JVC CONNECTED CAM GY HC550U User Manual

.
4K MEMORY CARD CAMERA RECORDER  
GY-HC550U/GY-HC550E/  
GY-HC500U/GY-HC500E/GY-HC500SPCU  
INSTRUCTIONS  
.
.
Wireless LAN antenna is not included in GY-HC500U/GY-HC500E/GY-HC500SPCU.  
The specifications and appearance of this product are subject to changes for further improvement  
without prior notice.  
Please check the latest version of the INSTRUCTIONS from the following Mobile User Guide. You can  
also download the PDF from the Mobile User Guide.  
Mobile User Guide  
When you are outside, you can refer to the instructions from your Android phone or iPhone.  
http://manual3.jvckenwood.com/pro/mobile/global/  
You can view the Mobile User Guide using the browser on your Android phone or iPhone.  
Please read the following before getting started:  
Thank you for purchasing this product.  
Before operating this unit, please read the  
instructions carefully to ensure the best possible  
performance.  
For Customer Use:  
In this manual, each model number is described  
without the last letter (U/E) which means the  
shipping destination.  
Enter below the Serial No. which is located  
on the body.  
Retain this information for future reference.  
(U: for USA and Canada, E: for Europe)  
Only “U” models (GY-HC550U/GY-HC500U/  
GY-HC500SPCU) have been evaluated by UL.  
Model No. GY-HC550U/GY-HC500U/GY-HC500SPCU  
Serial No.  
B5A-2966-00  
IM 1.01  
FOR USA  
These are general Important Safety Instructions and certain items may not  
apply to all appliances.  
Important Safety Instructions  
1. Read these instructions.  
2. Keep these instructions.  
3. Heed all warnings.  
4. Follow all instructions.  
5. Do not use this apparatus near water.  
6. Clean only with dry cloth.  
7. Do not block any ventilation openings. Install in accordance with the manufacturer’s  
instructions.  
8. Do not install near any heat sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or  
other apparatus (including amplifiers) that produce heat.  
9. Protect the power cord from being walked on or pinched particularly at plugs,  
convenience receptacles, and the point where they exit from the apparatus.  
10. Only use attachments/accessories specified by the manufacturer.  
11. Use only with the cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table  
specified by the manufacturer, or sold with the apparatus.  
When a cart is used, use caution when moving the  
cart/apparatus combination to avoid injury from tip-over.  
12. Unplug this apparatus during lightning storms or when  
unused for long periods of time.  
13. Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel.  
Servicing is required when the apparatus has been damaged in any way, such as  
power-supply cord or plug is damaged, liquid has been spilled or objects have fallen  
into the apparatus, the apparatus has been exposed to rain or moisture, does not  
operate normally, or has been dropped.  
For USA-California Only  
This product contains a CR Coin Cell Lithium Battery which contains Perchlorate  
Material – special handling may apply.  
See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate  
.
Important Safety Instructions  
3
POUR LES ÉTATS-UNIS  
Ces informations sont des CONSIGNES DE SÉCURITÉ IMPORTANTES et  
certains points peuvent ne pas s’appliquer à tous les appareils.  
CONSIGNES DE SÉCURITÉ IMPORTANTES  
1. Lire ces instructions.  
2. Conserver ces instructions.  
3. Tenir compte de tous les avertissements.  
4. Respecter toutes les instructions.  
5. Ne pas utiliser cet appareil à proximité de l’eau.  
6. Ne nettoyer qu’avec un chiffon sec.  
7. Ne pas boucher les ouvertures de ventilation.  
Installer selon les instructions du fabricant.  
8. Ne pas installer à proximité de sources de chaleur telles que des radiateurs,  
des accumulateurs de chaleur, des poêles, ou d’autres appareils  
(comprenant les amplificateurs) qui produisent de la chaleur.  
9. Protéger le cordon d’alimentation pour éviter qu’il ne soit piétiné ou ne se coince, tout  
particulièrement au niveau de la fiche, de la prise de courant et du point où il sort de l’appareil.  
10. Utiliser uniquement des équipements/accessoires spécifiés par le fabricant.  
11. N’utiliser qu’avec le chariot, le stand, le trépied, le support ou  
la table spécifié par le fabricant, ou vendu avec l’appareil.  
Lorsqu’un chariot est utilisé, faire attention pour déplacer  
la combinaison chariot/appareil pour éviter des blessures  
causées par un basculement.  
12. Débrancher cet appareil pendant un orage ou quand il  
n’est pas utilisé pendant une longue durée.  
13. Lentretien ou la réparation de l’appareil doit être effectué par du personnel qualifié uniquement.  
Un dépannage est nécessaire lorsque l’appareil a été endommagé d’une façon ou d’une autre,  
telle que lorsque le cordon d’alimentation ou la fiche est endommagé, si du liquide a été renversé  
ou si des objets sont tombés à l’intérieur de l’appareil, si l’appareil a été exposé à la pluie ou  
à l’humidité, ne fonctionne pas normalement ou a fait une chute.  
Pour Californie des États-Unis seulement  
Cet appareil contient une pile-bouton CR au lithium qui contient du perchlorate – une  
manipulation spéciale peut être requise.  
Voir www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate  
.
4
Important Safety Instructions  
Safety Precautions  
POUR CANADA  
ATTENTION  
FOR USA AND CANADA  
RISQUE  
CAUTION  
D’ELECTROCUTION  
NE PAS OUVRIR  
RISK OF ELECTRIC  
SHOCK  
DO NOT OPEN  
ATTENTION:  
POUR EVITER TOUT RISQUE  
D’ELECTROCUTION NE PAS  
OUVRIR LE BOITER. AUCUNE  
PIECE INTERIEURE N’EST A  
REGLER PAR LUTILISATEUR. SE  
REFERER A UN AGENT QUALIFIE  
EN CAS DE PROBLEME.  
CAUTION:  
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF  
ELECTRIC SHOCK.  
DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR  
BACK).  
NO USER-SERVICEABLE PARTS  
INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO  
QUALIFIED SERVICE  
PERSONNEL.  
Le symbole de l’éclair à  
l’intérieur d’un triangle  
équilatéral est destiné à  
alerter l’utilisateur sur la  
présence d’une “tension  
dangereuse” non isolée dans  
le boîtier du produit. Cette  
tension est suffisante pour  
provoquer l’électrocution de  
personnes.  
The lightning flash with  
arrowhead symbol, within  
an equilateral triangle is  
intended to alert the user to  
the presence of uninsulated  
“dangerous voltage” within  
the product’s enclosure that  
may be of sufficient  
Le point d’exclamation à  
l’intérieur d’un triangle  
équilatéral est destiné à  
alerter l’utilisateur sur la  
présence d’opérations  
d’entretien importantes au  
sujet desquelles des  
renseignements se trouvent  
dans le manuel  
magnitude to constitute a  
risk of electric shock to  
persons.  
The exclamation point within  
an equilateral triangle is  
intended to alert the user to  
the presence of important  
operating and maintenance  
(servicing) instructions in  
the literature accompanying  
d’instructions.  
Ces symboles ne sont  
utilisés qu’aux Etats-Unis.  
.
the appliance.  
.
Safety Precautions  
5
 
Supplier's Declaration of Conformity  
Model Number: GY-HC550U  
GY-HC500U  
Déclaration de conformité du fournisseur  
Numéro de  
modèle :  
GY-HC550U  
GY-HC500U  
GY-HC500SPCU  
GY-HC500SPCU  
Trade Name:  
Responsible  
party:  
JVC  
Nom de marque : JVC  
JVCKENWOOD USA  
Corporation  
500 Valley Road,  
Suite 203 Wayne,  
NJ 07470  
Personne  
responsable :  
Adresse :  
JVCKENWOOD USA  
Corporation  
Address:  
500 Valley Road,  
Suite 203 Wayne,  
NJ 07470  
Telephone  
Number:  
973-317-5000  
Numéro de  
téléphone :  
973-317-5000  
This device complies with Part 15 of  
the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to  
the following two conditions: (1) This  
device may not cause harmful  
interference, and (2) this device must  
accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause  
undesired operation.  
Cet ensemble se conforme à la partie 15 des  
règles de la FCC (Federal Communications  
Commission). Le fonctionnement est sujet aux  
deux conditions suivantes : (1) Cet appareil ne  
peut pas causer d’interférences nuisibles, et  
(2) cet appareil doit accepter toute interférence  
reçue, comprenant des interférences qui  
peuvent causer un mauvais fonctionnement.  
.
.
Changes or modifications not  
Des changements ou modifications  
non approuvés par JVC peuvent  
annuler le droit de l’utilisateur de faire  
fonctionner l’appareil. Cet appareil a  
été testé et il a été reconnu qu’il se  
conforme aux limites concernant  
l’appareillage informatique de classe  
A correspondant à la partie 15 des  
règles de la FCC. Ces limites sont  
conçues pour fournir une protection  
raisonnable contre les interférences  
dangereuses lorsque l’équipement est  
utilisé dans un environnement  
approved by JVC could void the  
user’s authority to operate the  
equipment. This equipment has been  
tested and found to comply with the  
limits for a Class A digital device,  
pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules.  
These limits are designed to provide  
reasonable protection against harmful  
interference when the equipment is  
operated in a commercial  
environment.  
This equipment generates, uses, and  
can radiate radio frequency energy  
and, if not installed and used in  
accordance with the instructions, may  
cause harmful interference to radio  
communications. Operation of this  
equipment in a residential area is  
likely to cause harmful interference in  
which case the user will be required  
to correct the interference at his own  
expense.  
commercial.  
Cet appareil génère, utilise et peut  
émettre de l’énergie des fréquences  
radio et, s’il n’est pas installé et utilisé  
selon les instructions du fabricant,  
peut causer des interférences  
nuisibles en communications radio.  
Lutilisation de cet équipement dans  
une zone résidentielle est susceptible  
de causer des interférences néfastes,  
auquel cas l’utilisateur devra prendre  
des mesures à ses propres frais.  
.
.
6
Safety Precautions  
CAUTION:  
The mains plug shall remain readily  
operable.  
Remove the mains plug immediately if  
the camera functions abnormally.  
Attention:  
La prise secteur doit être opérationnelle.  
Débranchez immédiatement la fiche  
secteur si le caméscope ne fonctionne  
pas normalement.  
.
.
WARNING:  
Avertissement:  
Évitez d’exposer la batterie, le  
caméscope avec la batterie insérée ou la  
télécommande avec la batterie insérée à  
une chaleur excessive, telle que celle  
des rayons directs du soleil, d’un feu ou  
de tout autre source de chaleur.  
The battery pack, the camera with  
battery installed, and the remote control  
with battery installed should not be  
exposed to excessive heat such as direct  
sunlight, fire or the like.  
.
.
WARNING:TO PREVENT FIRE OR  
SHOCK HAZARD, DO NOT  
EXPOSE THIS UNIT TO RAIN OR  
MOISTURE.  
AVERTISSEMENT : POUR EVITER  
LES RISQUES D’INCENDIE OU  
D’ELECTROCUTION, NE PAS  
EXPOSER LAPPAREIL A LA  
PLUIE NI A LHUMIDITE.  
.
.
NOTES:  
The rating plate and safety caution are  
on the bottom and/or the back of the  
main unit.  
REMARQUES :  
La plaque d’identification et  
l’avertissement de sécurité se trouvent  
sous l’appareil et/ou au dos.  
La plaque du numéro de série est  
située sur la partie inférieure de  
l’appareil.  
The serial number plate is on the  
bottom of the unit.  
The rating information and safety  
caution of the AC adapter are on its  
upper and lower sides.  
.
Les informations d’identification et  
l’avertissement de sécurité de  
l’adaptateur secteur sont situés sur ses  
côtés supérieur et inférieur.  
Caution on Replaceable lithium  
battery  
.
The battery used in this device may  
present a fire or chemical burn hazard if  
mistreated.  
Avertissement sur la pile au  
lithium remplaçable  
Do not recharge, disassemble, heat  
above 100°C (212°F) or incinerate.  
Replace battery with Panasonic, Sanyo,  
Sony or Maxell CR2025.  
Danger of explosion or risk of fire if the  
battery is incorrectly replaced.  
Dispose of used battery promptly.  
Keep away from children.  
Do not disassemble and do not dispose  
of in fire.  
La pile utilisée dans cet appareil peut  
présenter des risques d’incendie ou de  
brûlure chimique si elle est mal traitée.  
Ne pas recharger, démonter, chauffer à  
plus de 100°C (212°F) ni mettre au feu.  
Remplacez la pile avec Panasonic,  
Sanyo, Sony ou Maxell CR2025.  
Danger d’explosion ou risque d’incendie  
si la pile n’est pas changée correctement.  
Jeter immédiatement les piles usées.  
Placer hors de la portée des enfants.  
Ne pas démonter ni jeter au feu.  
.
.
Safety Precautions  
7
When the equipment is installed in a  
cabinet or on a shelf, make sure that it  
has sufficient space on all sides to allow  
for ventilation (10 cm (3-15/16") or more  
on both sides, on top and at the rear).  
Do not block the ventilation holes.  
(If the ventilation holes are blocked by a  
newspaper, or cloth etc. the heat may not  
be able to get out.)  
Si le matériel est installé dans un coffret  
ou sur une étagère, s’assurer qu’il y a un  
espace suffisant sur tous les côtés pour  
permettre la ventilation (10 cm (3-15/16")  
ou plus sur les deux côtés, au dessus et  
à l’arrière).  
Ne pas boucher les orifices de  
ventilation.  
(Si les orifices de ventilation sont  
bouchés par un journal, un tissu, etc., la  
chaleur peut ne pas s’éliminer.)  
Aucune source à flamme nue, telle que  
des bougies allumées, ne doit être  
placée sur l’appareil.  
En jetant des batteries aux ordures, les  
problèmes d’environnement doivent être  
pris en considération et les  
No naked flame sources, such as lighted  
candles, should be placed on the  
apparatus.  
When discarding batteries,  
environmental problems must be  
considered and the local rules or laws  
governing the disposal of these batteries  
must be followed strictly.  
.
réglementations locales ou la législation  
concernant le rebut de ces batteries  
doivent être strictement respectées.  
The apparatus shall not be exposed to  
dripping or splashing and that no objects  
filled with liquids, such as vases, shall be  
placed on the apparatus.  
.
Lappareil ne doit pas être exposé à de  
l’eau ou à des éclaboussures et les  
objets remplis de liquide, tels que des  
vases, ne doivent pas être placés sur  
l’appareil.  
.
Do not point the lens directly into the  
sun. This can cause eye injuries, as well  
as lead to the malfunctioning of internal  
circuitry. There is also a risk of fire or  
electric shock.  
.
Ne dirigez pas l’objectif directement vers  
le soleil. Vous pourriez vous abîmer la  
vue et l’appareil pourrait être  
endommagé. Il y a aussi risque  
d’incendie ou d’électrocution.  
Attention!  
Les remarques suivantes sont destinées  
à protéger l’utilisateur et le caméscope  
contre des dommages éventuels.  
Ne pas transporter ou saisir le  
caméscope par l’écran LCD, car il  
pourrait tomber ou s’endommager.  
Ne pas utiliser de trépied  
photographique sur des surfaces  
irrégulières et inclinées. Il pourrait  
tomber et le caméscope pourrait être  
sérieusement endommagé.  
CAUTION!  
The following notes concern possible  
physical damage to this unit and to the  
user.  
Carrying or holding this unit by the LCD  
monitor can result in dropping the unit,  
or in a malfunction.  
Do not use a tripod on unsteady or  
unlevel surfaces. It could tip over,  
causing serious damage to the unit.  
CAUTION!  
Connecting cables (Audio/Video, etc.) to  
this unit and leaving it on top of the TV is  
not recommended, as tripping on the  
cables will cause the unit to fall, resulting  
in damage.  
Attention!  
.
Avec des câbles (Audio/Vidéo, etc.)  
raccordés, il est recommandé de ne pas  
laisser le caméscope sur le dessus du  
téléviseur, car tirer sur les câbles  
pourrait faire tomber le caméscope,  
causant des dommages.  
.
8
Safety Precautions  
GY-HC550U  
Radio Frequency Energy Safety Information  
Informations sur la sécurité en présence  
d'énergie par radiofréquences  
Warning  
Avertissement  
This JVC camera generates RF EME while  
transmitting. RF EME (Radio Frequency Electric  
& Magnetic Energy) has the potential to cause  
slight thermal, or heating effects to any part of  
your body less than the recommended distance  
from this radio transmitter’s antenna. RF energy  
exposure is determined primarily by the distance  
to and the power of the transmitting device. In  
general, RF exposure is minimized when the  
lowest possible power is used or transmission  
time is kept to the minimum required for  
consistent communications, and the greatest  
distance possible from the antenna to the body  
is maintained.  
Ce caméscope JVC génère de l'EME par RF lors  
de la transmission. L'EME par RF (énergie  
électrique et magnétique par radiofréquences)  
peut causer de légers effets thermiques ou  
chauffants sur toute partie de votre corps,  
lorsque vous trouvez à une distance inférieure à  
cellerecommandéedel’antennedecetémetteur  
radio. L'exposition à l'énergie par  
radiofréquences est principalement déterminée  
par la distance et la puissance de l'appareil  
émetteur. En général, l'exposition aux  
radiofréquences est minimisée lorsqu'on utilise  
la puissance la plus faible possible ou que le  
temps de transmission est maintenu au minimum  
requis pour assurer des communications  
cohérentes et lorsqu'on maintient la plus grande  
distance possible entre l'antenne et le corps.  
The following list provides you with the information  
required to ensure that you are aware of RF  
exposure.  
La liste suivante vous fournit les informations dont  
vous avez besoin pour être sûr d'être informé de  
l'exposition aux radiofréquences.  
0
While transmitting, always keep the antenna  
and the radio at least 5 cm (1-31/32”) from your  
body or face, as well as from any bystanders.  
To maintain compliance with FCC's RF  
exposure guidelines, use only the supplied  
antenna (with antenna holder).  
0
Pendant la transmission, gardez toujours  
l’antenne et la radio à au moins 5 cm (1-31/32”)  
de votre corps ou de votre visage, ainsi que de  
toutes les personnes aux alentours.  
0
Unauthrized antenna, modification, or  
attachments could damage the transmitter and  
may violate FCC regulations.  
0
Pour maintenir la conformité avec les directives  
d’exposition RF de la FCC, utilisez uniquement  
l’antenne fournie (avec support d'antenne).  
Une antenne, une modification ou des  
accessoires non autorisés peuvent  
Electromagnetic Interference Compatibility  
Electronic devices are susceptible to  
electromagnetic interference (EMI) if they are not  
adequately shielded or designed for  
endommager le transmetteur et enfreindre les  
réglementations de la FCC.  
electromagnetic compatibility.  
Compatibilité aux interférences  
électromagnétiques  
Because this product generates RF energy, it can  
cause interference to such equipment.  
Les appareils électroniques sont sensibles aux  
interférences électromagnétiques (EMI) s'ils ne  
sont pas correctement protégés ou conçus pour  
une compatibilité électromagnétique.  
0
0
Turn OFF your WLAN where signs are posted to  
do so. Hospitals and health care facilities use  
equipment that is sensitive to electromagnetic  
radiation.  
Étant donné que cet appareil génère de l’énergie  
par radiofréquences, il peut provoquer des  
interférences avec ce genre d’équipement.  
Turn OFF your product while on board an aircraft  
when so instructed. Use of the product must be  
in accordance with airline regulations and/or  
crew instructions.  
0
Éteignez votre WLAN lorsque des signes vous  
l'indiquant s'affichent. Les hôpitaux et les  
établissements de santé utilisent un  
équipement sensible aux rayonnements  
électromagnétiques.  
0
Éteignez votre appareil lorsque vous trouvez à  
bord d’un avion et qu'on vous le demande.  
L'utilisation de l'appareil doit être conforme aux  
règlements de la compagnie aérienne et/ou aux  
instructions de l'équipage.  
Safety Precautions  
9
GY-HC550U  
For indoor use only (5150-5250 MHz) in  
Canada  
Pour usage intérieur seulement (5150-5250  
MHz) au Canada  
There are legal restrictions on the use and  
outdoor use depending on the country and  
region. Please be careful not to violate the law.  
Il existe des restrictions légales concernant  
l’utilisation générale et extérieure en fonction du  
pays et de la région. Veillez à respecter la loi.  
Data transmission is always intiated by software,  
which is the passed down through the MAC,  
through the digital and analog baseband, and  
finally to the RF chip. Several special packets are  
initiated by the MAC.These are the only ways the  
digital baseband portion will turn on the RF  
transmitter, which it then turns off at the end of  
the packet. Therefore, the transmitter will be on  
only while one of the aforementioned packets is  
being transmitted.In other words, this device  
automatically discontinue transmission in case  
of either absence of information to transmit or  
operational failure.  
La transmission des données est toujours initiée  
par le logiciel, puis les données sont transmises  
par l'intermédiaire du MAC, par la bande de base  
numérique et analogique et, enfin à la puce RF.  
Plusieurs paquets spéciaux sont initiés par le  
MAC. Ce sont les seuls moyens pour qu'une de  
la bande de base numérique active l'émetteur  
RF, puis désactive celui-ci à la fin du paquet. En  
conséquence, l'émetteur reste uniquement  
activé lors de la transmission d'un des paquets  
susmentionnés. En d'autres termes, ce dispositif  
interrompt automatiquement toute transmission  
en cas d'absence d'informations à transmettre  
ou de défaillance.  
Frequency Tolerance: 20 ppm  
Tolérance de fréquence: 20 ppm  
This radio transmitter (6549A-W8997M1216)  
has been approved by Innovation, Science and  
Economic Development Canada to operate with  
the antenna types listed bellow, with the  
maximum permissible gain indicated.  
Le présent émetteur radio (6549 A-W 8997 M  
1216) a été approuvé par Innovation, Sciences  
et Développement économique Canada pour  
fonctionner avec les types d'antenne énumérés  
ci-dessous et ayant un gain admissible maximal.  
Les types d'antenne non inclus dans cette liste,  
et dont le gain est supérieur au gain maximal  
indiqué pour tout type figurant sur la liste, sont  
strictement interdits pour l'exploitation de  
l'émetteur.  
Antenna types not included in this list that have  
a gain greater than the maximum gain indicated  
for any type listed are strictly prohibited use with  
this device.  
Antenna  
Gain  
Impedance  
50 Ω  
type  
Types  
3.6 dBi (4.9-5.8 GHz)  
1.9 dBi (2.4-2.5 GHz)  
Gain  
l'impédance  
50 Ω  
Dipole  
d'antenne  
Dipôle  
3.6 dBi (4.9-5.8 GHz)  
1.9 dBi (2.4-2.5 GHz)  
10 Safety Precautions  
GY-HC550U  
This transmitter must not be co-located or  
operated in conjunction with any other antenna  
or transmitter.  
Cet émetteur ne doit pas être co-localisé ou  
utilisé en conjonction avec une autre antenne ou  
un autre émetteur.  
This device contains licence-exempt  
transmitter(s)/receiver(s) that comply with  
Innovation, Science and Economic  
Development Canada’s licence-exempt RSS(s).  
Operation is subject to the following two  
conditions:  
L’émetteur/récepteur exempt de licence contenu  
dans le présent appareil est conforme aux CNR  
d’Innovation, Sciences et Développement  
économique Canada applicables aux appareils  
radio exempts de licence. L’exploitation est  
autorisée aux deux conditions suivantes :  
A
A
This device may not cause interference.  
This device must accept any interference,  
L’appareil ne doit pas produire de brouillage;  
L’appareil doit accepter tout brouillage  
B
B
including interference that may cause  
undesired operation of the device.  
radioélectrique subi, même si le brouillage est  
susceptible d’en compromettre le  
fonctionnement.  
The available scientific evidence does not show  
that any health problems are associated with  
using low power wireless devices. There is no  
proof, however, that these low power wireless  
devices are absolutely safe. Low power Wireless  
devices emit low levels of radio frequency energy  
(RF) in the microwave range while being used.  
Whereas high levels of RF can produce health  
effects (by heating tissue), exposure of low-level  
RF that does not produce heating effects causes  
no known adverse health effects. Many studies  
of low-level RF exposures have not found any  
biological effects. Some studies have suggested  
that some biological effects might occur, but  
such findings have not been confirmed by  
additional research.  
Les connaissances scientifiques dont nous  
disposons n’ont mis en évidence aucun  
problème de santé associé à l’usage des  
appareils sans fil à faible puissance. Nous ne  
sommes cependant pas en mesure de prouver  
que ces appareils sans fil à faible puissance sont  
entièrement sans danger. Les appareils sans fil  
à faible puissance émettent une énergie  
fréquence radioélectrique (RF) très faible dans  
le spectre des micro-ondes lorsqu’ils sont  
utilisés. Alors qu’une dose élevée de RF peut  
avoir des effets sur la santé (en chauffant les  
tissus), l’exposition à de faibles RF qui ne  
produisent pas de chaleur n’a pas de mauvais  
effets connus sur la santé. De nombreuses  
études ont été menées sur les expositions aux  
RF faibles et n’ont découvert aucun effet  
biologique. Certaines études ont suggéré qu’il  
pouvait y avoir certains effets biologiques, mais  
ces résultats n’ont pas été confirmés par des  
recherches supplémentaires.  
The RF module, W8997-M1216 has been tested  
and found to comply with FCC/ISED radiation  
exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled  
environment and meets the FCC radio frequency  
(RF) Exposure Guidelines and RSS-102 of the  
ISED radio frequency (RF) Exposure rules.  
Le module RF, W8997-M1216 a été testé et jugé  
conforme aux limites d’exposition aux  
rayonnements énoncées pour un  
environnement non contrôlé et respecte les  
règles les radioélectriques (RF) de la FCC lignes  
directrices d'exposition et d’exposition aux  
fréquences radioélectriques (RF) CNR-102 de l’  
ISDE.  
Safety Precautions 11  
IMPORTANT (for owners in the U.K.)  
Connection to the mains supply in  
the United Kingdom.  
CAUTION:  
Where there are strong electromagnetic  
waves or magnetism, for example near a  
radio or TV transmitter, transformer,  
motor, etc., the picture and the sound  
may be disturbed. In such case, please  
keep the apparatus away from the  
sources of the disturbance.  
DO NOT cut off the mains plug from  
this equipment.  
If the plug fitted is not suitable for the  
power points in your home or the cable is  
too short to reach a power point, then  
obtain an appropriate safety approved  
extension lead or contact the local  
dealers in your area.  
BE SURE to replace the fuse only with  
an identical approved type, as originally  
fitted, and to replace the fuse cover.  
If nonetheless the mains plug is cut off  
be sure to remove the fuse and dispose  
of the plug immediately, to avoid possible  
shock hazard by inadvertent connection  
to the mains supply.  
If this product is not supplied fitted with a  
mains plug then follow the instructions  
given below:  
DO NOT make any connection to the  
Larger Terminal coded E or Green.  
The wires in the mains lead are coloured  
in accordance with the following code:  
.
The plastics packaging bags may cause  
suffocation when they are covered over the  
head.Tear them open, and keep them away  
from the reach of infants and children by  
ensuring that they are disposed of properly.  
.
GY-HC550E  
Wireless LAN  
This device is a 2.4 GHz wideband  
transmission system (transceiver),  
intended for use in all EU member  
states and EFTA countries, except in  
France and Italy where restrictive use  
applies.  
In Italy the end-user should apply for a  
license at the national spectrum  
authorities in order to obtain  
Blue to N  
(Neutral) or Black  
Brown to L (Live)  
or Red  
authorization to use the device for  
setting up outdoor radio links and/or for  
supplying public access to  
telecommunications and/or network  
services.  
If these colours do not correspond with  
the terminal identifications of your plug,  
connect as follows:  
Blue wire to terminal coded N (Neutral)  
or coloured black.  
Brown wire to terminal coded L (Live) or  
coloured Red.  
If in doubt consult a competent  
electrician.  
This device may not be used for setting  
up outdoor radio links in France and in  
some areas the RF output power may  
be limited to 10 mW EIRP in the  
frequency range of 2454 - 2483.5 MHz.  
For detailed information the end-user  
should contact the national spectrum  
authority in France.  
.
CAUTIONS:  
Frequency Range 2.4GHz Band : 1 - 13ch  
To prevent shock, do not open the cabinet.  
No user serviceable parts inside.  
Refer servicing to qualified personnel.  
Output Power  
11 b/g/n  
: 14 dBm (max)  
.
.
Frequency Range 5GHz Band : W52/W53/W56  
Output Power  
11 n/a/ac : 11 dBm (max)  
WARNING  
.
Operation of this equipment in a  
residential environment could cause  
radio interference.  
.
12 Safety Precautions  
GY-HC550E and GY-HC500E  
Battery Pack  
The European representative of  
JVCKENWOOD Corporation is:  
The supplied battery pack is a lithium-ion  
battery. Before using the supplied battery  
pack or an optional battery pack, be sure  
to read the following cautions:  
Die europäische Vertretung für die  
JVCKENWOOD Corporation ist:  
Terminals  
To avoid hazards  
... do not burn.  
... do not short-circuit the  
terminals. Keep it away  
from metallic objects  
when not in use.  
JVCKENWOOD Deutschland GmbH  
Konrad-Adenauer-Allee 1-11  
61118 Bad Vilbel  
GERMANY  
.
When transporting, carry the battery in  
a plastic bag.  
GY-HC500E  
... do not modify or disassemble.  
... do not expose the battery to  
temperatures exceeding 60°C (140°F),  
as this may cause the battery to  
overheat, explode or catch fire.  
... use only specified chargers.  
To prevent damage and prolong  
service life  
... do not subject to unnecessary shock.  
... charge within the temperature range  
of 10°C to 35°C (50°F to 95°F). Cooler  
temperatures require longer charging  
time, or in some cases stop charging  
at all. Warmer temperatures prevent  
complete charging, or in some cases  
stop charging at all.  
Dear customer,  
this apparatus is in compliance with the  
valid European Directive and the  
relevant standards regarding  
electromagnetic compatibility.  
Sehr geehrter Kunde, sehr geehrte  
Kundin,  
dieses Gerät stimmt mit der gültigen  
europäischen Richtlinie und den  
relevanten Normen bezüglich  
elektromagnetischer Verträglichkeit  
überein.  
.
GY-HC550E  
... store in a cool, dry place. Extended  
exposure to high temperatures will  
increase natural discharge and  
shorten service life.  
Hereby, JVCKENWOOD Corporation  
declares that the radio equipment type  
GY-HC550E is in compliance with  
Directive 2014/53/EU.  
... keep a 30% battery level  
if the  
battery pack is not to be used for a  
long period of time.  
The full text of the EU declaration of  
conformity is available at the following  
internet address:  
... remove from charger or powered unit  
when not in use, as some machines  
use current even when switched off.  
... do not drop or subject to strong  
impact.  
Hiermit erklärt die , JVCKENWOOD  
Corporation, dass der Funkanlagentyp  
GY-HC550E der Richtlinie 2014/53/EU  
entspricht.  
.
Der vollständige Text der  
EU-Konformitätserklärung ist unter der  
folgenden Internetadresse verfügbar:  
http://www3.jvckenwood.com/ecdoc/  
.
Safety Precautions 13  
o Para Brasil  
Informação sobre eliminação de  
baterias  
Este produto não deverá ser eliminado  
como lixo doméstico em geral.  
Devolva a bateria velha ao comerciante  
ou para a rede autorizada, para que seja  
devolvida ao fabricante ou importador.  
A reciclagem e eliminação de lixo em  
uma maneira adequada, ajudarão para  
preservar recursos, prevenindo, ao  
mesmo tempo, contra efeitos prejudiciais  
sobre a nossa saúde e o meio ambiente.  
.
Empurre  
.
14 Safety Precautions  
Contents  
Introduction  
Contents 15  
 
16 Contents  
.
Contents 17  
HDR and log gamma for high dynamic  
range and wide color gamut  
Main Features  
This camera recorder is equipped with HLG  
(Hybrid Log-Gamma) that conforms to ITU-BT.  
2100 and our in-house J-Log1 Gamma with 800%  
dynamic range to cope with HDR (High Dynamic  
Range). Capable of recording in 10-bit for high  
dynamic range and wide color gamut.  
1" CMOS sensor and new 4K 20x lens  
for high-quality recording  
Comes with a 1" CMOS sensor that delivers high  
resolution and an excellent S/N ratio. At the same  
time, a new 4K 20x lens with a good balance in  
viewing angle, image quality and magnification is  
employed to reduce the occurrence of aberrations,  
thereby achieving premium-quality 4K recording  
with high sensitivity and low noise.  
High-frame-rate recording in Full HD  
quality (1920x1080)  
Videos with a maximum frame rate of 120 fps can  
be recorded in slow motion. It can be used to check  
the style of the subject in fast-moving sports and in  
video expression that leaves a deep impression.  
“Apple ProRes 422” available as a  
standard feature to achieve high-  
resolution and high bit-rate recording  
performance  
By making use of the KA-MC100 SSD media  
adapter (sold separately), it is possible to perform  
4K 50p/60p Apple ProRes 422 recording to a high-  
speed SSD memory.  
Broadcast Overlay A L  
Station name, program name, or news title  
according to the recorded content can be entered  
easily by using a smartphone or tablet, and this  
information can be superimposed on the recording  
clip or streaming images.  
Also, itcomeswithafull-screengraphicfeaturethat  
allows overlay of the entire screen with images  
such as notifications and advertisements.  
A variety of wired and wireless  
interfaces to support various network  
connections  
In addition to the USB host terminal for wireless  
LAN and LTE USB adapter connections, this  
camera recorder is equipped with a variety of  
interfaces such as wired LAN terminal and built-in  
wireless LAN with 2.4GHz/5GHz MIMO dual band  
antennas A to support various network  
connections.  
Score Board Overlay L  
Allowsdisplayofscoresforgamessuchasfootball,  
baseball, basketball and hockey over the video  
image.  
Scores can be entered from a smartphone or tablet  
while video-shooting is in progress, enabling easy  
operation such as live broadcast by a small crew.  
Bidirectional live streaming feature  
Auto focus/optical image stabilizer  
(OIS)  
The camera recorder is equipped with a face  
detection auto focus function that covers the entire  
screen. Switching to manual focus is also possible.  
A built-in optical image stabilizer feature is also  
available.  
Enables live streaming broadcast from the camera,  
while at the same time receives program images  
from studio stations as IP return video or intercom  
audio as IP return audio (IFB) over the same line.  
High quality signal processing by 10-bit,  
4:2:2 sampling  
High quality signal processing that delivers rich  
gradation expression and color reproduction of  
video signals is possible by means of 10-bit, 4:2:2  
sampling.  
Prevents camera shake with the OIS  
hard lock feature  
Helps to secure the OIS lens to prevent unnatural  
video images due to sudden acceleration of  
vehicles when the camera is mounted on a vehicle.  
Various usage-based recording formats  
Recording codecs supported are MPEG-4 AVC/H.  
264 and Apple ProRes 422, which is compatible  
with 4:2:2 10-bit recording. Selectable ProRes  
formats include Apple ProRes 422HQ, Apple  
ProRes 422 and Apple ProRes 422LT. Selectable  
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264 formats include QuickTime  
(MOV) and MP4.  
It is also compatible with MPEG2 MXF, which is a  
widely-used format at broadcasting stations. A  
18 Main Features  
 
Double SD card slots for series/dual  
recordings  
Symbols used  
Caution : Describes precautions concerning the  
The most common SDHC/SDXC card recording  
system is used for the memory card. This ensures  
high reliability and operation at low running cost.  
Various user friendly recording options are  
available. These include series recording which  
enables seamless long hour continuous  
recordings over the slots and dual recording of the  
same file to two slots.  
operation of this product.  
Memo  
:
Describes reference information, such  
as functions and usage restrictions of  
this product.  
A
:
:
:
:
Indicates the reference page numbers  
and reference items.  
A
B
L
Feature available on GY-HC550U/  
GY-HC550E only.  
Feature available on GY-HC500U/  
GY-HC500E/GY-HC500SPCU only.  
Feature available on GY-HC500SPCU  
only.  
FTP feature that supports automatic  
upload  
Clips stored in the recording media can be  
uploaded automatically to the FTP server while  
recording is paused. When recording is in  
progress, clips stored in the slot that is not used for  
recording can also be uploaded.  
Content of this manual  
0
All rights reserved by JVCKENWOOD  
Corporation. Unauthorized duplication or  
reprinting of this manual, in whole or in part, is  
strictly prohibited.  
Large tricolor LED indicators that show  
the camera and network status  
The two large LED indicators light up in three  
different colors to allow identification of the camera  
status and network status (including the return  
video) at a glance.  
0
Illustrated designs, specifications and other  
contents of this manual are subject to change for  
improvement without prior notice.  
0
0
SDXC and SDHC logos are trademarks of  
SD-3C, LLC.  
The terms HDMI and HDMI High-Definition  
Multimedia Interface, and the HDMI Logo are  
trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI  
LicensingAdministrator, Inc. intheUnitedStates  
and other countries.  
Time code input/output terminals for  
shooting using multiple cameras  
This camera recorder supports the use of multiple  
cameras as well as studio use.  
0
0
QuickTime, Final Cut Pro, iPhone, iPad, iPod  
touch, macOS and Safari are trademarks of  
Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other  
countries.  
Professional-style switch layout and  
diverse video parameters  
Switches for Gain and White Balance are available  
on the side panel to enable quick switching  
according to the shooting scene. Image quality  
parameters such as gamma and color matrix are  
also available in the menu for adjustment to the  
preferred tones.  
iOS is a trademark or registered trademark of  
Cisco in the U.S. and other countries and is used  
under license.  
0
0
0
Android and Google Chrome are trademarks  
and/or registered trademarks of Google LLC.  
QR Code is a registered trademark of Denso  
Wave Incorporated.  
Microsoft, Windows, and Internet Explorer are  
either registered trademarks or trademarks of  
Microsoft Corporation in the United States  
and/or other countries.  
Built-in GPS A L  
This camera recorder is built in with GPS function,  
which enables the positional information obtained  
from the GPS satellite during a shoot to be  
recorded as metadata.  
Note that acquisition of the positional  
information may fail depending on the weather  
condition.  
0
The company name of Fontworks, Fontworks,  
and the name of the fonts are registered  
trademarks of Fontworks Inc.  
*
0
0
Zixi and the Zixi logo are trademarks of Zixi LLC.  
Other product and company names included in  
this instruction manual are trademarks and/or  
registered trademarks of their respective  
companies. Marks such as ™ and ® have been  
omitted in this manual.  
User buttons/switches assignable with  
different functions for greater ease of  
use  
Menu items corresponding to each user button are  
available to assign the buttons with different  
functions.  
Main Features 19  
Power Saving  
Precautions for Proper  
Use  
o
When this unit is not in use, be sure to set the  
[POWER ON/OFF] switch to “OFF” in order to  
reduce power consumption.  
Storage and Usage Locations  
Maintenance  
o
Allowable ambient temperature and humidity  
o
Turn off the power before performing any  
Be sure to use this unit within the allowable  
temperature range of 0 °C to 40 °C (32 °F to  
104°F) and a relative humidity of 30 % to 80 %.  
Using this unit at a temperature or humidity  
outside the allowable ranges could result not  
only in malfunction but also serious impact on  
the CMOS elements as small white spots may  
be generated. Please exercise care during use.  
maintenance.  
o
Wipe the external cabinet of the unit with a soft  
cloth. Do not wipe the body with benzene or  
thinner. Doing so may cause the surface to melt  
or turn cloudy. When it is extremely dirty, soak  
the cloth in a solution of neutral detergent, wipe  
the body with it, and then use a clean cloth to  
remove the detergent.  
o
Strong electromagnetic waves or magnetism  
Noise may appear in the picture or audio and/or  
the colors may be incorrect if this unit is used  
near a radio or television transmitting antenna,  
in places where strong magnetic fields are  
generated by transformers, motors, etc., or near  
devices emitting radio waves, such as  
Rechargeable Battery  
o
Be sure to use only the specified batteries.  
We do not guarantee the safety and  
performance of this device if an unspecified  
battery is used.  
o
Store the battery in a cool and dry place when  
not in use. Do not expose the battery to high  
temperatures (such as in a car under direct  
sunlight). Failure to do so not only shortens the  
battery life but also damages the battery.  
Charge the battery first before using.  
If you are not using the battery for a prolonged  
period of time, remove and keep the battery at a  
30 % to 40 % charge level to prevent  
deterioration.  
transceivers or cellular phones.  
o
Use of wireless microphone near this unit  
When a wireless microphone or wireless  
microphone tuner is used near this unit during  
recording, the tuner could pick up noise.  
o
o
o
Avoid using or placing this unit in the following  
places.  
0
0
0
0
Places subject to extreme heat or cold  
Places with excessive dirt or dust  
Places with high humidity or moisture  
Places subject to smoke or vapor such as near  
a cooking stove  
o
o
Recharge the battery to a level of 10 % to 20 %  
once every six months when storing the battery.  
Storing the battery at a fully discharged state will  
result in over discharging and inability to charge  
the battery.  
0
0
Places subject to strong vibrations or unstable  
surfaces  
In a parked car under direct sunlight or near a  
heater for long hours  
ATTENTION:  
The product you have purchased  
is powered by a rechargeable  
o
Do not place this unit at places that are subject  
to radiation or X-rays, or where corrosive gases  
occur.  
battery that is recyclable.  
Please call 1-800-8-BATTERY for  
information on how to recycle this  
battery.  
o
o
Protect this unit from being splashed with water.  
(Especially when shooting in the rain)  
Protect this unit from getting wet when shooting  
on a beach. In addition, salt and sand may  
adheretothebody. Besuretocleantheunitafter  
use.  
o
Protect this unit against penetration of dust  
when using it in a place subject to sandy dust.  
Carrying the Camera  
o
Do not drop or hit this unit against a hard object  
when transporting.  
20 Precautions for Proper Use  
   
o
o
Make use of the SD card within the prescribed  
conditions of use.  
Regular Inspection (Maintenance)  
o
Under normal environment, dust will  
Do not use it at the following locations.  
Places that are subject to direct sunlight, high  
humidity or corrosion, places near thermal  
equipment, sandy or dusty places, or in a car  
under the sun with the doors and windows  
closed.  
accumulate on the camera recorder when it is  
used over a long period. Dust may enter the  
camera recorder especially if it is used outdoors.  
This may affect the image and sound quality of  
the camera recorder. Check and replace the fan  
after every 9000 hours (suggested guideline).  
You can check the usage time of the fan in  
[System] B [System Information] B [Fan Hour].  
Do not bend or drop the SD card, or subject it to  
strong impact or vibration.  
o
o
o
Do not splash the SD card with water.  
Do not dismantle or modify the SD card.  
Do not touch the terminals with your hands or  
with a metal object.  
If the fan is used for more than 9000 hours  
without replacement, “Fan Maintenance  
Required” will be displayed every time you turn  
on the power.  
o
o
o
o
Do not allow dust, dirt, water, or foreign objects  
to adhere to the terminals.  
Do not remove the labels or stick other labels or  
stickers on the SD cards.  
SDHC/SDXC Cards  
Do not use pencils or ballpoint pens to write on  
the SD cards. Always use oil-based pens.  
If you format (initialize) the SD card, all data  
recorded on the card, including video data and  
setup files, will be deleted.  
o
SDHC/SDXC card is referred to as “SD card” or  
“recording media” in this manual.  
o
o
This camera recorder saves the recorded  
images and audio sound on the SD card (sold  
separately) in the card slot.  
o
You are recommended to use cards that are  
formatted (initialized) on this camera recorder.  
If the SD card contains files recorded by devices  
other than this camera recorder or files that are  
saved from a PC, the recordable time may be  
shorter or data may not be properly recorded. In  
addition, the remaining space on the card may  
not increase even when files are deleted using  
a PC.  
0
The SD card may be damaged if the camera  
recorder is not operated correctly. Formatting  
(Initializing) the SD card may allow it to  
operate correctly.  
0
SD cards that have been formatted  
(initialized) on other cameras, computers or  
peripheral equipment may not operate  
o
For details on the combinations of usable SD  
card and format setting, refer to the following.  
correctly. In this case, format (initialize) the SD  
card on this camera recorder.  
o
If you want to wipe out all information by  
completely erasing the data, we recommend  
either using commercially available software  
that is specially designed for that purpose, or by  
physically destroying the SD card with a  
hammer, etc. When formatting or erasing data  
using the camera recorder, only the file  
*
Using cards other than those from Panasonic,  
TOSHIBA or SanDisk may result in recording  
failure or data loss.  
Handling of SD Cards  
administration information is changed. The data  
is not completely erased from the SD card.  
Some commercially available SD cards may be  
harder to be removed from this unit. Remove  
them by hooking onto the groove on the cards.  
o
The status indicator lights up in red when data  
on the SD card is being accessed.  
o
Do not remove the SD card during data access  
(such as recording, playback, or formatting). Do  
not turn off the power or remove the battery and  
AC adapter during access either.  
0
It will be easier to remove the cards after  
several times.  
o
o
Do not use or store the SD card in a place that  
is subject to static electricity or electrical noise.  
Do not place the SD card near locations that are  
exposed to strong magnetic fields or radio  
waves.  
0
Do not stick any stickers on the cards.  
o
o
Inserting the SD card incorrectly may result in  
damage of this unit or the SD card.  
Groove  
.
We are not liable for any accidental loss of data  
stored on the SD card. Please back up any  
important data.  
o
The SD card may pop out when it is being  
removed. Be careful not to lose the card.  
Precautions for Proper Use 21  
 
Encryption in Network Connection  
Copyright  
o
o
Wireless LAN connections make use of an  
Any recordings made on this camera recorder  
that are played back for profit or public preview  
may infringe on the rights of the owner of the  
recordings.  
encryption function.  
This encryption is designed for commercially-  
sold equipment, and it cannot be altered.  
Do not use the recordings for purpose other than  
personal enjoyment without prior consent from  
the owner. And even for personal enjoyment,  
you may not be able to record without  
permission from the owner.  
LCD Monitor and Viewfinder  
o
The LCD monitor and viewfinder screen are  
manufactured using high-precision technology.  
Black or bright spots may appear on the LCD  
monitor and viewfinder screen. This is not a  
malfunction. These spots will not be recorded.  
If you use this unit continuously for a long period  
of time, the characters displayed in the  
viewfinder may temporarily remain on the  
screen. This phenomenon will not be recorded  
to the recording media. They will not appear  
after you turn the power off and then on again.  
If you use this unit in a cold place, the images  
may appear to lag on the screen, but this is not  
a malfunction. Retained images are not  
recorded on the SD card.  
License Notices  
o
o
o
MPEG LA AVC  
THIS PRODUCT IS LICENSED UNDER THE  
AVC PATENT PORTFOLIO LICENSE FOR  
THE PERSONAL USE OF A CONSUMER OR  
OTHER USES IN WHICH IT DOES NOT  
RECEIVE REMUNERATION TO  
(i) ENCODE VIDEO IN COMPLIANCE WITH  
THE AVC STANDARD (“AVC VIDEO”) AND/OR  
(ii) DECODE AVC VIDEO THAT WAS  
ENCODED BY A CONSUMER ENGAGED IN A  
PERSONAL ACTIVITY AND/OR WAS  
OBTAINED FROM A VIDEO PROVIDER  
LICENSED TO PROVIDE AVC VIDEO.  
NO LICENSE IS GRANTED OR SHALL BE  
IMPLIED FOR ANY OTHER USE. ADDITIONAL  
INFORMATION MAY BE OBTAINED FROM  
MPEG LA, L.L.C. SEE  
o
o
o
Do not press against the surface with force or  
subject it to strong impact. Doing so may  
damage or break the screens.  
Noise may appear in the viewfinder when  
switching between the live video and playback  
images.  
Due to the characteristic of the viewfinder  
display device, colors may appear on the  
images when you blink your eyes. It does not  
affect the recorded images, SDI output, or HDMI  
output.  
MPEG LA MPEG-2 Patent  
o
ANY USE OF THIS UNIT IN ANY MANNER  
OTHER THAN PERSONAL USE THAT  
COMPLIES WITH THE MPEG-2 STANDARD  
FOR ENCODING VIDEO INFORMATION FOR  
PACKAGED MEDIA IS EXPRESSLY  
PROHIBITED WITHOUT A LICENSE UNDER  
APPLICABLE PATENTS IN THE MPEG-2  
PATENT PORTFOLIO, WHICH LICENSE IS  
AVAILABLE FROM MPEG LA, LLC, 6312 S.  
WHICH LICENSE IS AVAILABLE FROM MPEG  
LA, LLC, 6312 S. Fiddlers Green circle, Suite  
400E, Greenwood Village, Colorado 80111  
U.S.A.  
GPS A L  
o
The GPS (Global Positioning System) satellites  
are managed by the Department of State of the  
U.S., and its precision may be altered  
intentionally.  
o
o
Perform positioning at an unobstructed location  
with a clear view that is not indoors or blocked  
by trees.  
The time needed for obtaining the position  
information may be longer and variation may  
also be larger depending on the surrounding  
environment and time of day.  
o
o
This camera recorder uses the WGS 84 World  
Geodetic System.  
Signal from GPS satellites may be interrupted by  
communication signal from electronic devices  
such as mobile phones.  
o
Make use of it in accordance with the regulations  
of the country, region or location of use.  
22 Precautions for Proper Use  
 
Rebooting  
Others  
o
o
The camera recorder is rebooted when the  
Do not insert objects other than the memory card  
following operations are performed.  
into the card slot.  
0
0
0
o
o
o
o
o
[System] B [Record Set] B [Record Format]  
[System] B [Record Set] B [Time Stamp]  
[System] B [Setup File] B[Load File] B [User  
File]/[All File]  
Do not block the vent on the unit.  
Blocking of the vent causes internal heating and  
may lead to burns and fires.  
Hot air may be discharged from the vents  
depending on the condition of use. This is not a  
malfunction.  
0
0
0
0
[System] B [Reset All]  
[Camera Process] B [Reverse Picture]  
[Network] B [Return over IP] B [Function]  
[Overlay Settings] B [Overlay Function] A  
L
Do not turn off the [POWER ON/OFF] switch or  
remove the power cable during recording or  
playback.  
The camera recorder may not show stable  
pictures for a few seconds immediately after the  
power is turned on, but this is not a malfunction.  
When the video signal output terminals are not  
in use, put on the covers to prevent damage to  
the terminals.  
0
[Overlay Settings] B [Output] A L  
o
o
Do not drop this unit or subject it to strong impact  
or vibration as it is a precision equipment.  
Optical performance of lens  
Due to the optical performance of the lens, color  
divergence phenomena (magnification  
chromatic aberration) may occur at the  
periphery of the image. This is not a camera  
malfunction.  
o
o
o
Noise may appear in the image when switching  
modes.  
If placed on its side, heat release efficiency will  
deteriorate.  
Use the supplied AC adapter as the power  
supply. Do not use the supplied AC adapter on  
other devices.  
o
o
Use the supplied power cord. And do not use the  
supplied power cord for any other devices.  
When the connectors that come with connector  
covers are not in use, put on the covers to  
prevent damage to the connectors.  
This camera recorder makes use of fonts by  
Fontworks Inc.  
o
o
o
This camera recorder makes use of M+FONTS.  
Use the built-in wireless LAN only in the country  
and region where it was purchased.  
And there are legal restrictions on the use and  
outdoor use depending on the country and  
region. Please be careful not to violate the law.  
A
Precautions for Proper Use 23  
Operation Modes  
This camera recorder has three operation modes - Camera mode, Media mode, and Remote Edit mode.  
.
Camera Mode  
Camera Input  
Media Mode  
Press and hold [MODE]  
[CANCEL]/[MENU/THUMB] Button  
Playback  
Thumbnail  
Display  
Normal Playback  
Set Button (  
Execute  
)
R
[MODE]  
Button  
Trimming Playback  
[Trim This Clip]  
Exit Trimming Operation  
[ONLINE/3] Button  
(Successful/Failed/Stopped)  
Trimming in Progress  
Exit/Cancel File Delete Operation (Successful/Failed/Stopped)  
File Deletion in Progress  
Exit FTP  
Execute [Delete Clips]  
Operation  
(Actions)  
(Successful)  
Exit/Cancel FTP Operation (Successful/Failed/Stopped)  
Execute [FTP Upload]  
Press and hold [MODE]  
FTP in Progress  
FTP in Progress  
[MODE] Button  
Upon access via a web browser and selecting [Change] on the  
[Change to Remote Edit Mode?] screen on the camera or the web browser  
Remote Edit Mode  
*
* Selecting a mode other than the Metadata Edit mode via the web  
browser, or selecting [Exit] on the [Remote Edit Mode] screen  
24 Operation Modes  
   
Operation Mode  
Camera Mode  
Description  
0
0
This is the camera shooting mode. The camera recorder starts up in Camera mode  
when the power is turned on.  
Camera images are output to the viewfinder and LCD monitor. When a recordable  
media is inserted, the camera recorder enters the recording standby mode. “STBY”  
appears on the operation mode display area of the LCD monitor and viewfinder.  
Press the [REC] trigger button to start recording.  
0
Memo :  
0
Playback of recording media is not possible in the Camera mode. However, you  
can check the most recently recorded video clip.  
0
0
Media Mode  
This mode allows you to play back or delete clips recorded on the recording media.  
When a playable recording media is inserted, the thumbnail or playback screen is  
displayed on the viewfinder and LCD monitor.  
0
Press and hold the [MODE] selection button to enter the Media mode when you  
are not shooting in the Camera mode. Once the camera recorder is in Media mode,  
thumbnails of the selected media slot are displayed.  
0
0
Remote Edit  
Mode  
This mode enables the list display and editing of the recorded clip data through  
access to the clip list display page via a web browser on a smartphone, tablet  
terminal, or PC.  
When you access via a web browser on a smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC, “It  
is necessary to change the camera mode to "Remote Edit Mode". Change the  
mode.” appears on the web browser. Also, “Change to Remote Edit Mode?” is  
displayed on the display screen of the camera unit.  
Selecting [Change] on the camera recorder and pressing the Set button switches  
to the Remote Edit mode, and enables display of the clip list and editing of the clip  
metadata.  
Memo :  
0
If you access via a web browser on devices such as a smartphone, tablet terminal,  
or PC while recording is in progress, the message appears after recording stops.  
If playback is in progress, the message appears once the files are closed  
automatically, such as when playback stops.  
0
Operation Modes 25  
     
Names of Parts  
X
W
I
A
B
V
U
J
K
L
H
G
T
S
C
R
M
Q
P
N
O
D
.
I
Wireless LAN Antenna Terminal A  
Bottom  
o
E
J
K
L
M
N
Viewfinder  
F
.
A
Shoe  
Eyecup  
For mounting separately sold lights and  
accessories.  
Prevents external light from entering the  
viewfinder screen and cameraman’s vision.  
B
Tally Lamp  
Visibility Adjustment Lever  
[x] Headphone Jack (Φ3.5 mm)  
C
D
E
Built-in Microphone  
Monitor Speaker  
Cross-Shaped Button (JKHI)/Set Button (R)  
[TC IN/OUT] switch  
0
For operating the menu and cursor and for  
confirming a setting, as well as for configuring  
the settings for time code and user’s bit.  
When a function is assigned to the cross-  
shaped button, it functions as a user button.  
O
P
[TC] TC Input/Output Terminal  
[REC] Record Trigger Button  
Starts/stops recording.  
0
Memo :  
F
G
Tripod Mounting Screw Hole  
[FIX/VAR/OFF] zoom speed switch  
This switch is interlocked with the [REC/HOLD]  
button W at the top of the handle.  
Q
[EXP.FOCUS/9] Expanded Focus Assist/User  
9 Button  
0
For switching the expanded focus ON or  
OFF.  
For switching the zoom speed of the zoom lever  
X at the handle.  
H
Accessory Mounting Screw Hole  
0
You can also use it as a user button by  
assigning a specific feature in the menu  
setting to this button.  
R
Zoom Lever at the Grip  
26 Names of Parts  
 
S
T
Hood Release Button  
External Microphone Cable Clamp  
U
V
[INPUT1/INPUT2] Audio Input Terminal 1, 2  
(XLR 3-pin x 2)  
Shoulder Belt Mount (x2)  
For mounting a shoulder belt (sold separately).  
Caution :  
0
0
0
Be sure to use a shoulder belt with the strength  
to withstand the weight of this camera recorder.  
If the shoulder belt is not properly attached, the  
camera recorder may fall and cause injuries.  
Check the [INSTRUCTIONS] provided with the  
shoulder belt before using.  
W
[REC/HOLD] Record Trigger Button/Lock  
Switch  
Starts/stops recording.  
Set the switch to [HOLD] to lock the [REC]  
Trigger button.  
Memo :  
0
This switch is interlocked with the [REC] button  
P on the grip.  
0
[REC] button P on the grip is not locked.  
X
Zoom Lever on Handle  
Names of Parts 27  
Side Control Panel  
I
[WHT BAL] White Balance Auto/Manual  
Selection Button / [B/A/PRESET] Selection  
Switch  
V
X
b Z  
a
W
Y
U
J
K
[y] One Push Auto White Balance Button  
T
S
[SHUTTER] Shutter Speed Auto/Manual  
A
B
C
Selection Button  
R
Q
P
L
M
[FULL AUTO ON/OFF] Full Auto Switch  
[MARKER/6] Marker/User 6 Button  
This button toggles ON/OFF the marker, safety  
zone, and center mark displays.  
You can also use it as a user button by assigning  
a specific feature in the menu setting to this  
button.  
D
E
F
G
O
N
H I J K  
L M  
.
A
[FOCUS AUTO/MANU] Focus Switch  
[ND FILTER] ND Filter Switch  
B
Use the ND filter to keep the lens aperture in the  
appropriate range.  
[KEYLOCK ON/OFF] Key Lock Switch  
[MODE] Camera/Media Mode Selection Button  
OFF, 1/4, 1/16, 1/64  
N
C
[PUSH AUTO/PUSH LOCK] Focus Push Auto/  
Push Lock Button  
O
P
EXT.SLOT Lamp  
Lights up in green when a media is inserted into  
EXT.SLOT, and lights up in red when the media  
is being accessed.  
D
E
[USER7] Button  
It can be assigned with a specific menu function.  
Q
[POWER ON/OFF] Lock Power ON/OFF Switch  
Turns ON/OFF the power.  
0
0
0
Hold down the lock button (blue) in the center  
to toggle ON/OFF.  
[USER8] Button  
It can be assigned with a specific menu function.  
When the power is turning OFF, “P.OFF”  
appears on the LCD monitor and viewfinder.  
Wait for 5 seconds or more to turn on the  
power again.  
F
G
H
[IRIS] Iris Auto/Manual Selection Button  
[PUSH AUTO] Iris Push Auto Button  
R
S
T
POWER/CHARGE LED  
[GAIN] Gain Auto/Manual Selection Button / [L/  
M/H] Sensitivity Selection Switch  
STATUS LED  
NETWORK LED  
28 Names of Parts  
 
U
V
Z
[ZEBRA/5] Zebra/User 5 Button  
You can also use it as a user button by assigning  
a specific feature in the menu setting to this  
button.  
[FOCUS ASSIST/1] Focus Assist/User 1 Button  
For switching the focus assist function ON or  
OFF.  
You can also use it as a user button by assigning  
a specific feature in the menu setting to this  
button.  
[MENU/THUMB] Menu/Thumbnail Button  
[AE LOCK/4] AE Lock/User 4 Button  
When Gain, Iris, and Shutter are set to “AUTO”,  
their respective values and the value of white  
balance are locked when the [AE LOCK/4] button  
is pressed.  
a
0
Displays the menu screen during Camera  
mode.  
0
Switches between [Main Menu] and  
[Favorites Menu] when the [MENU/THUMB]  
button is pressed and held down while the  
menu screen is displayed.  
You can also use it as a user button by assigning  
a specific feature in the menu setting to this  
button.  
0
Displays the menu screen when the button is  
pressed during thumbnail display in the  
Media mode.  
W
Cross-Shaped Button (JKHI)/Set Button (R)  
The function changes according to the  
operation status of the camera recorder.  
0
Stops playback and displays the thumbnail  
screen when the button is pressed during  
playback screen display in the Media mode.  
o
During menu operation (all modes)  
Set Button (R)  
:
Confirms menu items  
and setting values  
b
[CANCEL] Cancel Button  
Cancels various settings and stops playback.  
Cross-shaped Button : Selects menu items  
(JK)  
and setting values  
o
During Camera mode  
Shutter operation:  
Set Button (R)  
:
Shutter ON/OFF  
Cross-shaped Button : Switches shutter  
(JK)  
speed when shutter  
is ON  
Cross-Shaped Button : AE level operation  
(HI)  
X
[ONLINE/3] Online/User 3 Button  
0
Switches live streaming between ON/OFF.  
0
You can also use it as a user button by  
assigning a specific feature in the menu  
setting to this button. Initial setting: Live  
streaming  
Y
[OIS/2] Optical Image Stabilizer/User 2 Button  
For switching the image stabilizer feature mode  
ON or OFF.  
You can also use it as a user button by assigning  
a specific feature in the menu setting to this  
button.  
Names of Parts 29  
Rear Terminal  
E
F
Card Slot B  
[EXT.SLOT]  
SSD media adapters (sold separately) such as  
KA-MC100 can be inserted into the slot.  
G
H
Battery  
A
B
C
D
E
F
O
N
M
L
[DC] Terminal  
Input terminal for DC 12 V power supply. For  
connecting with the supplied AC adapter.  
OPEN  
K
J
I
I
J
K
L
[SDI OUT] Terminal  
[REMOTE] Terminal  
G
H
.
A
B
C
SD Card Cover  
Card Slot A  
[SLOT SEL] Button  
[LAN] Terminal  
For connecting the LAN cable.  
[HOST] USB Host Terminal  
For switching the active card slot during  
For connecting a USB adapter according to the  
intended purpose when you are connecting the  
unit to a network.  
shooting and playback.  
[BATT.RELEASE] Button  
D
M
N
[HDMI] Terminal  
[AUX] Terminal (Φ3.5 mm)  
For connecting to receiver such as wireless  
microphone.  
O
Access Lamp A/B  
30 Names of Parts  
 
LCD Monitor  
H
I
[INPUT1/INPUT2] Audio Input Signal Selection  
Switch  
K J I  
H
G
[CH2] CH2 Audio Input Signal Selection Switch  
Select the audio input terminal to record to CH2.  
CH1  
CH2  
INPUT1  
INPUT2  
MONITOR  
A
INT  
INPUT1  
INPUT2  
LINE  
MIC  
CH1  
BOTH  
CH2  
MIC  
+48V  
LCD BRIGHT PEAKING  
DISPLAY STATUS  
AUTO  
MANUAL  
J
K
[CH1] CH1 Audio Input Signal Selection Switch  
CH1  
CH2  
[CH1/CH2 AUTO/MANUAL] CH1/CH2 Audio  
Recording Mode Switch  
B
C D E F  
.
A
LCD Monitor  
Lens Section  
B
[CH1/CH2] CH1/CH2 Recording Level  
Adjustment Knob  
20x  
OPTICAL ZOOM  
FOCUS  
C
D
[LCD BRIGHT +/-] LCD Display Brightness  
Adjustment Button  
ND FILTER  
AUTO  
MANU  
1/64  
1/16  
1/4  
A
PUSH AUTO  
PUSH LOCK  
OFF  
[PEAKING +/-] LCD/VF Contour Adjustment  
Button  
I
USER7 USER8  
B C  
D E  
.
E
[DISPLAY] Display Button  
0
Press the [DISPLAY] button to switch to the  
display screen during normal screen display  
(when the menu screen is not displayed).  
A
Filter Built-In Screw  
0
Transparent or UV filter for lens protection, or  
filters for various effects can be installed.  
Installable filter types: Φ82 mm  
0
0
Switches between [Main Menu] and  
[Favorites Menu] when the [DISPLAY] button  
is pressed while the menu screen is  
displayed.  
Memo :  
0
Remove the lens hood when installing the filter.  
B
C
D
E
Lens Cover Open/Close Switch  
F
G
[STATUS] Status Screen Display Button  
Press the [STATUS] button to display the status  
screen on the viewfinder and LCD monitor  
during normal screen display (when the menu  
screen is not displayed).  
Focus Ring  
Zoom Ring  
Iris Ring  
[MONITOR]/[+/-] Audio Monitor Selection  
Switch/Volume Adjustment Button  
Switches the audio monitor and adjusts the  
monitor speaker/headphone.  
To operate auto iris, press the [IRIS] button on  
the side control panel.  
(a mark appears on the screen)  
Names of Parts 31  
   
Basic System Diagram  
.
Shoulder  
Belt  
Wireless  
Microphone  
Receiver  
GY-HC550/GY-HC500  
Headphone  
Microphone  
[INPUT1]/  
[INPUT2]  
Monitor  
Monitor  
[x]  
[AUX]  
[TC]  
SDI Cable  
GY-HC550/GY-HC500  
Wireless LAN Antenna  
[SDI OUT]  
[HDMI]  
BNC  
HDMI Cable  
A
USB Network Adapter  
Battery  
[HOST]  
(BN-VC296G)  
Battery Charger  
(AA-VC2)  
[DC]  
SSD Media Adapter  
[EXT.SLOT]  
(KA-MC100)  
AC Adapter  
Standard Package  
Tripod  
[REMOTE]  
SD Card  
SD Card Reader  
Carrying  
Case  
Remote Control Unit  
32 Basic System Diagram  
 
Opening/Closing the Lens Cover  
Settings and Adjustments  
Before Use  
Use the lens cover open/close switch to open or  
close the lens cover.  
Before shooting, open the lens cover.  
When this camera recorder is not in use, close the  
lens cover to protect the lens.  
.
Adjusting the Grip Belt  
Open the pad and adjust the position of the grip belt  
accordingly.  
Lens cover switch  
.
Caution :  
.
0
Do not press against the lens cover with force.  
Doing so may damage the lens or the cover.  
Caution :  
0
If the grip is loose, the camera recorder may fall  
off resulting in injuries or malfunction.  
Attaching the Tripod (Sold Separately)  
Use the screw hole at the bottom of this camera  
Attaching the External Microphone  
(Sold Separately)  
recorder.  
(3/8×16UNC, 1/4×20UNC)  
You can attach a separately sold microphone to the  
Use the screw hole that suits the tripod.  
To prevent the camera recorder from falling off,  
which may result in injuries or damages, read the  
“INSTRUCTIONS” of the tripod to be used and  
make sure that it is securely attached.  
microphone holder.  
1, 3  
5
2
4
5
o Bottom  
.
1
Turn the knob on the microphone holder  
counterclockwise to loosen and open the  
microphone holder.  
.
2
3
4
Place the microphone in the microphone  
Caution :  
holder.  
0
If the camera recorder exceeds the weight limit  
of the tripod, do not mount it on the tripod.  
Use the tripod on a stable surface.  
To prevent the camera recorder from falling,  
attach securely using the rotation prevention  
hole.  
Turn the knob on the microphone holder  
clockwise to secure the microphone.  
0
0
Connect the microphone cable to the  
[INPUT1] or [INPUT2] terminal.  
5
6
Pin the microphone cable to the clamp.  
Perform the settings for the microphone  
0
Use screws with screw length 5 mm and below.  
correctly.  
Settings and Adjustments Before Use 33  
         
Attaching the Wireless LAN Antennas  
Attaching/Detaching the Hood  
Attaching the Hood  
Align the markings on the camera recorder and  
hood; turn the hood in the direction of the arrow until  
it is locked.  
(Supplied) A  
Attach the wireless LAN antenna by turning it in the  
clockwise direction. Hold the base while attaching  
the antenna.  
.
Detaching the Hood  
.
While pressing the hood release button, turn the  
hood in the direction of the arrow (anti-clockwise)  
to remove it.  
Caution :  
0
Applying force to the wireless LAN antenna or  
yanking it may damage the antenna so please  
use caution when using the antenna.  
If it is damaged, replacement is chargeable even  
during the warranty period.  
(Part number: T9A-0095-00)  
0
Use the antenna holders without removing  
them.  
.
Caution :  
0
Remove the hood when attaching a filter,  
teleconverter or wide converter to the front of the  
lens.  
34 Settings and Adjustments Before Use  
   
Memo :  
Power Supply  
0
Blinking of the [POWER/CHARGE] lamp during  
charging indicates the charge level.  
[POWER/CHARGE] Lamp  
during “POWER.OFF”  
To use this camera recorder, you can attach a  
battery pack or connect an AC adapter to it.  
Charge Level  
Alternates between a blinking Less than 25 %  
orange light (4 times) and  
Caution :  
light off (1 second)  
0
Set the [POWER ON/OFF] switch to “OFF”  
before changing the power supply that operates  
this camera recorder.  
Alternates between a blinking Less than 50 %  
orange light (3 times) and  
light off (1 second)  
0
To charge the battery using a battery charger,  
purchase a genuine charger that can charge the  
recommended battery.  
Alternates between a blinking Less than 75 %  
orange light (2 times) and  
light off (1 second)  
Alternates between a blinking Less than 100 %  
orange light (blinks once) and  
light off (1 second)  
Using a Battery Pack  
Charging the Battery  
Light goes out  
Fully charged  
0
You can charge the battery even when operating  
the camera recorder using the AC adapter. The  
lamp lights up in green during “POWER.ON”.  
Charge the battery immediately after purchase or  
when the battery power is running low.  
*
The battery is not charged when purchased.  
Removing the Battery  
2
2
POWER/  
CHARGE  
4
3
ON  
ON  
1
1
OFF  
OFF  
.
.
1
Hold down the lock button (blue) at the  
center of the [POWER ON/OFF] switch to set  
to “OFF”.  
1
2
Hold down the lock button (blue) at the  
center of the [POWER ON/OFF] switch to set  
to “OFF”.  
While pressing and holding the [BATT.  
RELEASE] button, push up and remove the  
battery in the direction of the arrow.  
2
3
Attach the supplied battery.  
Slide it in until you hear a click.  
Connect the supplied AC adapter to the  
[DC] terminal.  
Open the cover of the[DC] terminal and connect  
as shown in the diagram.  
Caution :  
0
Do not remove the battery when the [POWER  
ON/OFF] switch is “ON”.  
4
Connect the AC adapter to a power outlet.  
0
The [POWER/CHARGE] lamp blinks during  
charging and will go out after charging is  
complete.  
0
Leaving the camera recorder unused with the battery  
attached will deplete the battery power even when  
you set the [POWER ON/OFF] switch to “OFF”.  
0
Remove the AC adapter after charging is  
complete.  
Remove the battery if you are not using the camera  
recorder.  
Power Supply 35  
           
Estimated Charging and Continuous  
Operating Times  
Using AC Power (DC IN Power)  
Use the supplied AC adapter to operate the camera  
o
Charging time  
recorder with AC power.  
BN-VC296G (accessory) Approx. 5 hours  
:
*
When the [POWER ON/OFF] switch is set to “OFF”  
Memo :  
0
If you charge the battery immediately after using  
while the battery is still warm, it may not be fully  
charged.  
0
It is recommended that you charge the battery  
in an environment between 10 °C and 30 °C (50  
°F and 86 °F). The battery may not be fully  
charged or the charging time may be prolonged  
if charged under low temperatures (below 10 °C/  
50 °F). In addition, charging the battery under  
high temperature (above 30 °C/86 °F) condition  
may shorten the battery life.  
POWER/  
CHARGE  
1
ON  
2
o
Continuous operating time  
OFF  
BN-VC296G (accessory) Approx. 2 hrs 40 mins  
:
.
(*1)  
Approx. 2 hrs 50 mins  
(*2)  
1
Connect the DC cable of the AC adapter to  
the [DC] terminal of the camera recorder.  
*1 When [System] is set to “4K” and all other  
0
Check that the power switch of the camera  
recorder is set to “OFF”.  
settings are in factory default  
*2 When [System] is set to “HD” and all other  
settings are in factory default  
Memo :  
0
0
Open the cover of the [DC] terminal and  
connect as shown in the diagram.  
2
Hold down the lock button (blue) at the  
center of the [POWER ON/OFF] switch to set  
to “ON”.  
Actual operating times may differ depending on  
the age of the battery, charging condition, and  
operating environment.  
0
0
Operating time is shortened in cold  
environment.  
Power will be supplied to the camera recorder.  
Caution :  
The operating time may shorten when power  
zoom is used, accessories are connected, or  
when the LCD monitor is frequently used.  
For purchase of spare batteries and battery  
charger, please contact the local dealers in your  
area.  
0
Do not insert or remove the DC cable during  
recording.  
0
0
Do not use power supply of high voltage  
fluctuation, containing noise such as ripple, or  
with insufficient capacity.  
Precautions for Batteries  
Charging the Built-In Battery  
0
Store the battery in a cool and dry place when  
not in use. Do not expose the battery to high  
temperatures (such as in a car under direct  
sunlight). Failure to do so not only shortens the  
battery life but also damages the battery.  
If the operating time shortens drastically even  
after charging, the battery may be reaching the  
end of its life. Replace the battery with a new  
one.  
0
The date/time and time code data are stored  
using the built-in rechargeable battery.  
When power is connected to the camera  
recorder, the built-in battery always gets  
charged. When the power is disconnected, the  
battery gradually discharges.  
0
0
0
The battery will be totally discharged if left  
unused for 3 months and the date/time and time  
code data will be reset. When this happens, set  
the [POWER ON/OFF] switch to “ON” to display  
the [Initial Setting] screen, then set the date/  
time.  
36 Power Supply  
       
Menu Screen  
Power Status Display  
Viewfinder Screen and LCD Monitor  
The power status is displayed on the display and  
menu screens.  
Display Settings  
Display  
Description  
B 7.4V  
B 100min  
C 30%  
4 RES  
Currently powered by a battery.  
When the battery power runs out,  
the battery mark appears hollow,  
and “RES” (yellow) is displayed.  
Memo :  
0
You can set the display using  
[LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B  
[Battery].  
.
Warnings by Lamp and Warning Tone  
Warning status is indicated by tally lamp and  
warning tone.  
F
Acquisition of battery information  
may fail if a genuine battery is not  
used.  
0
0
The tally lamp blinks.  
The warning tone is output from the monitor  
speaker or [x] terminal.  
Memo :  
T
Appears when an error occurs  
during battery charging.  
0
You can specify whether to turn on the warning  
tone as well as setting the volume in [A/V Set] B  
[Audio Set] B [Alarm Level].  
G
Currently powered by an AC  
adapter.  
P
Q
R
S
Camera recorder battery charging  
in progress.  
0
In the event that the battery level runs low while  
it is being used, the camera recorder will stop  
operating automatically.  
Caution :  
Memo :  
0
The remaining battery power and time are  
displayed as they are from the battery  
0
If the supplied battery (or equivalent battery sold  
separately) is not used, the battery mark which  
indicates the battery level may not appear.  
information. Accuratedatamaynotbedisplayed  
depending on the battery condition. Replace the  
battery as soon as possible when the remaining  
battery power and time are low.  
Display Screen  
282min  
00:00:00.00  
5 . 6 f t  
12 :34 :56  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
K
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
5600  
102400  
.
Power Status Display 37  
   
Turning Off the Power  
Turning On/Off the Power  
Turning On the Power  
Sets the camera recorder to the recording standby or  
stop mode.  
1
2
Hold down the lock button (blue) at the  
center of the [POWER ON/OFF] switch to set  
to “OFF”.  
Remove the battery and the power to the [DC]  
terminal (when not in use for a long time).  
Caution :  
0
0
0
Do not set the [POWER ON/OFF] switch to “OFF”  
during recording. Check that the operation mode  
display is “STBY” or “STOP” before you turn off the  
power.  
If you have mistakenly set the [POWER ON/OFF]  
switch to “OFF” during recording, wait for 5  
seconds or more before you turn on the power  
again.  
.
1
Hold down the lock button (blue) at the  
center of the [POWER ON/OFF] switch to set  
to “ON”.  
When turning off the power, first set the [POWER  
ON/OFF] switch of the camera recorder to “OFF”.  
Do not remove the battery or turn off the AC power  
while the [POWER ON/OFF] switch is set to “ON”.  
The camera recorder starts up in Camera mode  
and is ready for shooting.  
Memo :  
0
The camera recorder always start up in Camera  
mode when the [POWER ON/OFF] switch is set to  
“ON”. Use the [MODE] button at the side of the  
camera recorder to switch mode.  
0
The camera recorder behaves as follows when an  
AC adapter is connected.  
0
If the battery is not fully charged, the battery will  
be charged at the same time.  
0
Even when a fully charged battery is used,  
charge the battery briefly to confirm the  
remaining battery power.  
38 Turning On/Off the Power  
   
Initial Settings  
Memo :  
0
The menus and messages on the screen of the  
LCD monitor or viewfinder are displayed in the  
selected language.  
When the power is first turned on, the Initial Setting  
screen for performing the initial settings in the  
camera recorder appears.  
Set the date/time of the built-in clock in the [Date/  
Time] screen.  
2
Select a language using the cross-shaped  
button (JK), and press the Set button (R).  
A self-diagnosis screen appears.  
All operations are disabled until initial settings are  
complete.  
.
3
Ensure that the lens cover is closed, and  
press the Set button (R).  
0
Self-diagnosis starts.  
0
A progress bar appears, and “Complete  
Diagnosis” appears when the diagnosis is  
complete.  
.
Memo :  
0
It is recommended to use the AC adapter as the  
power supply.  
0
Be sure to close the lens cover.  
1
Hold down the lock button (blue) at the  
center of the [POWER ON/OFF] switch to set  
to “ON”.  
A language selection screen appears.  
0
For U models  
.
.
Memo :  
0
It takes about 6 minutes to complete the  
diagnosis. During the diagnosis, do not operate  
or turn off the camera recorder.  
0
For E models  
Language  
English  
Français  
Deutsch  
Italiano  
Español  
Pусский  
.
Initial Settings 39  
   
Changing the Time after Initial Setting  
4
Press the Set button (R) after confirming  
the exit screen.  
Setting the Date/Time  
The [Date/Time] screen appears.  
0
For U models  
1
Select [System] B [Date/Time].  
The [Date/Time] screen appears.  
2
A
Set the date and time.  
Move the cursor with the cross-shaped button  
(HI) and select the setting item.  
B
Change the values with the cross-shaped  
button (JK).  
3
Press the Set button (R) after setting is  
.
complete.  
0
For E models  
The clock is set to 0 seconds of the input date/  
time.  
Changing the Display Style  
You can change the display style of the date/time  
on the menu.  
Setting the Date Display (Date Style)  
.
The date display can be changed in [System] B  
[Date Style].  
5
Set the time zone and date/time.  
A
B
6
Move the cursor with the cross-shaped button  
(HI) and select the setting item.  
Setting the Time Display (Time Style)  
Change the values with the cross-shaped  
The time display can be changed in [System] B  
[Time Style].  
button (JK).  
Press the Set button (R) after setting is  
complete.  
The clock is set to 0 seconds of the input date/  
time.  
Date/Time Display in Each Operation  
Mode  
Memo :  
During Camera mode:  
0
The configured date/time data can be displayed  
on the LCD monitor and viewfinder screen and  
be recorded to a recording media.  
Time of the built-in clock is displayed.  
During Media mode:  
Shooting date/time of the clip being played back is  
displayed.  
0
0
The value of the year can be set in the range of  
“2000” to “2099”.  
The configured date/time data is saved in the  
built-in battery even if the power is turned off.  
40 Initial Settings  
 
Display Screen (VF/LCD) in Media Mode  
Displays on the LCD  
0
Monitor and Viewfinder  
This is the screen display during clip playback in  
Media Mode.  
0
The display switches with every press of the  
[DISPLAY] button.  
You can display the camera status, recording  
media information, zebra pattern, and various  
markers in the video image on the LCD monitor and  
viewfinder screen during shooting.  
(Display off B Display on B Display off)  
Memo :  
0
When [A/V Set] B [Video Set] B [SDI OUT] B  
[Character] is set to “On”, the display screen and  
menu screen are also displayed in the video  
image of the video signal output terminal.  
Display Off  
Display Screen  
1000/2000  
282min  
3840x2160  
30p 140M  
00:00:00.00  
Jan 24,2019  
12 :34 :56  
Display Screen (VF/LCD) in Camera Mode  
0
0
The display switches with every press of the  
[DISPLAY] button.  
4030 20 10  
0
(Display off B Display on B Display off)  
Press the [STATUS] button to switch to the  
status screen.  
Display On  
.
Display Off  
282min  
00:00:00.00  
5 . 6 f  
12 :34 :56  
t
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
K
5600  
1
ISO  
102400  
F2. 8  
B
Display On  
.
Displays on the LCD Monitor and Viewfinder 41  
     
Status Screen  
Remote Edit Mode Screen  
0
This screen allows you to check the current  
This is a mode for accessing the page for editing  
the metadata that is recorded in a clip via a web  
browser on devices such as a smartphone, tablet  
terminal, or PC.  
settings.  
0
0
0
To display the status screen, press the  
[STATUS] button in the normal screen.  
Press the [STATUS] button again to return to the  
normal screen.  
Press the [MENU/THUMB] button at each status  
screen (other than the [Camera] screen) to enter  
the setting screen.  
0
Use the cross-shaped button (HI) to switch  
between the screens.  
Remote Edit Mode  
USER Switch Set  
Exit  
.
Warning Display  
Warning display is displayed in the display screen  
(Camera mode, Media mode).  
00:00:00.00  
5 . 6 f t  
Camera  
12 :34 :56  
LCD/VF  
Record Format  
Audio  
Video  
Planning Metadata  
Network  
Connection Setup  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
K
5600  
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
102400  
Warning Display Area  
.
Streaming  
.
*
These are screen examples. The contents  
displayed are different depending on the model  
and settings.  
42 Displays on the LCD Monitor and Viewfinder  
       
Adjusting the LCD Monitor  
Adjusting the LCD Monitor  
and Viewfinder  
You can monitor video images on this camera  
recorder using the viewfinder, LCD monitor, or  
both.  
LCD BRIGHT PEAKING  
3
Tilt 90 degrees downward  
2
Normal LCD  
Inverted  
DISPLAY  
LCD  
Tilt 180 degrees  
upward  
1
.
.
1
2
Open the LCD cover.  
Incline the LCD monitor to a position that  
Displays on the LCD Monitor and  
Viewfinder Screen (VF)  
enables easy viewing.  
Rotate the LCD monitor to adjust the angle.  
0
While the LCD monitor is open, you can  
rotate it 180 degrees upward or 90 degrees  
downward.  
LCD Monitor Status  
LCD closed Normal LCD OFF  
Inverted LCD ON  
LCD opened Normal LCD ON  
Inverted LCD ON  
LCD Display VF Display  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
0
Rotating the LCD monitor 180 degrees  
upward enables you to see the screen from  
the lens side. To display the image when it is  
viewed from the opposite direction (mirror  
image), perform setting as follows.  
Set [LCD/VF] B [LCD Mirror] to “Mirror” B Set  
button (R)  
Memo :  
0
Press and hold the [DISPLAY] button for 2 seconds  
to turn ON/OFF the LCD monitor.  
0
The function to switch between LCD monitor and  
viewfinder displays by pressing the [DISPLAY]  
button can be canceled by opening/closing or  
rotating the LCD monitor.  
3
Adjust the brightness, contour, and  
contrast of the LCD monitor.  
You can change the angle and brightness of the  
LCD monitor according to your usage condition.  
Changing the brightness of the screen will not  
affect the recorded images.  
Adjusting the LCD Monitor and Viewfinder 43  
     
Adjusting the Viewfinder  
Adjusting the Brightness  
You can change the brightness and peaking of the  
viewfinder screen according to your usage  
conditions.  
Use the [LCD BRIGHT +/-] button to adjust the  
brightness of the LCD monitor.  
0
0
0
The [+] button brightens the monitor and the  
[-] button darkens it.  
Changing the brightness of the screen will not  
affect the recorded images.  
Press the [+] and [-] buttons simultaneously  
to return to standard settings.  
During adjustment, the brightness level is  
displayed on the LCD monitor.  
1
ꢅꢄꢁ  
PEAKING  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
ꢀꢁ ꢂꢁ ꢃꢁ ꢄꢁ  
K
5600  
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
102400  
.
Adjusting the Contour  
Use the [PEAKING +/-] button to adjust the  
contour of the LCD monitor.  
(The contour of the viewfinder screen will also  
be adjusted.)  
2
.
0
The [+] button increases contour correction  
and the [-] button decreases contour  
correction.  
Caution :  
0
A high-definition viewfinder is used on this  
camera recorder in order to provide an accurate  
focusing environment. Due to the characteristic  
of the display device, colors may appear on the  
images when you blink your eyes. This is not a  
malfunction. It does not affect the recorded  
images, SDI output, or HDMI output.  
0
0
Press the [+] and [-] buttons simultaneously to  
return to standard settings.  
During adjustment, the contour level is  
displayed on the LCD monitor.  
ꢅꢁ  
1
Incline the viewfinder vertically to a  
position that enables easy viewing.  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
ꢀꢁ ꢂꢁ ꢃꢁ ꢄꢁ  
K
5600  
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
102400  
.
2
Turn the visibility adjustment lever to  
adjust the visibility.  
Adjusting the Contrast  
Turn the visibility adjustment lever to sharpen  
the image on the viewfinder screen.  
Use the [LCD Contrast] menu to adjust the  
contrast of the LCD monitor.  
3
Adjust the brightness, contour, and  
contrast of the viewfinder screen.  
0
Adjust using [LCD/VF] B [LCD Contrast].  
0
Increasing the value increases the contrast.  
[Setting Values: +10 to -10] (Default value: 0)  
44 Adjusting the LCD Monitor and Viewfinder  
       
Adjusting the Brightness  
Use the [VF Bright] menu to adjust the  
brightness of the viewfinder screen.  
0
Adjust using [LCD/VF]B[VF Bright].  
0
Increasing the value increases the  
brightness. [Setting Values: +10 to -10]  
(Default value: 0)  
Adjusting the Contour  
Use the [PEAKING +/-] button to adjust the  
contour of the viewfinder screen.  
The contour of the LCD monitor will also be  
adjusted.  
Memo :  
0
When [LCD/VF] B [LCD + VF] is set to “Off”,  
operate after switching to the viewfinder display  
by pressing the [DISPLAY] button for 2 seconds  
or longer.  
Adjusting the Contrast  
Use the [VF Contrast] menu to adjust the  
contrast of the viewfinder screen.  
0
Adjust using [LCD/VF] B [VF Contrast].  
0
Increasing the value increases the contrast.  
[Setting Values: +10 to -10] (Default value: 0)  
Displaying in Black and White  
You can display the viewfinder screen in black  
and white.  
0
[LCD/VF] B [VF Color] item B Press Set  
button (R) B “Off” Select B Press Set button  
(R).  
Adjusting the LCD Monitor and Viewfinder 45  
 
Assignment of Functions  
to User Buttons  
EXP.FOCUS/9  
FOCUS ASSIST/1  
OIS/2  
ONLINE/3  
You can assign functions to the following buttons  
and use them as user buttons.  
By assigning functions to the buttons, the usability  
of the camera recorder can be enhanced.  
Perform settings in the menu items corresponding  
to each button.  
AE LOCK/4  
ZEBRA/5  
MARKER/6  
Button  
Menu Item  
USER7 USER8  
[FOCUS ASSIST/1] Button USER1  
[OIS/2] Button  
USER2  
USER3  
USER4  
USER5  
USER6  
USER7  
USER8  
USER9  
.
[ONLINE/3] Button  
[AE LOCK/4] Button  
[ZEBRA/5] Button  
[MARKER/6] Button  
[USER7] Button  
1
Assign functions to the buttons from the  
menu.  
Configure each item to the user buttons in  
[Camera Function] B [User Switch Set].  
[USER8] Button  
[EXP.FOCUS/9] Button  
Memo :  
0
Operations of the user buttons are interlocked  
with the menu settings.  
Front Cross-Shaped Button USER10 ▲  
0
When the menu screen is displayed, these  
buttons function as the menu operation buttons.  
([J])  
Front Cross-Shaped Button USER11 ▼  
([K])  
Front Cross-Shaped Button USER12 ◀  
([H])  
Front Cross-Shaped Button USER13 ▶  
([I])  
46 Assignment of Functions to User Buttons  
   
0
Tally Lamp Behavior  
Tally Lamp and LED  
[Tally Lamp] Setting  
This is the indicator lamp for recording, warning  
and network.  
Rec/Live  
Live  
Rec  
External Off  
Streaming  
Streaming  
The operation changes according to the menu  
settings.  
J
Warning  
Alarm  
Recording  
-
-
-
o
Camera  
Recorder  
Status  
*
Set using [System] B [Tally Lamp]/[NETWORK  
LED]/[STATUS LED].  
R
R
-
-
During live  
R
-
-
-
streaming  
R
R
Input from  
Remote  
PROGRAM  
PREVIEW  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Control Unit  
Tally lamp  
0
NETWORK LED Behavior  
[NETWORK LED] Setting  
On  
Off  
o
(Green)  
(Red)  
(Red)  
Activating  
Warning  
During live streaming  
-
-
-
J
R
Waiting for live streaming  
R
R
(Orange)  
-
-
connection  
(Orange)  
Error during live streaming  
NETWORK LED  
STATUS LED  
0
STATUS LED Behavior  
[STATUS LED] Setting  
REC/  
Return  
over IP  
External  
Off  
Pre Rec  
o
(Green)  
Activating  
Warning  
-
-
.
J
(Red)  
R
(Green)  
(Red)  
On Pre Rec standby  
Recording  
-
-
-
-
-
-
R
Remaining space in media  
R
(Orange)  
running low  
-
-
-
(Only during recording)  
R
(Red)  
R
PROGRAM  
-
-
-
-
-
-
Input from  
Remote  
PREVIEW  
Control Unit  
(Green)  
R
(Green)  
R
(Orange)  
Return over IP in Progress  
Error during Return over IP  
-
-
-
-
-
-
R
J :  
o
:
Lights up  
Flashes rapidly  
Blinks slowly  
:
Tally Lamp and LED 47  
 
Usable SSD Media  
Refer to the “Instruction Manual” of the SSD Media  
Adapter that is inserted into [EXT.SLOT] for steps  
to mount the SSD media.  
Recording Media  
This camera recorder saves recorded audio sound  
and videos except those in “4K EXT (SSD)” quality  
to the SD card (sold separately) in the card slot.  
Audio sound and videos in “4K EXT (SSD)” will be  
recorded to the SSD media (sold separately) in the  
KA-MC100 SSD Media Adapter (sold separately)  
that is inserted into the [EXT.SLOT].  
Caution :  
0
Please refer to the product information page on  
our website for a list of SSD media that have  
been tested for compatibility.  
Estimated Recordable Time of SD Cards  
Usable Cards  
The estimated recordable time is only a guide.  
Differences may occur depending on the SD card  
in use and the battery condition.  
Format Setting and Usable SD Card  
Combinations  
0
The recordable time varies according to the  
settings in [System], [WFormat], [WResolution],  
[WBit Rate] and [YResolution].  
Usable SD  
System  
Format  
Bit Rate  
Card  
High-  
Speed  
70M (XHQ),  
50M (XHQ),  
50M (XHQ),  
35M (UHQ)  
UHS-I U3 or  
higher  
System  
Format  
Resolution  
4K  
QuickTime (H.264)  
3840x2160  
4K  
150M,  
150M  
70M  
QuickTime  
(H.264)  
Bit Rate  
150M  
70M  
150M  
6
12  
8 GB  
16 GB  
6
12  
13  
26  
HD  
UHS-I U1 or  
higher, or Class  
10 or higher  
70M (XHQ),  
32 GB  
25  
50  
100  
199  
399  
25  
50  
100  
200  
401  
53  
64 GB*  
128 GB*  
256 GB*  
512 GB*  
106  
212  
424  
848  
50M (XHQ),  
50M (XHQ)  
35M (UHQ)  
QuickTime  
(MPEG2),  
35M (HQ), 25M  
*
SDXC  
(Unit: minute)  
MXF (MPEG2) (SP)  
UHS-I U1 or  
higher, or Class  
6 or higher  
A
SD,  
HD  
Exchange  
12M (LP),  
HD,  
HD+Web  
(Web)  
(U model)  
8M (LP)  
System  
Format  
HD+Web (HD)  
+Web  
MP4  
12M (LP),  
8M (LP)  
(Web)  
(H.264)  
(E model)  
QuickTime (H.264)  
720x  
SD  
Web  
-
-
-
-
UHS-I U1 or  
higher, or Class  
4 or higher  
1920x  
1080  
1920x1080,  
480,  
720x  
576  
960x  
540  
480x  
270  
Resolution  
1280x720  
Caution :  
XHQ  
XHQ  
0
Using cards other than those from Panasonic,  
TOSHIBA or SanDisk may result in recording  
failure or data loss.  
Bit Rate  
UHQ  
HQ  
HQ  
LP  
(70M) (50M)  
8 GB  
16 GB  
32 GB  
64 GB*  
128 GB*  
256 GB*  
512 GB*  
13  
26  
52  
105  
210  
420  
839  
18  
36  
73  
147  
295  
590  
1180  
25  
51  
103  
207  
415  
832  
1664  
96  
194  
391  
785  
1572  
3147  
274  
556  
1119  
2243  
4495  
588  
1190  
2396  
4804  
9626  
8998 19270  
6297 18004 38557  
*
SDXC  
(Unit: minute)  
48 Recording Media  
       
Estimated Recordable Time of SSD  
Media  
System  
Format  
HD  
QuickTime  
(MPEG2)  
A
,
Exchange,  
The estimated recordable time is only a guide.  
Differences may occur depending on the SSD  
media in use and condition of the battery.  
MXF  
MP4 (H.264)  
(MPEG2)  
A
0
The recordable time varies according to the  
settings in [System], [GFrame Rate], and  
[GBit Rate].  
1920x1080,  
Resolution  
1440x1080, 1440x1080 1920x1080  
1280x720  
1280x720  
Bit Rate  
8 GB  
16 GB  
HQ  
25  
51  
103  
206  
412  
825  
1651  
SP  
35  
70  
141  
283  
566  
1133  
2267  
LP (12M)  
68  
139  
279  
580  
1121  
2245  
4482  
LP (8M)  
97  
197  
396  
794  
1592  
3186  
6376  
System  
Format  
Resolution  
Frame Rate  
Bit Rate  
500 GB  
1 TB  
4K EXT (SSD)  
ProRes  
3840x2160  
32 GB  
60p  
422  
50  
101  
201  
30p  
50p  
422  
60  
121  
241  
25p  
64 GB*  
128 GB*  
256 GB*  
512 GB*  
422HQ  
34  
67  
422LT 422HQ  
422LT  
86  
173  
346  
72  
144  
289  
40  
80  
161  
2 TB  
134  
Frame Rate  
Bit Rate  
500 GB  
1TB  
*
SDXC  
(Unit: minute)  
422HQ 422  
422LT 422HQ 422  
422LT  
172  
345  
Memo :  
67  
134  
268  
100  
201  
402  
24p  
144  
288  
576  
80  
161  
321  
120  
240  
481  
0
If the SD card contains files recorded by devices  
other than this camera recorder or files that are  
saved from a PC, the recordable time may be  
shorter or data may not be properly recorded.  
For each file format, up to 600 clips can be  
recorded to one SD card on this camera  
2TB  
690  
Frame Rate  
Bit Rate  
500 GB  
1 TB  
0
422HQ 422  
422LT  
180  
359  
84  
167  
335  
125  
251  
502  
recorder. When 600 clips are recorded to one  
card, the remaining space is displayed as 0 min  
regardless of the estimated recordable time,  
and no further recording can be performed.  
When [System] is configured to “High-Speed”,  
the remaining time display for recording to the  
SD card will run out faster than usual.  
2 TB  
719  
(Unit: minute)  
0
Memo :  
0
The maximum continuous recording time of “4K  
EXT (SSD)” is 4 hours. Recording stops upon  
exceeding 4 hours.  
Write-Protect Switch on the SD Card  
A
Slide the write-protect switch upward to enable  
writing or deleting.  
B
Slide the write-protect switch downward to  
prevent writing or deleting. (Images in the card  
are protected.)  
Write-Protect Switch  
A
B
Write/Delete Enabled  
Write/Delete Disabled  
.
Recording Media 49  
   
Inserting an SD Card  
Removing the SD Card  
This camera recorder comes with two card slots  
(Slot A and B) for video/audio recording and  
playback.  
1
Check that the SD card to be removed is not  
being accessed (status indicator of the  
card slot lights up in red).  
2
3
Open the SD card cover.  
Push the SD card and remove it from the  
slot.  
4
Close the SD card cover.  
Memo :  
0
When both slots are inserted with usable SD  
cards, the previously selected slot is used.  
Caution :  
0
Data may be lost if you turn off the power of the  
camera recorder or remove the SD card when it  
is being accessed. All data recorded on the  
card, including the file that is being accessed,  
may be corrupted. Be sure to check whether the  
status indicator is lit in green or turned off before  
you turn off the power or remove the SD card.  
If you mistakenly remove the card when it is  
being accessed, reinsert the card only after the  
status indicator goes off.  
.
1
2
Open the SD card cover.  
Insert an SD card into the slot with the  
notched corner of the card on the right.  
The status indicator of the card slot to which the  
card was inserted lights up in red.  
0
0
3
Close the SD card cover.  
The SD card may not be recognized if you insert  
and remove the card within a short time. When  
this happens, remove the card and wait for a few  
seconds before you reinsert.  
Card Slot Status Indicator  
The following table shows the respective states of  
slot A and B.  
Lamp  
Lights up in  
Slot Status  
The inserted SD card is being  
accessed. (writing/reading data)  
Do not turn off the power of the  
camera recorder or remove the SD  
card.  
red  
Lights up in  
green  
On standby. The inserted SD card  
can be used for recording or  
playback.  
0
0
0
Light goes out  
SD card is not inserted.  
An unusable card is inserted.  
An SD card is inserted but a  
different slot is selected.  
50 Recording Media  
 
Switching the SD cards  
Formatting (Initializing) of Recording  
Media  
When both card slots are inserted with SD cards,  
you can use the [SLOT SEL] button to switch the  
card to use.  
When any of the following recording media (SD  
card or SSD media) is inserted, [!FORMAT]  
appears in the remaining level display area.  
Format the card using the camera recorder menu.  
When the memory on an SD card is full during  
recording, datarecordingautomaticallyswitchesto  
the other card.  
0
0
Unformatted recording media  
Recording media formatted under different  
specifications  
Memo :  
0
The [SLOT SEL] button is disabled during  
recording or playback. Cards will not be  
switched even if you press the button.  
*
For details of the menu operation, refer to  
Inserting the SSD Media Adapter  
This camera recorder comes with an [EXT.SLOT]  
for recording and playing audio sound and videos  
in “4K EXT (SSD)” quality.  
Caution :  
0
Be sure to format the recording media on this  
camera recorder. Recording media formatted  
on a PC or other peripheral equipment cannot  
be used on this camera recorder.  
0
[!RESTORE] appears in the remaining level  
display area when a recording media that  
requires repair is inserted.  
1
Select [System] B [Media] B [Format  
Media].  
2
Select the slot of the card to be formatted  
and press the Set button (R).  
2
.
1
2
3
4
Turn off the camera recorder.  
Detaching the Battery  
Open the EXT.SLOT cover.  
With the USB terminal of the SSD Media  
Adapter facing down, insert it into  
[EXT.SLOT].  
.
3
The status of the selected recording media  
is displayed.  
Insert it all the way until the tab locks into place.  
4
Select [Format] and press the Set button  
5
6
7
Close the EXT.SLOT cover.  
Attach the battery.  
Turn on the camera recorder.  
(R).  
Format Media  
Format  
Cancel  
4
Set  
.
Recording Media 51  
   
5
2
Formatting starts.  
Select the recording media to be restored  
and press the Set button (R).  
Formatting...  
2
.
6
Formatting is complete.  
.
When formatting is complete, “Complete” appears  
and the camera recorder returns to the [Format  
Media] screen.  
3
Restoring starts.  
Memo :  
0
The menu cannot be operated while formatting  
is in progress, but recording is possible to the  
slot where formatting is not executed.  
Formatting cannot be performed in the following  
cases.  
Restoring...  
0
0
When recording to the recording media to be  
formatted is in progress.  
0
.
SD card is not inserted.  
0
Write-protect switch of the SD card is set (z  
4
Restoring is complete.  
is displayed).  
0
When restoring is complete, “Complete”  
appears and the camera recorder returns to the  
[Restore Media] screen.  
Caution :  
0
If you format a recording media, all data  
recorded to it, including video data and setup  
files, will be deleted.  
0
When no media that requires restoring is  
inserted, the camera recorder returns to the  
[Media] menu screen.  
Repairing the Recording Media  
It is necessary to restore the recording media if an  
abnormality occurs to the data in the recording  
media due to some reasons.  
Caution :  
0
[Restore Media] can only be selected in Camera  
mode. However, it cannot be selected while the  
camera recorder is recording. Select [Restore  
Media] in Camera mode when the camera  
recorder is not recording.  
Memo :  
0
[!RESTORE] appears in the remaining level  
display area when a recording media that  
requires repair is inserted.  
0
0
[Restore Media] does not restore the SD card to  
its original states completely. If restoring fails,  
replace or format the recording media. Take  
note that formatting erases all the information  
inside the SD card.  
1
Select [System] B [Media] B [Restore  
Media].  
Restoring cannot be performed in the following  
cases.  
0
Camera recorder is recording in progress.  
0
SD card is not inserted.  
0
Write-protect switch of the SD card is set (z  
is displayed).  
52 Recording Media  
 
Example: QuickTime  
Clips Recorded to Recording Media  
Folders Created in the Recording Media  
ABCG0001  
Clip Number  
The captured image is recorded into different  
folders according to the [Format] settings.  
A number in automatic  
ascending order is assigned in  
the recording order.  
0
0
Other than MXF (MPEG2): [DCIM]  
MXF (MPEG2): [PRIVATE]A  
Memo :  
The Clip Number can be reset in  
the menu.*  
0
By formatting (initializing) the recording media  
from the [Format Media] menu on the camera  
recorder, folders required for recording in the  
current [System] settings will be generated.  
When the [System] settings and [WFormat]/  
[YFormat] settings are changed, folders  
required for recording in those settings will be  
automatically generated.  
Clip Name Prefix (any four alphanumeric characters)  
This is set to “xxxG” (“xxx” denotes the last 3  
digits of the serial number) by default.  
.
0
*
[Clip Set] B [Reset Clip Number]  
Memo :  
0
Before recording starts, you can set any  
characters for the clip name prefix by using  
[System] B [Record Set] B [Clip Set] B [Clip  
Name Prefix].  
Changes cannot be made after recording.  
Caution :  
0
When a clip inside the folder is moved or deleted  
using the Explorer (Windows) or Finder (Mac),  
recording to the recording media may fail if  
formatting (initializing) of the media is not  
performed.  
0
Recorded Clips  
Clip (Recorded Data) and Clip Name  
0
The recorded materials may be split into several  
files but they can be played back continuously  
on the camera recorder.  
0
When recording is stopped, the images, audio  
and accompanying data which are recorded  
from start to stop are recorded as one “clip” on  
the recording media.  
0
Clips may be recorded across the two SD cards  
in card slots A and B depending on the recording  
time of the clip.  
0
An 8-character clip name is automatically  
generated for the recorded clip.  
Caution :  
(“Clip Name Prefix” + “Clip Number”)  
0
A clip recorded across several SD cards cannot  
be played back continuously. Continuous  
playback is only possible when the recording is  
made on one card.  
Recording Media 53  
   
Operation lock does not apply to the following  
buttons and switches.  
About the Operation Lock  
Feature (KEYLOCK)  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
[POWER ON/OFF] switch  
[ND FILTER] switch  
[TC IN/OUT] switch  
Focus Ring  
You can use this feature to prevent erroneous  
camera operation.  
Zoom Ring  
Iris Ring  
Zoom Lever at the Grip  
Zoom Lever on Handle  
[FIX/VAR/OFF] switch  
Memo :  
0
Operation lock does not apply to the REC button  
if “Keylock Except Rec” is selected in [Camera  
Function] B [KEYLOCK].  
.
1
Set the [KEYLOCK] switch to “ON”.  
0
The operation lock turns on, and an operation  
lock icon (r) appears on the display  
screen.  
0
The operation lock function is turned off when  
the [KEYLOCK] switch is set to “OFF”.  
Memo :  
0
The operation lock feature is only valid in the  
Camera mode.  
0
The following remote operations are possible  
even when the operation lock feature is turned  
on (“On”).  
0
Remote operation from the wired remote  
control connected to the [REMOTE] terminal.  
0
Remote operation of the camera through  
access via a browser on devices such as a  
smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC.  
54 About the Operation Lock Feature (KEYLOCK)  
   
Shooting  
Basic Shooting  
Procedures  
1
Configure the video and audio input  
settings.  
You have to configure video settings such as  
brightness adjustment (iris, gain, shutter) and  
white balance adjustment in order to start  
shooting. You also have to adjust the audio  
input settings and audio recording level for  
audio recording.  
Setting up  
4
0
Adjusting the Brightness  
0
Adjusting the White Balance  
4
0
Adjusting Audio Input Settings and  
Recording Level  
2
2
1
Press the [REC] button to start recording to  
the recording media  
3
2
The tally lamp lights up in red during recording.  
0
Zoom Operation  
0
Adjusting the Focus  
.
Memo :  
1
Supply battery or AC adapter power to the  
camera recorder.  
0
If both SD card slots A and B are loaded with  
recordable SD cards in the factory default state,  
pressing the [REC] button starts recording only  
to the media in the selected slot.  
2
3
Insert the recording media  
Configuring [System] B [Record Set] B [Slot  
Mode] to “Dual” enables recording to be  
performed simultaneously to the SD cards in  
both slots A and B.  
Turn on the power of the camera recorder.  
Setting the [POWER ON/OFF] switch to “ON”  
starts up the camera recorder in the Camera  
mode to enable shooting.  
The tally lamp can be turned off in [System] B  
[Tally Lamp].  
0
4
5
Adjust the angle of the LCD monitor and  
viewfinder.  
3
Check the most recently captured images.  
0
Set [System], [Format], [Resolution],  
[Frame Rate] and [Bit Rate] in [System] B  
[Record Set] B [Record Format].  
Press the user button that is assigned with  
the Clip Review function. Doing so activates  
the function and plays back the most recently  
captured images on the LCD monitor and  
viewfinder screen.  
0
You can select the definition of the recorded  
videos, file format for recording/playback,  
and the video recording format on this  
camera recorder.  
0
After playback, the camera recorder returns  
to standby mode (STBY).  
0
Press the [MENU/THUMB] button to display  
the menu screen on the LCD monitor and  
viewfinder.  
Basic Shooting Procedures 55  
   
You can select a definition for the recorded images  
from the following items under [System].  
Selecting System  
Definition, File Format and  
Video Format  
You can select the definition of the recorded  
videos, file format for recording/playback, and the  
video recording format on this camera recorder.  
0
0
0
0
0
4K EXT (SSD):  
Performs 4K EXT recording in EXT.SLOT.  
4K:  
Records in 4K quality for both slots A and B.  
HD:  
Records in HD quality for both slots A and B.  
SD:  
Records in SD quality for both slots A and B.  
HD+Web:  
Records in HD quality for slot A, and Web quality  
for slot B.  
Setting the Record Format Menu  
1
Set [System], [Format], [Resolution],  
[Frame Rate] and [Bit Rate] in [System] B  
[Record Set] B [Record Format].  
0
High-Speed:  
Records in HD quality for both slots A and B.  
2
Set each of the items.  
A
B
C
D
Selecting a File Format  
Select a file format in [WFormat]/[YFormat].  
The following file formats are available for  
selection.  
0
0
0
0
0
QuickTime (MPEG2):  
QuickTime file format (.MOV)  
MXF (MPEG2):  
3
After setting is complete for all items, press  
the [[FOCUS ASSIST/1] button.  
MXF file format  
0
0
The recording format is switched.  
QuickTime (H.264):  
A “Please Wait...” message appears on the  
screen during switching.  
QuickTime file format (.MOV)  
Exchange: (U model only)  
Sports Video Interop Group format (.MP4)  
MP4 (H.264): (E model only)  
MP4 file format  
Selecting a System Definition  
The following definitions are available for selection.  
Memo :  
0
0
0
4K EXT:  
0
When [System] is set to “4K EXT (SSD)”, this  
item is fixed at “ProRes”.  
Records in 4K resolution (3840x2160)  
4K:  
0
Exchange (U model) and MP4 (E model) are  
selectable only when [System] is configured to  
“HD”.  
Records in 4K resolution (3840x2160)  
HD:  
Records in HD (High Definition) resolution  
(1920x1080, 1440x1080 or 1280x720)  
SD:  
0
When Exchange (U model) or MP4 (E model) is  
selected, backup recording and clip cutter  
function cannot be used.  
0
0
Records in SD (Standard Definition) resolution  
(720x480 or 720x576)  
Web:  
Records in resolution (960x540, 720x480,  
720x576, or 480x270) suitable for web  
distribution  
0
High-Speed:  
Records in HD resolution (1920×1080)  
56 Selecting System Definition, File Format and Video Format  
         
o
When [System] is set to “HD” or “HD+Web”, the  
options for slot A are:  
Selecting a Video Format  
The selectable [Frame Rate]/[Bit Rate] changes  
according to the settings of [System]/[Format]/  
[Resolution].  
Record Format  
W
Format  
W
W
Frame  
W
Bit Rate  
Resolution  
Rate  
QuickTime 1920x1080 60i, 50i,  
35M (HQ)  
List of Formats  
(MPEG2),  
MXF  
30p, 25p  
1440x1080 60i, 50i  
The following is a list of file formats and video  
formats that can be selected on this camera  
recorder.  
35M (HQ),  
25M (SP)  
35M (HQ)  
(MPEG2)  
A
1280x720  
60p, 50p  
o
When [System] is set to “4K EXT (SSD)”  
QuickTime 1920x1080 60p, 50p  
Record Format  
(H.264)  
70M (XHQ),  
G
Format  
G
G
Frame  
G
Bit Rate  
Resolution  
Rate  
50M (XHQ),  
50M (XHQ)  
ProRes  
3840x2160 60p, 50p,  
422HQ,  
422,  
30p, 25p,  
24p  
60i, 50i,  
30p, 25p,  
24p  
422LT  
50M (XHQ),  
50M (XHQ),  
35M (UHQ)  
Memo :  
0
0
0
[Rec Mode] is fixed at “Normal”.  
[Slot Mode] is fixed at “----”.  
1280x720  
60p, 50p  
The following functions cannot be used when 4K  
EXT (SSD) is selected.  
50M (XHQ),  
35M (UHQ)  
12M (LP)  
8M (LP)  
12M (LP)  
8M (LP)  
View Remote, Live Streaming, Return over IP or  
Overlay Function  
Exchange  
(U model)  
1920x1080 60p  
1280x720  
1920x1080 50p  
1280x720  
o
When [System] is set to “4K”  
Record Format  
MP4  
(H.264)  
(E model)  
W
Format  
W
Resolution  
W
Frame  
W
Bit Rate  
Rate  
3840x2160 30p,  
Memo :  
QuickTime  
(H.264)  
0
0
0
When [System] is set to “HD”, each item for slot  
B is fixed at the same setting as slot A.  
When [System] is set to “HD+Web”, [Format] is  
fixed at “QuickTime(H.264)”.  
25p,  
24p  
150M,  
150M, 70M  
Memo :  
When [WFormat] is configured to “Exchange” or  
“MP4(H.264)”, selection is possible only when  
[System] is configured to “HD”.  
0
The following functions cannot be used when 4K  
is selected.  
View Remote, Live Streaming, Return over IP or  
Overlay Function  
0
The following functions cannot be used when  
HD+Web is selected.  
0
Each item for slot B is fixed at the same setting  
as slot A.  
View Remote, Live Streaming or Return over IP  
Selecting System Definition, File Format and Video Format 57  
 
o
o
When [System] is set to “High-Speed”  
Record Format  
When [System] is set to “SD”  
Record Format  
W
Format  
W
W
Frame  
W
Bit Rate  
W
Format  
W
W
Frame  
W
Bit Rate  
Resolution  
Rate  
Resolution  
Rate  
QuickTime 1920x1080 120/60p,  
QuickTime 720x480  
60i  
8M (HQ)  
(H.264)  
100/50p  
(H.264)  
(U model)  
70M (XHQ),  
720x576  
Memo :  
50i  
(E model)  
50M (XHQ),  
50M (XHQ)  
0
The following function cannot be used when SD  
120/30p,  
100/25p,  
120/24p  
is selected.  
50M (XHQ),  
50M (XHQ),  
35M (UHQ)  
Overlay Function  
0
Each item for slot B is fixed at the same setting  
as slot A.  
Memo :  
0
0
0
o
When [System] is set to “HD+Web”, the options  
for slot B are:  
[Rec Mode] is fixed at “Normal”.  
[Slot Mode] is fixed at “Series”.  
The following functions cannot be used when  
High-Speed is selected.  
Record Format  
Y
Format  
Y
Y
Frame  
Y
Bit Rate  
View Remote, Live Streaming, Return over IP,  
Upload of recorded clip, time stamp recording,  
Face Detection or Overlay Function  
The settings for slot B are fixed at the same as  
slot A.  
Resolution  
Rate  
QuickTime 960x540  
30p, 25p, 24p 3M (HQ)  
(H.264)  
720x480  
720x576  
480x270  
60i  
50i  
8M (HQ)  
0
0
0
0
Only “Rec Run” and “Regen” are the only TC  
generator settings available.  
30p, 25p, 24p 1.2M (LP)  
Memo :  
0
It is not possible to set a shutter speed that is  
slower than the frame rate.  
The following functions cannot be used when  
HD+Web is selected.  
The angle of view shifts to telephoto.  
(35 mm conversion: [Normal] 28.0 mm to 560.0  
mm B [High-Speed] 56.1 mm to 1122 mm)  
The sensitivity of high speed shooting is lower  
than normal shooting. In order to capture more  
beautiful images, it is recommended to perform  
shooting in a lighted environment.  
View Remote, Live Streaming or Return over IP  
0
0
Selecting the Aspect Ratio of SD Videos  
For setting the aspect ratio of the SD recording  
image when [System] is set to “SD”.  
You can select “16:9” or “4:3”.  
The remaining space on the media (recordable  
time to the recording media) runs out faster than  
usual.  
Memo :  
0
(Example: For 120/60p, as the recording speed  
is twice as fast as usual, the remaining space on  
the media is reduced by approximately double  
the speed.)  
For conditions other than those above, this item  
is fixed at “16:9”.  
58 Selecting System Definition, File Format and Video Format  
 
Using Zoom Ring at the Lens Section  
Zoom Operation  
Adjusts the angle of view.  
You can adjust the preferred angle of view by  
turning the zoom ring.  
Optical zoom ratio: 1x to 20x  
Dynamic zoom ratio: 1x to 40x  
Setusing[CameraFunction] B [Zoom] B [Dynamic  
Zoom].  
Saving/Recalling Current Zoom  
Position (Preset Zoom)  
This allows you to register up to three zoom  
Zooming can be operated using the following.  
positions.  
1
Assign the “Preset Zoom1”, “Preset  
Zoom2”, or “Preset Zoom3” function to any  
of the user buttons.  
0
0
0
Zoom Lever at the Grip  
Zoom Lever on Handle  
Zoom Ring at the Lens Section  
During the zoom operation, the zoom bar or  
number will appear on the upper right corner of the  
screen.  
Caution :  
2
3
Save the current zoom position.  
0
Depending on the zoom speed, the zoom drive  
0
Press any of the user buttons assigned with  
the “Preset Zoom1”, “Preset Zoom2”, or  
“Preset Zoom3” function for more than 1  
second.  
noise of the power zoom may be recorded.  
Using the Zoom Lever at the Grip  
Press the zoom lever to zoom.  
0
The current zoom position will be stored.  
1
Recall the stored zoom position.  
0
0
0
The zoom speed changes according to the  
extent the zoom lever is being pushed.  
Zooms into wide angle and increases the  
angle of view when “W” is pressed.  
0
Press any of the user buttons assigned with  
the “Preset Zoom1”, “Preset Zoom2”, or  
“Preset Zoom3” function and release within 1  
second.  
Zooms into telephoto and decreases the  
angle of view when “T” is pressed.  
0
The camera recorder zooms to the stored  
zoom position.  
Memo :  
Using the Zoom Lever at the Handle  
0
Set the speed for shifting to the preset zoom  
position and the rate of change for starting and  
stopping the preset zoom operation in [Camera  
Function] B [Zoom] B [Preset Zoom] B [Speed]/  
[Ease In]/[Ease Out].  
1
Set the [FIX/VAR/OFF] zoom speed switch  
to “FIX” or “VAR”.  
Memo :  
0
Setting to “FIX” will allow the zoom operation to  
move at the speed set in [Handle Zoom Speed].  
Operating other zoom maneuvers during a  
zoom position recall will cancel the recall.  
0
0
Set the zoom speed using [Camera  
Function] B [Zoom] B [Handle Zoom Speed].  
2
Press the zoom lever at the handle to zoom.  
Memo :  
0
When the [FIX/VAR/OFF] zoom speed switch is  
set to “OFF”, the zoom lever at the handle  
section cannot be used.  
Zoom Operation 59  
           
Locking the Focus  
Focus Operation  
While in the Auto Focus mode, pressing the [PUSH  
LOCK] button locks the focus on the corresponding  
point.  
Adjusting Focus Automatically  
An  
icon appears when the focus is locked.  
1
Set the [FOCUS AUTO/MANU] switch to  
“AUTO”.  
The auto focus icon e appears on the screen.  
Memo :  
0
Performing any focusing operation when the  
focus is locked disengages the focus lock.  
Memo :  
0
When [Camera Function] B [Focus] B [AF  
Assist] is configured to “Direction”, it is possible  
to move the auto focus point by turning the focus  
ring.  
Adjusting Focus Manually  
1
Set the [FOCUS AUTO/MANU] switch to  
“MANU”.  
The manual focus icon d appears on the  
0
The AF area can be configured in [Camera  
Function] B [Focus] B [AF Area]. Selecting  
“Multi” displays a “Multi” icon, while selecting  
“Wide” shows a “Wide” icon.  
screen.  
00:00:00.00  
5 . 6 f t  
12 :34 :56  
One Push Auto Focus  
ꢀꢁ ꢂꢁ ꢃꢁ ꢄꢁ  
K
5600  
B
.
While in the Manual Focus mode, pressing the  
[PUSH AUTO] button (within 1 minute) makes the  
camera recorder focus on the center of the frame  
automatically.  
2
Turn the focus ring to adjust the focus.  
Memo :  
0
Using the Focus Assist or Expanded Focus  
Memo :  
function makes it easier to focus.  
0
Face detection does not work during One Push  
Auto Focus.  
Pressing the [PUSH AUTO] button in the Manual  
Focus mode activates the One-push Auto Focus  
mode, while holding down the [PUSH AUTO]  
button activates the Push Auto Focus mode.  
0
0
AF Assist does not function.  
0
When the operation is complete, the camera  
recorder returns to the Manual Focus mode  
automatically.  
0
One Push Auto Focus functions with emphasis  
on the focusing speed. This function is not  
suitable during recording.  
Setting to Auto Focus Temporarily  
(Push Auto Focus)  
0
The camera recorder will shift to Auto Focus  
mode temporarily and automatically adjusts  
focus when the [PUSH AUTO] button is pressed  
during shooting in Manual Focus mode.  
Release the [PUSH AUTO] button to return to  
Manual Focus mode.  
0
Memo :  
0
Face detection does not work during Push Auto  
Focus.  
60 Focus Operation  
       
AF Assist Function  
Focus Assist Function  
0
Configure this function to move the auto focus point  
closer to or away from the camera or to activate MF  
temporarily by turning the focus ring.  
When the [F.ASSIST/1] button is pressed during  
shooting, the focused area is displayed in color.  
This enables easy and accurate focusing.  
Select the color (blue, red or green) in the menu.  
0
Set [Camera Function] B [Focus] B [AF Assist].  
0
0
Direction:  
Memo :  
0
This option allows you to shift the auto focus  
point to near and far directions by turning the  
focus ring during AF.  
When [LCD/VF] B [Shooting Assist] B [Focus  
Assist] B [Type] is set to “ACCU-Focus”, the  
depth of field becomes shallower to enable  
easier focusing.  
Focus is automatically adjusted to a focus  
point near the position where the focus ring  
stops turning.  
0
0
0
The “ACCU-Focus” function switches  
automatically to “Off” after about 10 seconds.  
Select the display color in [LCD/VF] B [Shooting  
Assist] B [Focus Assist]B[Color].  
Manual:  
Temporarily activates MF when the focus ring  
is turned during AF. The camera recorder  
returns to the AF mode when the focus ring is  
not operated for a some time.  
0
If you use the zebra function and the Focus  
Assist function at the same time, it may be  
difficult to see the effect of the Focus Assist. In  
this case, turn off the zebra function.  
MF Assist Function  
This function activates AF operation for a short  
interval when the focus ring is turned during MF.  
0
Set [Camera Function] B [Focus] B [MF Assist].  
0
Setting Focus Assist Function to a User Button  
YoucanassigntheFocusAssistfunctiontoauser  
button.  
On:  
Turning the focus ring during MF activates AF  
for a short interval after the operation, after  
which the camera recorder returns to the MF  
mode.  
Focus Assist + Function  
0
You can operate the Focus Assist and  
Expanded Focus functions simultaneously by  
pressing the user button assigned with “Focus  
Assist +”.  
Memo :  
0
“Expanded Focus” is displayed during the  
“Focus Assist +” operation regardless of the  
setting in [Camera Function] B [User Switch  
Set] B [Expanded Focus].  
Focus Operation 61  
   
Expanded Focus Function  
You can magnify the preferred area by pressing the  
[EXP.FOCUS/9] button; doing so enables precise  
focus to be established easily.  
Adjusting the Focusing by  
Face Detection  
This function detects human faces and  
automatically adjusts focus during Auto Focus.  
It can also track moving objects.  
*
You can also use the user button assigned with  
the “Expanded Focus” function instead of the  
[EXP.FOCUS/9] button.  
When several faces are detected, you can select  
one to focus on.  
Memo :  
0
This function can also adjust the brightness  
automatically according to the brightness of the  
face detected.  
1
Press the [EXP.FOCUS/9] button.  
0
The center area of the screen is enlarged for  
the first time.  
0
For subsequent operation of the button, the  
area at which the operation was last  
performed will be enlarged.  
.
.
2
Use the cross-shaped button (JKH I) to  
magnify the preferred area.  
0
The portion that is being magnified is  
displayed at the lower right corner of the  
screen.  
3
Press the [CANCEL] button to cancel the  
setting.  
Memo :  
0
The display of the enlarged screen is dot by dot  
equivalent.  
0
To set the operation when the button is pressed,  
go to [Camera Function] B [User Switch Set] B  
[Expanded Focus].  
0
0
0
0
0
Pressing and holding the Set button (R) resets  
the position of magnification.  
This function can be used together with the  
Focus Assist function.  
Magnifying an image does not alter the size of  
the recorded image.  
The cross-shaped button cannot be used as  
user button while the area is being magnified.  
This function is unavailable when [System] B  
[Record Set] B [Record Format] B [System] is  
set to “SD”.  
0
When the display screen is turned off, the  
magnified area at the bottom right of the screen  
will not be displayed.  
62 Focus Operation  
   
Selecting Specific Person from Several  
Persons  
1
2
Assign the “Face Detection” function to any  
of the user buttons.  
1
Hold down the user button that is assigned  
with “Face Detection”.  
0
Focus the camera recorder on a person and  
press the user button that is assigned with  
“Face Detection”.  
The camera recorder will enter face selection  
mode and the face detection icon (q) will  
blink.  
0
An orange frame will appear on the face of  
the person nearest to the center of the  
screen. Blue frames will appear on the faces  
of others.  
0
When Face detection is enabled, the face  
detection icon (q) appears.  
0
An orange frame will appear on the face of  
the person nearest to the center of the  
screen. Blue frames will appear on the faces  
of others.  
Detection Frame (Orange)  
0
Focus will be automatically adjusted for the  
selected person.  
Memo :  
0
When the button assigned with “Face Only AF”  
or the [Camera Function] B [Face Detection] B  
[Face Only AF] item is configured to “On”,  
“ONLY” appears to the right of the face detection  
icon, and auto focus functions only when a face  
is detected. When a face cannot be detected,  
the camera recorder switches manual focusing.  
Blinking  
Detection Frame (Blue)  
.
2
Select a specific person.  
0
Use the cross-shaped button (HIJK) to  
select a person.  
Detection Frame (Orange)  
0
An orange frame will appear on the face of  
the selected person and focus will be  
automatically adjusted.  
Detection Frame (Orange)  
.
Memo :  
0
If the detection frame does not appear, make  
sure that Auto Focus mode is selected. Also, if  
[Face Detection] is set to “AF&AE”, set at least  
one of the iris, gain, and electronic shutter  
control items to the automatic adjustment mode.  
Detection Frame (Blue)  
.
3
Press the Set button (R) to confirm the  
person for face detection.  
Memo :  
0
0
0
Press the [CANCEL] button to cancel the  
selection.  
A face can be selected by turning the focus ring  
without entering the face selection mode.  
The detection sensitivity and duration for  
maintaining the current focus after losing sight  
of the face can be configured in [Camera  
Function] B [Face Detection] B [Sensitivity]/  
[Holding Duration].  
Adjusting the Focusing by Face Detection 63  
Memo :  
0
Adjusting the Brightness  
Setting the [FULL AUTO] switch to “ON” to enter  
the Full Auto mode also activates the automatic  
brightness adjustment (AE) mode. In this case,  
white balance is also switched forcibly to auto  
mode.  
Adjust the brightness using Iris, Gain, Shutter  
speed and ND filter according to the brightness of  
the object.  
0
0
The convergence speed of the automatic  
adjustment for automatic brightness adjustment  
(AE) can be set in the menu.  
Adjusting the Brightness Automatically:  
Automatic Brightness Adjustment (AE)  
Mode  
If one or more of the items (Gain, Iris and  
Shutter) have been set to Auto mode, the value  
of the corresponding items when the user button  
that is assigned “AE Lock” is pressed can be  
fixed.  
Iris, Gain, Shutter speed and ND filter are  
automatically adjusted according to the brightness  
of the object to maintain optimum brightness.  
To set only the Iris, Gain and Shutter to Auto mode,  
set the [FULL AUTO] switch to “OFF” before setting  
each item to the automatic adjustment mode.  
0
If one or more of the items (Gain, Iris and  
Shutter) have been set to Auto mode, the  
automatic brightness adjustment (AE) mode is  
enabled.  
1
Set Gain, Iris and Shutter to Auto mode.  
0
0
0
2
Set the target level (brighter/darker) to  
maintain optimum brightness during  
automatic adjustment.  
Adjusting the Brightness Manually  
When the [FULL AUTO] switch is set to “OFF”,  
some or all of the items (Iris, Gain and Shutter) can  
be manually adjusted.  
0
This can be configured using the cross-  
shaped button (HI) on the side of the camera  
recorder unit.  
1
2
Set the [FULL AUTO] switch to “OFF”.  
Adjust the Iris, Gain and Shutter speed.  
0
This can be configured in [Camera  
Function] B [AE Level].  
0
0
0
00:00:00.00  
5 . 6 f t  
12 :34 :56  
Memo :  
0
The brightness cannot be manually adjusted in  
the Full Auto mode.  
0
If Iris, Gain and Shutter Speed are manually  
adjusted, the [AE Level] setting is temporarily  
disabled.  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
ꢀꢁ ꢂꢁ ꢃꢁ ꢄꢁ  
K
5600  
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
102400  
.
64 Adjusting the Brightness  
     
3
Adjusting the Iris  
Turn the iris ring on the lens to adjust the  
iris manually.  
Adjust the aperture of the lens iris according to the  
The open F-number of the aperture varies  
according to the zoom position.  
brightness of the subject.  
Wide [W] end  
Tele [T] end  
:
:
F2.8  
F4.5  
Auto Iris (Automatic Adjustment) Mode  
F-number  
Decrease  
Description  
1
2
Set the [FULL AUTO] switch to “OFF”.  
The subject appears brighter.  
The focused range becomes  
sharper, while the background is  
blurred to produce a soft image.  
The subject appears darker.  
Background of image becomes  
focused as well.  
Press the [IRIS] button to set to the Auto Iris  
mode.  
The iris is automatically adjusted according to  
the brightness of the object.  
Increase  
Memo :  
A a icon appears on the left side of the lens  
aperture value (F-number) during Auto Iris  
mode.  
Memo :  
0
0
Pressing the [PUSH AUTO] button in the Manual  
Iris mode activates the One-push Auto Iris  
mode, while holding down the [PUSH AUTO]  
button activates the Push Auto Iris mode.  
Setting the [FULL AUTO] switch to “ON” to enter  
Full Auto mode also activates the Auto Iris  
mode. In this case, the Gain, Shutter and White  
Balance also enter into Auto mode forcibly.  
The iris open/close limit can be set in [Camera  
Function] B [Auto Iris Limit (OPEN)][Auto Iris  
Limit (CLOSE)] during Auto Iris.  
0
One Push Auto Iris  
When the camera recorder is in Manual Iris mode,  
press the [PUSH AUTO] button to adjust the iris  
according to the brightness of the object.  
The control target level (brighter/darker) of the  
auto iris can be configured using the cross-  
shaped button (HI) on the side of the camera  
recorder unit or in [Camera Function] B [AE  
Level].  
0
Push Auto Iris  
When the camera recorder is in the Manual Iris  
mode, press and hold the [PUSH AUTO] button to  
change to the Auto Iris mode temporarily. The iris  
will be automatically adjusted according to the  
brightness of the subject.  
0
0
The convergence speed of the auto iris can be  
set in the menu.  
While in the Auto Iris mode, and [AE/FAW  
About the Iris F-number  
Lock] is set to “AE” or “AE/FAW”, a  
icon  
Blurry effects due to “small aperture diffraction”  
may occur when the diameter of the iris becomes  
too small. When this phenomenon occurs, the F-  
number on the screen turns gray to warn you that  
the diffraction F-number of the iris has been  
exceeded.  
appears on the left side of the lens aperture  
value (F-number) during lock operation.  
Manual Iris (Manual Adjustment) Mode  
The aperture value (F-number) of the lens can be  
You are recommended to make appropriate use of  
ND filters to prevent the F-number from turning  
gray.  
set manually.  
1
2
Set the [FULL AUTO] switch to “OFF”.  
Press the [IRIS] button to set to the Manual  
Iris mode.  
The lens aperture value (F-number) is  
displayed.  
00:00:00.00  
5 . 6 f t  
12 :34 :56  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
ꢀꢁ ꢂꢁ ꢃꢁ ꢄꢁ  
K
5600  
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
102400  
.
Adjusting the Iris 65  
     
Manual Gain Mode (Manual Gain  
Switching)  
Setting the Gain  
1
2
This function electrically boosts the light sensitivity  
when there is insufficient illumination on the object.  
You can set the gain of the video amplifier  
according to the brightness of the object. Select the  
setting mode according to your shooting  
conditions.  
Set the [FULL AUTO] switch to “OFF”.  
Press the [GAIN] button to set to the manual  
gain mode, followed by selecting the [GAIN  
L/M/H] switch  
0
Use the [GAIN L/M/H] switch to display the  
gain of the selected video amplifier.  
The gain level appears on the screen.  
The a icon on the screen disappears.  
0
0
00:00:00.00  
5 . 6 f t  
12 :34 :56  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
ꢀꢁ ꢂꢁ ꢃꢁ ꢄꢁ  
K
5600  
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
102400  
.
.
0
The default positions of the switch are as  
follows.  
Automatic Gain Mode (Automatic Gain  
Adjustment)  
[L]  
[M] : 6dB  
[H] 12dB  
:
0 dB  
1
2
Set the [FULL AUTO] switch to “OFF”.  
:
Press the [GAIN] button to set to the AGC  
mode.  
Memo :  
The gain of the video amplifier is automatically  
set according to the brightness of the subject.  
A a icon appears on the left side of the gain  
value in the AGC mode.  
0
You can change the gain value of each position  
in the menu. Increasing the sensitivity causes  
the screen to appear grainier.  
Memo :  
0
Setting the [FULL AUTO] switch to “ON” to enter  
the Full Auto mode also activates the Auto Gain  
mode. In this case, the Iris, Shutter and White  
Balance also enter into Auto mode forcibly.  
The switching operation of the [GAIN L/M/H]  
switch is disabled in the Full Auto mode.  
The upper limit of the gain setting value during  
AGC operation can be set in [Camera  
Function] B [AGC Limit].  
0
0
0
While in the Auto Gain mode, and [AE Lock] is  
set to “AE” or “AE/FAW”, a  
icon appears on  
the left side of the gain value during lock  
operation.  
66 Setting the Gain  
     
Manual Shutter Mode (Manual Shutter  
Switching)  
Setting the Electronic  
Shutter  
You can change the shutter speed (time for each  
shooting frame) using the electronic shutter  
function. Electronic shutter can be adjusted  
manually or automatically.  
1
2
Set the [FULL AUTO] switch to “OFF”.  
Press the [SHUTTER] button to set to the  
Manual Shutter mode.  
0
0
The a icon on the screen disappears.  
Use the Set button (R) to switch between the  
shutter modes and the cross-shaped button  
(JK) to switch between the speeds.  
Automatic Shutter Mode (Automatic  
Shutter Adjustment)  
00:00:00.00  
1
2
Set the [FULL AUTO] switch to “OFF”.  
5 . 6 f t  
12 :34 :56  
Press the [SHUTTER] button to set to the  
Automatic Shutter mode.  
0
0
The a icon appears on the screen.  
Automatic Shutter mode adjusts the shutter  
speed automatically according to the  
brightness of the object.  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
ꢀꢁ ꢂꢁ ꢃꢁ ꢄꢁ  
K
5600  
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
102400  
.
3
Set the controllable range for the Automatic  
Shutter in [Camera Function] B [EEI Limit].  
Switching Shutter Mode  
Press the Set button (R) to turn ON/OFF the  
shutter.  
Memo :  
Memo :  
0
0
0
Setting the [FULL AUTO] switch to “ON” to enter  
the Full Auto mode also activates the Automatic  
Shutter mode. In this case, the Iris, Gain and  
White Balance also enter into Auto mode  
forcibly.  
0
When the shutter is ON, configure the [Camera  
Function]B[Shutter] item to “Step” or “Variable”.  
“Step” is the factory default.  
In the Automatic Shutter mode, switching of  
shutter speed with the cross-shaped button (J  
K) at the side of the camera recorder and  
switching of shutter mode with the Set button (R)  
are disabled.  
Switching Shutter Speed  
When the shutter is ON, use the cross-shaped  
button (JK) to configure the shutter speed. The  
settable shutter speed range differs according to  
the video format setting.  
While in the Automatic Shutter mode, and  
[AE/FAW Lock] is set to “AE” or “AE/FAW”, a  
Memo :  
icon appears on the left side of the shutter speed  
during lock operation.  
0
To display Shutter in angle (DEG), set [WFrame  
Rate] to “25p” or “24p” and set [LCD/VF] B  
[Display Type] B [Shutter] to “DEG”.  
Setting the Electronic Shutter 67  
       
After the shutter speed indication turns white, the  
setting value can be changed using the cross-  
shaped button (JK).  
Setting the ND Filter  
o
For “Step”  
Use the ND filter to keep the lens aperture in the  
appropriate range.  
Frame Rate  
Shutter  
Speed  
60p,  
60i,  
30p  
50p,  
50i,  
25p  
120/60p,  
120/30p,  
120/24p  
100/50p,  
100/25p  
24p  
1/10000  
1/4000  
1/2000  
1/1000  
1/500  
1/250  
1/120  
1/100  
1/60  
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
*
-
c
*
.
c
*
-
-
Switch according to the brightness of the object.  
When the position on the switch is changed, the  
selected position of the ND filter is displayed on the  
LCD monitor and viewfinder screen.  
1/50  
-
-
c
*
-
-
1/48  
-
-
c
*
-
-
1/30  
c
-
-
-
-
1/25  
-
-
c
-
-
-
00:00:00.00  
1/24  
c
-
-
-
5 . 6 f t  
1/15  
c
-
-
-
-
12 :34 :56  
1/12.5  
1/12  
c
-
-
-
-
ND 1/16  
-
c
-
-
-
1/7.5  
1/6.25  
1/6  
c
-
-
-
-
AE  
/ 60  
ND1/16  
F2. 8  
0
ꢀꢁ ꢂꢁ ꢃꢁ ꢄꢁ  
c
-
-
-
K
5600  
1
ISO  
B
102400  
.
-
-
c
-
-
Memo :  
*
o
When the shutter is set to OFF  
For “Variable”  
0
It is recommended to use the ND filter to set the  
lens aperture to less than F11.  
Frame Rate  
60p,  
60i,  
30p  
1/9860  
1/60.00  
1/30.00  
50p,  
50i,  
25p  
ND Filter Warning Display  
Shutter Speed  
24p  
In order to adjust the amount of light when you are  
shooting at a relatively bright location, the diameter  
of the iris may become extremely small, causing  
blurry effects to occur as a result.  
Upper limit  
(Default value)  
Lower limit  
1/10118  
1/50.00  
1/25.00  
1/9860  
1/48.00  
1/24.00  
This phenomenon is known as “small aperture  
diffraction”. You can make appropriate use of ND  
filters to prevent it from occurring.  
Frame Rate  
120/60p,  
Shutter Speed  
100/50p,  
100/25p  
120/30p,  
120/24p  
This unit displays an ND filter warning when  
necessary to prompt you to select an appropriate  
ND filter.  
Upper limit  
(Default value)  
Lower limit  
Memo :  
0
1/9860  
1/120.0  
1/120.0  
1/10118  
1/100.0  
1/100.0  
1
Set [LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B [ND  
Filter] to “Normal + Assist”.  
When the iris diameter becomes too small  
while adjusting the light intensity, or when  
an ND filter is used in a dimly-lit location,  
the ND filter display starts blinking.  
The operations of the cross-shaped button  
(JK) and Set button (R) are disabled in the  
following cases.  
2
0
During clip preview  
0
During display of the formatting confirmation  
screen  
0
When selecting a face using face detection  
0
When selecting a photometry area with [Spot  
Meter] set to “Manual”  
0
During expanded focus  
68 Setting the Electronic Shutter  
   
Memo :  
0
Adjusting the White  
Balance  
Setting the [FULL AUTO] switch to “ON” to enter  
the Full Auto mode also activates the Automatic  
White Balance mode. In this case, the Iris, Gain  
and Shutter also enter into Auto mode forcibly.  
When [Camera Function] B [User Switch Set] B  
[AE Lock] is set to “AE/FAW” or “FAW”, the white  
balance when the user button that is assigned  
with [AE Lock] is pressed can be fixed while in  
the Automatic White Balance mode.  
Adjust the white balance according to the color  
temperature of the lighting. You can select the  
adjustment mode according to the shooting  
conditions.  
0
As the color of the light (color temperature) varies  
according to the light source, it is necessary to  
readjust the white balance when the main light  
source illuminating the subject changes.  
0
If [White Balance] is assigned to the user button,  
pressing the assigned user button will display  
the FAW Paint Adjustment screen.  
FAW Paint Adjustment  
You can fine-adjust the white balance that was  
automatically adjusted.  
GAIN  
WHT BAL  
SHUTTER  
1
Select [Camera Process] B [White  
Balance] B [FAW Paint] and press the Set  
button (R).  
L
B
A
M
H
PRESET  
The FAW Paint Adjustment screen appears.  
.
White Balance  
Automatic White Balance Mode (FAW:  
Fulltime Auto White balance)  
1
2
Set the [FULL AUTO] switch to “OFF”.  
Press the [WHT BAL] button to set to  
Automatic White Balance mode.  
FAW Paint  
1
0
0
“FAW” appears on the screen.  
White balance switching with the [WHT BAL  
B/A/PRESET] selection switch is disabled.  
.
2
Adjust the R and B values.  
Caution :  
0
Use the cross-shaped button (JK) to adjust R  
value and (HI) to adjust B value.  
The accuracy of [FAW] is inferior to that of [AWB]  
(Auto White Balance).  
0
When the power of the camera recorder is  
turned on with the [FAW] mode selected, it takes  
about 15 seconds for the colors to stabilize.  
R
B
.
Adjusting the White Balance 69  
     
Setting the [Preset Temp.] or [Alternative  
Temp.] Values  
3
Press the Set button (R).  
Returns to the [White Balance] screen.  
You can change both the color temperature  
settings in the Preset mode in the menu.  
White Balance  
1
Open the [Preset Temp.] or [Alternative  
Temp.] menu.  
0
Select [Camera Process] B [White Balance]  
B [Preset Temp.] and [Alternative Temp.],  
and press the Set button (R).  
R Value  
FAW Paint  
0
The Color Temperature setting screen  
appears.  
B Value  
.
Manual White Balance Mode (Manual  
Switching)  
1
2
Set the [FULL AUTO] switch to “OFF”.  
Press the [WHT BAL] button to set to  
Manual White Balance mode.  
0
Color Temperature  
Detailed Selection  
Use the [WHT BAL B/A/PRESET] selection  
switch to select “PRESET” (preset mode), “A”  
(memory A mode), or “B” (memory B mode).  
Color Temperature Selection Screen  
Screen  
.
Memo :  
2
Select the color temperature.  
0
0
This is fixed at “FAW” when the [FULL AUTO]  
switch of the camera recorder is set to “ON”.  
The FAW (Full Time Auto White Balance) mode  
makes automatic adjustments by sampling the  
color temperature of the video to obtain the most  
appropriate white balance level.  
When selecting from a setting value (Color  
Temperature Selection screen), use the  
cross-shaped button (JK) to select the color  
temperature.  
0
[Setting Values: 7500K, 6500K, 5600K,  
5200K, 4800K, 4200K, 3200K, 3000K,  
2800K]  
0
To select detailed values (Color  
Temperature Detailed Selection screen)  
Preset Mode (PRESET)  
0
Press the cross-shaped button (I) to  
0
Two different color temperature settings are  
registered on this camera recorder. You can  
switch between them using the [y] button or  
the user button assigned with the “AWB”  
function.  
display the Color Temperature Detailed  
Selection screen.  
0
Use the cross-shaped button (JK) to  
select a color temperature.  
[Setting Values: 2300K to 15000K (in  
100K increments)]  
Default setting:  
[Preset Temp.]  
:
3200K  
Memo :  
0
[Alternative Temp.] : 5600K  
Use the cross-shaped button (I) to switch  
between the Color Temperature Selection  
screen and the Color Temperature Detailed  
Selection screen.  
1
2
Set the [WHT BAL] switch to “PRESET”.  
Press the [y] button or the user button  
assigned with the “AWB” function  
0
If [White Balance] is assigned to the user button,  
pressing the assigned user button will display  
the Color Temperature Selection screen.  
0
The color temperature switches.  
(“Preset Temp.”1“Alternative Temp.”)  
70 Adjusting the White Balance  
 
Preset Paint Adjustment  
The white balance for [Preset Temp.] and  
[Alternative Temp.] can be fine adjusted  
individually or collectively.  
4
5
Locate a place with similar lighting conditions  
as the object to be shot, place a white object  
near the center of the screen and zoom in to  
fill the screen with white.  
Press the [  
y
] button or the user button  
1
Select [Camera Process] B [White  
Balance] B [Preset Paint Memory].  
assigned with the “AWB” function  
0
The white detection frame appears when Auto  
White Balance is activated. Fill the frame with  
white completely.  
0
0
“Common” configures the settings for the  
entire color temperature range collectively.  
“Individual” configures the settings for the 9  
types of color temperature individually.  
0
WhileAutoWhiteBalanceisstartingup, “A  
y
or “B  
y
” appears on the screen. (  
y
mark  
appears blinking)  
2
Select [Camera Process] B [White  
Balance] B [Preset Paint].  
0
After the correct white balance is obtained, an  
estimated value of the current color  
temperature is displayed.  
0
0
The adjustment screen appears if “Common”  
is selected.  
The lower color temperature limit of the color  
temperature range is displayed if “Individual”  
is selected. Select the color temperature to  
adjust.  
120/60fps  
1080 /30p  
282min  
00:00:00.00  
100min  
50min  
5 . 6 f t  
12 :34 :56  
White Detection  
Frame  
In the case of 2300K for example, the target  
range is 2300K to 2900K (less than 3000K)  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
102400  
3
4
Adjust the R and B values.  
0
Use the cross-shaped button (JK) to adjust  
[AWB] Activating  
R value and (HI) to adjust B value.  
Blinking  
Press the Set button (R).  
120/60fps  
1080 /30p  
282min  
100min  
50min  
00:00:00.00  
0
In the case of “Common”, the display returns  
to the [White Balance] screen.  
As for “Individual”, repeat steps 1 to 4 as  
necessary to configure each color  
temperature individually.  
5 . 6 f t  
12 :34 :56  
0
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
K
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
5600  
102400  
Memory A Mode (A), Memory B Mode  
(B)  
Result Display  
.
Caution :  
0
Set to the white balance saved in Memory A or  
0
Do not use highly reflective objects, such as  
metals. Doing so may result in improper white  
balance adjustment.  
Memory B.  
0
When the [WHT BAL B/A/PRESET] selection  
switch is set to “A” or “B”, pressing the [y]  
button or the user button assigned with the  
“AWB” function executes Auto White Balance.  
White balance will be automatically adjusted  
and the adjusted value will be saved in Memory  
A or Memory B.  
0
The Auto White Balance function cannot provide  
optimum white balance with an object outside the  
adjustment range, for example when it contains  
only a single color or not enough white color.  
1
Prepare the camera recorder.  
A
B
C
2
Set the [POWER ON/OFF] switch to “ON”.  
Set the [FULL AUTO] switch to “OFF”.  
Press the [IRIS] button to set to the Auto mode.  
Set the [ND FILTER] switch according to the  
lighting.  
3
Set the [WHT BAL B/A/PRESET] selection  
switch to “A” or “B”.  
Adjusting the White Balance 71  
 
Error Message  
3
Press the Set button (R).  
If the Auto White Balance adjustment is not  
correctly completed, one of the following  
messages will appear for about 3 seconds.  
Returns to the [White Balance] screen.  
White Balance  
Message  
Status  
R Value  
Auto White * NG: Displayed when there is not  
Object  
enough white color on the  
object, or when the color  
temperature is not suitable.  
Use another white object and  
adjust the white balance  
again.  
AWB Paint  
(*A or B)  
B Value  
.
Auto White * Error: Displayed when the lighting is  
Low Light  
(*A or B)  
dark. Increase the lighting  
and adjust the white balance  
again.  
Memo :  
0
Executing Auto White Balance will usually clear  
the White Paint Adjustment value. But when  
[Camera Process] B [White Balance] B [Clear  
Paint After AWB] is set to “Off”, values will not  
be cleared even when Auto White Balance is  
executed.  
Auto White * Error: Excessive illumination.  
Over Light  
(*A or B)  
Displayed when the lighting is  
too bright. Decrease the  
lighting and adjust the white  
balance again.  
If [White Balance] is assigned to the user button,  
pressing the assigned user button will display  
the AWB Paint Adjustment screen.  
0
White Paint Adjustment  
You can fine-tune the white balance saved in  
Memory A or Memory B.  
1
Select [Camera Process] B [White  
Balance] B [AWB Paint] and press the Set  
button (R).  
The White Paint Adjustment screen appears.  
White Balance  
AWB Paint  
1
.
2
Adjust the R and B values.  
Use the cross-shaped button (JK) to adjust R  
value and (HI) to adjust B value.  
R
B
.
72 Adjusting the White Balance  
   
Adjusting the Camera  
Image  
Using the Image Stabilizer  
Reduces blurring of images due to camera shake.  
1
Check whether the image stabilizer feature  
is turned ON or OFF.  
The picture quality of the camera can be set using  
the [Camera Process] menu.  
If the image stabilizer icon (i/j) does not  
appear on the screen display, the image  
stabilizer function is OFF.  
As the adjustments are shown on the screen, you  
can adjust the values while checking the picture  
quality on the camera.  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
00:00:00.00  
[Color Space]  
[Gamma]  
[Detail]  
[Master Black]  
[Black Toe]  
[Knee]  
[White Clip]  
[White Balance]  
[Color Matrix]  
[Color Gain]  
[Reverse Picture]  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
K
5600  
1
O  
F2. 8  
B
102400  
.
2
Press the [OIS/2] button to turn ON the  
image stabilizer feature (when image  
stabilizer feature is OFF).  
The image stabilizer feature switches between  
ON and OFF with every press of the [OIS/2]  
button.  
Memo :  
0
OFF:  
0
For details of the respective items, see the  
Use this setting when the camera recorder is  
[Camera Process] menu.  
secured, such as when using a tripod.  
0
ON:  
Reduces blurring of images due to camera  
shake.  
Memo :  
0
Select [Camera Function] B [OIS] B [Level] to  
set the correction level.  
0
0
0
Correction by this feature may not be sufficient  
when camera shake is too strong.  
“OIS” is assigned to the [OIS/2] button in factory  
default.  
“OIS” can also be assigned to other user  
buttons.  
About the Hard Lock Feature  
Use this feature when blurry image caused by  
camera shake tends to occur due to strong  
acceleration.  
It can be used to lock the IS (image stabilization)  
lens in place.  
1
Press the [OIS/2] button to turn off the  
Image Stabilizer function  
2
Set [Camera Function] B [OIS] B [Hard  
Lock] to “On”.  
Memo :  
0
Camera shake that causes image blur occurs  
when switching between On and Off.  
Adjusting the Camera Image 73  
       
Setting Input Channel to [INPUT1]/[INPUT2]  
Audio Recording  
Select the audio to input to [INPUT1] and [INPUT2]  
terminals with the [INPUT1]/[INPUT2] mode  
switch.  
You can record audio from the two channels (CH1/  
CH2) in synchronization with video images on this  
camera recorder.  
Setting  
[LINE]  
Description  
Select from the options below to record the audio.  
Use this setting when connecting to  
an audio device or other equipment.  
The reference input level is +4 dBu.  
0
0
0
0
Built-in Microphone  
Microphone connected to [AUX] terminal  
Microphone connected to [INPUT1] terminal  
Microphone connected to [INPUT2] terminal  
[MIC]  
Use this setting when connecting to  
a dynamic microphone.  
[MIC+48V] Use this setting when connecting to  
a microphone (phantom  
microphone) that requires a +48 V  
power supply.  
Memo :  
0
When “MIC” or “MIC+48V” is selected, set the  
reference input level in [A/V Set] B [Audio Set]  
B [Input1 Mic Ref.]/[Input2 Mic Ref.].  
CH1  
CH2  
INPUT1  
INPUT2  
INT  
INPUT1  
INPUT2  
LINE  
MIC  
MIC  
+48V  
LCD BRIGHT PEAKING  
AUTO  
MANUAL  
CH1  
CH2  
Caution :  
0
.
When connecting a device that does not require  
a +48 V power supply, make sure that it is not  
set to the “MIC+48V” position.  
Selecting Audio to Be Recorded in Each  
Channel  
Select the audio to be recorded in CH1/CH2.  
0
When the [INPUT1]/[INPUT2] mode switch is  
set to “MIC”, make sure that a microphone is  
connected to the [INPUT1]/[INPUT2] terminal. If  
you increase the recording level when a  
microphone is not connected, noise from the  
input terminal may be recorded.  
-
Switch Setting  
INT  
Connected Devices  
CH1  
0 Built-in Microphone  
0 [MAiUcrXo]ptheormneincaol nnected to  
INPUT1  
INT  
Microphone connected to  
0
When a microphone is not connected to the  
[INPUT1]/[INPUT2] terminal, set the [INPUT1]/  
[INPUT2] mode switch to “LINE” or adjust the  
volume with the [CH1]/[CH2] recording level  
adjustment knob.  
[INPUT1] terminal  
CH2  
0 Built-in Microphone  
0 [MAiUcrXo]ptheormneincaol nnected to  
INPUT1  
INPUT2  
Microphone connected to  
[INPUT1] terminal  
Microphone connected to  
[INPUT2] terminal  
Memo :  
0
When “INT” is set, the built-in microphone is  
disabled if a microphone is connected to the  
[AUX] terminal; audio from the microphone  
connected to the [AUX] is recorded.  
When “INT” is selected, set the reference input  
level in [Main Menu] B [A/V Set] B [Audio Set]  
B [Int. Mic Gain]/[AUX Gain].  
0
74 Audio Recording  
 
o
When the input channel is set to “INT” for  
both [CH1] and [CH2]  
Adjusting Audio Recording Level  
You can select to adjust the audio recording levels  
for the two channels (CH1/CH2) manually or  
automatically.  
1
2
Set the [CH1 AUTO/MANUAL] selection  
switch to “MANUAL”.  
Turn the [CH1] recording level adjustment  
knob to adjust the level.  
CH1  
CH2  
INPUT1  
INPUT2  
INT  
INPUT1  
INPUT2  
LINE  
MIC  
MIC  
+48V  
LCD BRIGHT PEAKING  
When the built-in microphone and the [AUX]  
input terminal are used, the recording levels of  
[CH1] and [CH2] are interlocked.  
AUTO  
MANUAL  
CH1  
CH2  
This is also effective when the [CH1 AUTO/  
MANUAL] selection switch is set to [CH2].  
Memo :  
0
0
0
Select [Limiter], [AGC Response], [AGC Mode],  
or [Int. Mic Separation] in the menu to set the  
recording audio.  
.
Manual Adjustment Mode (Manual  
Adjustment)  
0
If [Limiter] is set to other than “Off”, the limiter  
operates according to the value set.  
Set the [CH1/CH2 AUTO/MANUAL] switch on  
the camera recorder to “MANUAL” to enter the  
manual adjustment mode, and use the [CH1]/  
[CH2] recording level adjustment knob to set the  
recording level.  
For the reference level to be recorded to an SD  
card, set [A/V Set] B [Audio Set] B [Ref. Level]  
to “-20dB”, “-18dB”, or “-12dB”. (common for  
CH1/CH2)  
0
o
1
You can adjust the level manually during the  
recording, recording standby, and stop modes.  
0
The operations of the [CH2] recording level  
adjustment knob and [CH2 AUTO/MANUAL]  
selection switch are disabled.  
When the input channel is set to “INPUT1”/  
“INPUT2”  
Set the [CH1/CH2 AUTO/MANUAL]  
selection switch to “MANUAL” for the  
channel to be adjusted manually.  
Automatic Adjustment Mode  
0
Set the [CH1/CH2 AUTO/MANUAL] selection  
switch to “AUTO” or the [FULL AUTO] switch to  
“ON” to enter Automatic Adjustment mode. The  
audio recording level is set automatically  
according to the input level.  
2
Turn the corresponding [CH1]/[CH2]  
recording level adjustment knob to adjust  
the level.  
When [Audio Set] B [Limiter] is set to “Off”,  
adjust such that the audio level meter does not  
light up at -2 dB even for loud sounds.  
0
When the [FULL AUTO] switch is set to “ON”,  
mode switching with the [CH1/CH2 AUTO/  
MANUAL] selection switch is disabled.  
Memo :  
0
00:00:00.00  
When [A/V Set] B [Audio Set] B [Limiter] is set  
to “Off” while in the automatic adjustment mode,  
the limiter operates at -6dBFS.  
5 . 6 f  
12 :34 :56  
t
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
0
4030 20 10  
0
When [A/V Set] B [Audio Set] B [Audio On FULL  
AUTO] is set to “SW Set”, you can switch the  
audio recording mode with the [CH1/CH2  
AUTO/MANUAL] selection switch on the  
camera recorder even when the [FULL AUTO]  
switch is set to “ON”.  
K
5600  
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
102400  
4030 20 10  
0
-2dB  
.
Audio Recording 75  
 
Monitoring Audio Sound  
During Recording Using a  
Headphone  
Time Code and User’s Bit  
Time code and user’s bit data are recorded with the  
video in this camera recorder.  
The time code and user’s bit are displayed on the  
viewfinder and LCD monitor during playback or  
recording. (Display screen)  
You can check the recorded audio using  
headphone.  
Displaying Time Code and User’s Bit  
1
The time code and user’s bit are displayed on the  
viewfinder and LCD monitor during playback or  
recording.  
The display differs according to the menu settings.  
2
3
1
Set [LCD/VF] B [Display On/Off] B [TC/UB]  
to “On”.  
MONITOR  
CH1  
BOTH  
CH2  
2
Set [LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B [TC/UB].  
When “TC” or “UB” is selected, time code or  
user’s bit data is displayed respectively on the  
display screen.  
.
1
2
Connect the headphone.  
Select the channel to monitor with the  
[MONITOR] selection switch.  
Setting  
[CH1]  
[BOTH]  
Description  
Outputs the audio recorded in [CH1].  
Outputs the audio recorded in  
AB CD EF 89  
00H00M00S00  
F
[CH1/CH2].  
[CH2]  
Outputs the audio recorded in [CH2].  
00:00:00.00  
3
Use the [MONITOR +/-] button to adjust the  
monitor volume.  
5 . 6 f t  
12 :34 :56  
Memo :  
0
Audio during recording is not output from the  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
monitor speaker.  
K
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
5600  
102400  
.
0
Warning tone is output when there is an  
abnormality in the camera recorder or when the  
battery is low.  
Selecting Audio Output Method When the  
[MONITOR] Selection Switch Is Set to “BOTH”  
When a stereo type earphone jack is connected,  
perform the following setting to output stereo  
sound.  
1
Set the [MONITOR] selection switch to  
“BOTH”.  
2
Set [A/V Set] B [Audio Set] B [Monitor] to  
“Stereo”.  
Memo :  
0
You can set the volume of the warning tone in  
[A/V Set]B[Audio Set]B[Alarm Level]. (“Off”/  
“Low”/“Middle”/“High”)  
76 Monitoring Audio Sound During Recording Using a Headphone  
   
Time Code Operation Mode  
Set the time code operation in [TC/UB] B [TC  
Generator].  
Setting Time Code  
Generator  
Presetting the Time Code  
Setting  
Description  
Time code and user’s bit data generated from the  
internal time code generator are recorded.  
This section describes how to set [TC/UB] B [TC  
Preset].  
Memo :  
Free  
Time code information can be  
synchronized with the date/time  
information acquired from the  
GPS.  
Run(GPS)  
L
Free Run(Ext) This mode synchronizes another  
camera recorder connected to the  
[TC] terminal. The time code  
operates in the run mode at all  
times regardless of the recording  
status.  
0
When [System] B [Record Set] B [Record  
Format] B [WFrame Rate] is set to “50p”, “50i”,  
“25p” or “24p”, setting for “Drop” will be disabled.  
You can configure the setting without accessing  
the [TC/UB] menu screen.  
It continues to run even when the  
power of the camera recorder is  
turned off.  
0
Free Run  
Rec Run  
The time code operates in the run  
mode at all times regardless of the  
recording status.  
Required Settings Before Preset  
It continues to run even when the  
power of the camera recorder is  
turned off.  
1
Set [TC/UB] B [TC Generator] to “Rec  
Run” or “Free Run”.  
The time code operates in the run  
mode during recording. It  
0
[Rec Run]:  
continues to run in the order of the  
recorded clips as long as the SD  
card is not replaced. If the SD card  
is removed and recording is made  
on another card, time code will be  
recorded on the new card from  
where it was left off in the previous  
card.  
Preset data in the time code generator  
operates in run mode during recording mode.  
Set this when recording continuous time  
code in connecting frames.  
0
[Free Run]:  
Time code starts to operate in run mode from  
the preset time in the time code generator.  
Regen  
The time code operates in the run  
mode during recording. When the  
SD card is replaced, the last time  
code recorded on the card is read  
and recorded on a new card so that  
the time code continues in running  
order.  
Memo :  
0
When [System] B [Record Set] B [Rec Mode] is  
set to “Interval Rec” or “Frame Rec”, and [TC  
Generator] is set to “Free Run” or “Free  
Run(Ext)”, “Rec Run” is activated.  
When [System] B [Record Set] B [Record  
Format] B [System] is set to “High-Speed”, and  
[TC Generator] is set to “Free Run” or “Free  
Run(Ext)”, “Rec Run” is activated.  
0
Time Code and User’s Bit 77  
   
Setting Time Code  
2
Select the framing mode for the time code  
generator (only when the frame rate setting  
is “60” or “30”).  
1
Select [TC/UB] B [TC Preset] and press the  
Set button (R).  
To configure the setting, go to [TC/UB] B [Drop  
Frame].  
The [TC Preset] screen appears.  
0
[Drop]:  
TC/UB  
Sets the run mode of the time code generator  
to drop frame mode. Use this setting when  
placing emphasis on the recording time.  
[Non Drop]:  
TC Preset  
00:00:00:00  
1
0
Sets the run mode of the time code generator  
to non-drop frame mode. Use this setting  
when placing emphasis on the number of  
frames.  
.
Memo :  
Memo :  
0
When [TC/UB] B [TC Generator] is set to  
“Regen”, the parameter is displayed as  
“<Regen>” and cannot be selected.  
Drop frame/non-drop frame mode  
0
When [System] B [Record Set] B [Record  
Format] B [Frame Rate] is set to “60p”, “60i”, or  
“30p”, the actual number of frames per second  
is approximately 59.94 (29.97). However, the  
time code processing standard is “60p”, “60i”, or  
“30p” frames. To make up for the frame number  
discrepancy, the drop frame mode (Drop) drops  
the 00 frame and 01 frame every minute except  
for minutes that are multiples of 10. However, in  
the case of “60p”, the 00, 01, 02 and 03 frame  
are dropped.  
2
Set the time code (hour, minute, second,  
frame).  
Use the cross-shaped button (HI) to place the  
cursor at the item to set, then use the cross-  
shaped button (JK) to change the values.  
TC/UB  
0
The non-drop frame mode (Non Drop) does not  
drop frames and ignores the discrepancy with  
the actual time.  
Cursor  
TC Preset  
00:00:00:00  
During non-drop  
frame  
During drop frame  
Memo :  
.
0
Press the [OIS/2] button to reset each digit to “0”.  
The cursor moves to the time digit (left).  
3
Check the values and press the Set button  
(R).  
0
The time code is set and the screen returns  
to [TC/UB].  
0
To cancel the setting, press the [CANCEL]  
button.  
4
Press the [MENU/THUMB] button.  
Returns to the normal screen.  
78 Setting Time Code Generator  
 
Setting Time Code without Opening the  
Menu  
4
Check the values and press the Set button  
(R).  
0
0
The time code is set and the screen returns  
to the normal screen.  
FOCUS ASSIST/1  
OIS / 2  
To cancel the setting, press the [CANCEL]  
button.  
TIME CODE  
Caution :  
0
When the camera recorder is switched to Media  
mode during editing, editing will be canceled  
and the screen will close.  
AE LEVEL  
MENU/THUMB  
CANCEL  
0
When editing the time code, operation of the  
buttons that are set in [Camera Function] B  
[User Switch Set] is disabled. [OIS/2] functions  
as the number reset button.  
.
Memo :  
0
Settings cannot be made in the following cases.  
0
[TC/UB] B [TC Generator] has been set to  
“Regen”.  
Recording Time Code in Continuation of  
the Recorded Time Code on SD Card  
0
Menu screen is displayed.  
0
The camera recorder is not in the Camera  
mode.  
This camera recorder is equipped with the time  
code reader.  
Setting Time Code  
1
Set [TC/UB] B [TC Generator] to “Regen”.  
1
0
0
When the camera recorder enters from  
recording standby mode to recording mode,  
it reads the time code already recorded on  
the SD card and records the new time code  
in continuation of that value.  
Set [TC/UB] B [TC Generator] to a value  
other than “Regen”.  
2
Hold down the [MENU/THUMB] button and  
press the [FOCUS ASSIST/1] button.  
The [TC Preset] setting screen appears.  
The same data as the user’s bit already  
recorded on the SD card is recorded.  
Memo :  
0
When [TC/UB] B [TC Generator] is set to  
“Regen”, the framing mode of the time code  
follows the settings in [TC/UB] B [Drop Frame]  
instead of the clip settings.  
Cursor  
During drop frame  
During non-drop frame  
.
3
Set the time code (hour, minute, second,  
frame).  
Use the cross-shaped button (HI) to place the  
cursor at the item to set, then use the cross-  
shaped button (JK) to change the values.  
Memo :  
0
Press the [OIS/2] button to reset each digit to “0”.  
The cursor moves to the time digit (left).  
Setting Time Code Generator 79  
 
2
3
Setting the User’s Bit  
You can add the date, time or an 8-digit  
hexadecimal number as the user’s bit to the  
recorded image.  
Select [TC/UB]B “Preset” and press the Set  
button (R).  
The [Preset] setting screen appears.  
Use the cross-shaped button (HI) to place  
the cursor at the item to set, then use the  
cross-shaped button (JK) to change the  
values.  
Selecting a Recording Mode  
Numbers between 0 and 9 or alphabets  
between A and F can be specified for the user’s  
bit.  
Recording date/time information to the user’s  
bit  
1
Set [TC/UB] B [UB Mode] to “Date” or  
“Time”, and press the Set button (R).  
TC/UB  
The date or time information is recorded to the  
Cursor  
user’s bit.  
Memo :  
0
When “Date” or “Time” is set, [Preset] appears  
as “-” and cannot be set.  
“Time” is displayed in the 24-hour format.  
0
.
Memo :  
0
Presetting the User’s Bit  
Press the [OIS/2] button to reset each digit to  
“0”. The cursor moves to the left.  
Recording arbitrary information (8-digit  
hexadecimal) to the user’s bit  
4
Check the values and press the Set button  
1
Set [TC/UB] B [UB Mode] to “Preset”, and  
press the Set button (R).  
(R).  
0
The user’s bit is set and the screen returns to  
[TC/UB].  
0
To cancel the setting, press the [CANCEL]  
button.  
TC/UB  
5
Press the [MENU/THUMB] button.  
Returns to the normal screen.  
UB Mode  
Preset  
Date  
Time  
Preset  
1
.
Memo :  
0
When [TC/UB] B [TC Generator] is set to  
“Regen”, the parameter is displayed as  
“<Regen>” and cannot be selected.  
80 Setting the User’s Bit  
     
Settings and Operation of the Camera  
Recorder  
Synchronizing Time Code  
on Another Camera  
1
2
Set to Camera mode.  
This camera recorder is equipped with a time code  
Set [TC/UB] B [TC Generator] as follows.  
input/output terminal ([TC] terminal).  
0
Slave device:  
Connect another camera recorder to the [TC]  
terminal and synchronize to the time code.  
Select “Free Run(Ext)”.  
Master device:  
0
1
Connect the [TC] terminal of the master  
device with the [TC] terminal of the slave  
device.  
Select “Free Run”.  
3
4
Set LCD monitor or viewfinder to Display  
screen.  
Set the [TC IN/OUT] switch of the master device  
to “OUT”, and the [TC IN/OUT] switch of the  
slave device to “IN”.  
Set the master device and run the time  
code.  
0
When the built-in time code generator is  
synchronized with the external time code  
data input, the Z icon on Display screen lights  
up.  
Master Device  
0
When time code is not synchronized or time  
code input is not available, the Z icon goes  
out.  
[OUT]  
00:00:00.00  
5 . 6
12 :36  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
K
5600  
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
102400  
.
Slave Device (This Camera Recorder)  
[IN]  
Memo :  
0
The built-in time code generator will continue  
operation even when the master device is  
disconnected after synchronization.  
0
User’s bit will become data in the master device.  
.
Synchronizing Time Code on Another Camera 81  
 
3
Setting Zebra Pattern  
When the luminance level range for displaying  
zebra patterns is specified, diagonal lines (zebra  
pattern) are displayed at areas with the specified  
luminance levels during shooting.  
Display the zebra pattern.  
Press the [ZEBRA/5] button to display the zebra  
pattern in the specified range.  
1
Set [LCD/VF] B [Shooting Assist] B [Zebra]  
to “On”.  
2
Specify the brightness (luminance) level  
range for displaying zebra pattern.  
Specify the upper and lower limits of the  
luminance level in [LCD/VF] B [Shooting  
Assist] B [Zebra] B [Top] and [Bottom].  
.
During zebra pattern display,  
(zebra icon)  
is displayed on the display screen in Camera  
mode.  
Memo :  
Item  
Top  
Settings  
Options  
0
“Zebra” is assigned to [ZEBRA/5] button in  
factory default.  
Upper luminance 5%, 10% to 95%,  
limit for displaying 98%, 100%, Over  
[Zebra]  
0
“Zebra” can also be assigned to other user  
buttons.  
Bottom Lower luminance 0%, 5% to 95%,  
limit for displaying 98%, 100%  
[Zebra]  
Memo :  
0
The timing to detect the zebra pattern display  
can be configured only when “J-Log1” or “HLG”  
is selected in [Color Space] and “Cam” or “Cam  
+ Return” is selected in [Convert to ITU709].  
82 Setting Zebra Pattern  
   
Setting Spot Meter  
Color of Frame  
Indicating the  
Position  
Item  
Settings  
The brightness of the object during shooting is  
displayed.  
0
0
Max & Min  
Displays the  
Max: Green  
This function is useful when setting video or stage  
lighting or when specifying camera exposure.  
A cursor indicating the location and the brightness  
(%) of that location are displayed in the images  
shown on the LCD monitor and viewfinder screen.  
brightness (%)  
and positions of  
the brightest and  
darkest areas in  
the screen.  
Min: Yellow  
0
0
0
Zebra patterns display the brightness of output  
video signals.  
Frames may also  
be stopped at the  
current positions.  
This function allows you to check the brightness  
of input images from the lens without depending  
on image processing such as gamma curve.  
When [Color Space] is set to a value other than  
“HLG” and “J-Log1”, the dynamic range of the  
camera recorder is max. 400% and a brightness  
range of 0% to 400% is displayed.  
Max  
Displays the  
Green  
Yellow  
Green  
brightness (%)  
and position of the  
brightest area in  
the screen.  
Frames may also  
be stopped at the  
current positions.  
0
The value of the spot meter changes according  
to the setting of [LCD/VF] B [Convert to  
ITU709]/[White Level] when [Color Space] is set  
to “HLG”.  
Min  
Displays the  
brightness (%)  
and position of the  
darkest area in the  
screen. Frame  
may also be  
When [Color Space] is set to “HLG” and  
[LCD/VF] B [Convert to ITU709]/[White Level] is  
set to “72.5%”, the dynamic range of the camera  
recorder is max. 458% and a brightness range  
of 0% to 458% is displayed.  
stopped at the  
current positions.  
0
Manual  
Displays the  
When [Color Space] is set to “J-Log1”, the  
dynamic range of the camera recorder is max.  
800% and a brightness range of 0% to 800% is  
displayed.  
brightness (%) of (Blinks in green  
the specified  
position.  
when specifying  
the position)  
2
3
Assign the “Spot Meter” function to any of  
Memo :  
the user buttons.  
0
Spot meter may not be consistent with the zebra  
Press the user button that is assigned with  
display range.  
1
Select one of the following from [Camera  
Function] B [User Switch Set] B [Spot  
Meter].  
“Spot Meter”.  
The operation switches as below when the  
button is pressed.  
Setting Spot Meter 83  
 
When [Max & Min]/[Max]/[Min] is selected  
A
When [Manual] is selected  
A
The cursors appear according to the setting  
The brightness of the cursor position is  
when the button is pressed.  
displayed when the button is pressed.  
Green and yellow frames appear, and the  
brightness levels of these areas are displayed.  
Cursor  
(Green)  
Cursor  
Brightness  
(Green)  
Indication  
Brightness  
Indication  
Cursor  
(Yellow)  
.
B
By pressing the button, the cursors and  
.
brightness indication disappear.  
B
Hold down the button in the state in A, the  
positions of the brightest (Max) and darkest  
(Min) areas in the screen are automatically  
detected with regard to the changes of the  
object, and the brightness level of these areas  
are displayed.  
Cursor  
.
(Max: Green)  
C
Brightness  
Hold down the button in the state in A or B, the  
cursor blinks in green.  
Indication  
Cursor  
Move the cursor with the cross-shaped button  
(JKHI) to specify the position to display the  
brightness.  
(Min:Yellow)  
.
When you decide on the position, press the Set  
button (R) to confirm.  
C
Pressing the button in the state in B stops the  
automatic position detection. The frames are  
fixed at the stopped positions and the  
brightness levels are displayed.  
Brightness  
Indication  
D
By pressing the button, the cursors and  
brightness indication disappear.  
Cursor  
(Blinks in  
green)  
.
D
Frames are fixed at the stopped positions and  
the brightness is displayed.  
Memo :  
0
.
When moving the cursor position, [Shutter]/[AE  
Level] control is disabled.  
When the brightness is 0 % in the entire screen,  
the frame is fixed in the center.  
0
84 Setting Spot Meter  
Acquiring Positioning  
Information by GPS A  
L
Reception  
Status  
Display  
(No  
Positioning Status  
GPS reception Receiving strong  
in progress GPS signal. UTC  
.
(signal strength: and positioning  
strong)  
information can be  
obtained and  
recorded.  
This camera recorder comes with a built-in GPS  
function. The GPS function is able to record the  
positioning information.  
GPS function is The [GPS] item is  
During playback, you can also display the recorded  
information on the playback screen.  
display) turned off  
set to “Off”.  
Memo :  
0
0
If positioning cannot be performed after waiting  
for several minutes, this means GPS reception  
is poor, and there is difficulty in receiving data.  
Move to an open place with no obstructions.  
Otherwise, GPS information will not be recorded  
when shooting is performed.  
1
Set [System] B [GPS] to “On”.  
0
0
Positioning starts when the H icon on the  
display screen starts blinking.  
After positioning is complete, the H icon  
switches to a solid light and records the  
positioning information during shooting.  
The icon that appears on the screen changes  
according to the condition of signal reception  
from the GPS satellite.  
Signal may not be received depending on  
circumstances such as locations that are  
indoors or surrounded by tall buildings, or the  
geographical conditions.  
0
Precision error may occur in the position  
information depending on the conditions of  
reception.  
00
0
0
Even when positioning is in progress,  
information may be disrupted depending on the  
condition of signal reception.  
f t  
12 :34 :56  
When [A/V Set] B [Video Set] B [SDI OUT] B  
[Resolution] is set to “1080p”, configuring  
[System] B [GPS] to “On” changes the setting to  
“1080i”.  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
K
5600  
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
102400  
.
Reception  
Status  
Display  
Positioning Status  
[GPS] is set to GPS signal cannot  
be received. UTC  
and positioning  
information cannot  
be obtained.  
“On”, but signal  
cannot be  
.
(Yellow)  
received  
GPS search in UTC information  
progress  
can be obtained,  
but not positioning  
information.  
.
(Blink)  
GPS reception Receiving weak  
in progress GPS signal. UTC  
.
(signal strength: and positioning  
weak)  
information can be  
obtained and  
recorded.  
GPS reception Receiving GPS  
in progress signal. UTC and  
(signal strength: positioning  
.
medium)  
information can be  
obtained and  
recorded.  
Acquiring Positioning Information by GPS A L  
85  
 
Caution :  
Viewing Recorded Videos  
Immediately (Clip Review)  
0
During Clip Review, only the [CANCEL] and  
[REC] buttons are enabled.  
Press the [CANCEL] button to cancel clip review  
and return to “STBY” (recording standby) mode.  
Press the [REC] button to cancel clip review and  
enter recording mode. It will take some time to  
start recording after the button is pressed.  
When the last clip is less than 5 seconds, the  
whole clip is played back.  
You can check (review) the last recorded video clip  
on the screen.  
However, the video clip cannot be played back if  
the settings of the camera recorder are different  
from the video format (Resolution/Frame Rate/Bit  
Rate/SD Aspect) of the clip.  
0
0
0
0
Only video clips in the currently selected slot can  
be reviewed.  
When there are no clips in the selected slot, Clip  
Review function is disabled.  
Clip Review is unavailable when Clip  
Continuous Rec is paused (“STBYL”, yellow  
text). To operate Clip Review, use the  
[CANCEL] button to set to “STBYL” (white text)  
first.  
Memo :  
0
To use this function, assign “Clip Review” to any  
of the user buttons.  
1
Press the user button assigned with the  
“Clip Review” function during standby  
(“STBY” is displayed).  
0
0
Clip Review is unavailable when the camera  
recorder is connected to an external equipment  
and the equipment is in recording state.  
Clip Review is unavailable when operating View  
Remote via network connection.  
Playback of the configured section starts.  
Memo :  
0
0
The video clip is played back according to the  
setting in [Camera Function] B [User Switch  
Set] B [Clip Review]. By default setting (Last  
5sec), the last 5 seconds of the clip is played  
back.  
Clip Review does not function during live  
streaming.  
0
0
Clip Review does not function while the record  
trigger is in the REC state.  
When playback is complete, the camera  
recorder exits Clip Review and returns to  
“STBY” (recording standby) mode.  
86 Viewing Recorded Videos Immediately (Clip Review)  
   
Displaying the Histogram Recording  
Simultaneously at Two  
The histogram shows the brightness distribution,  
and is employed mainly for checking the exposure  
of the image.  
Different Definitions  
By setting [System] to “HD+Web”, you can record  
simultaneously at two different definitions.  
1
Set the histogram feature to ON.  
0
Set [LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B  
0
When HD+Web is selected:  
[Histogram] to “On”.  
Records a high-definition (HD) file to slot A and  
a web file to slot B at the same time.  
Web files can be used as a proxy file for the HD  
file.  
0
You can also press the user button that is  
assigned with “Histogram”.  
2
Set the upper and lower limits of the  
Memo :  
histogram display.  
0
If a recordable SD card is inserted into only one  
of the slots, files will only be recorded to that slot.  
The [Rec Mode] is fixed at “Normal”.  
Clip Cutter Trig is disabled.  
After setting, the brightness level is displayed in  
red color.  
0
0
0
0
Item  
Top  
Settings  
Options  
Sets the maximum 5% to 110% (in 5 %  
brightness limit for increments)  
changing the  
[Slot Mode] cannot be selected.  
Clip Review can only be performed for slot A.  
(“No Media” appears if there is no card in slot A  
while a card is inserted into slot B.)  
histogram display  
color  
0
Playback of web files is only possible from slot  
B when “HD+Web” is selected.  
Bottom Sets the minimum 0% to 105% (in 5 %  
brightness limit for increments)  
changing the  
histogram display  
color  
Series Rec  
o When the upper limit is set to 110% and the lower  
limit to 0%  
0
Series Rec mode is specified in the factory  
default.  
([System] B [Record Set] B [Slot Mode] is set to  
“Series”.)  
0
If both the slots are loaded with recordable  
cards, pressing the [REC] button starts  
recording only to the media in the selected slot.  
When the remaining space in the selected  
media runs out, recording continues by  
automatically activating the media in the other  
slot.  
.
*
The area in red is not displayed.  
0
o When the upper limit is set to 90% and the lower  
limit to 10%  
The slot mode can be identified on the status  
screen.  
Bottom  
Top  
.
How to read the histogram  
0
0
The vertical axis denotes the number of pixels.  
The horizontal axis denotes the pixel  
brightness.  
Displaying the Histogram 87  
       
3
Dual Rec  
Stop recording.  
0
0
Press the [REC] button again.  
Recording to both slots stops, and both the  
card slot marks turn white.  
0
If both the slots are loaded with recordable cards  
in the Dual Rec mode ([Slot Mode] is set to  
“Dual”), pressing the [REC] button starts  
recording simultaneously to the media in both  
the slots.  
0
The same clips are recorded to both cards.  
282min  
100min  
50min  
00:00:00.00  
5 . 6 f t  
0
12 :34 :56  
The clips recorded to the media in both the slots  
are identical, and two clips of the same content  
can be created only on this camera recorder.  
White  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
K
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
5600  
102400  
.
Memo :  
0
During recording in the Dual Rec mode, both the  
card slot marks light up in red.  
0
During recording in the Dual Rec mode to two  
cards with a different amount of remaining  
space, if the space of one card runs out,  
recording to both slots will stop automatically.  
After recording stops, recording automatically  
resumes for the card with remaining space.  
Although the clips are separated in this case, the  
clips can be seamlessly joined by arranging  
them on the timeline of the editing software since  
they are recorded seamlessly.  
.
Setting to Dual Rec Mode  
0
0
If the last clip on the cards that are inserted in the  
two slots are different from each other, and the  
time code operating mode is set to “Regen”, the  
Regen mode for the selected card slot will be  
enabled in the next recording.  
1
2
Set [System] B [Record Set] B [Slot Mode]  
to “Dual”.  
Start recording.  
0
0
0
When [WFormat] is set to “High-Speed”, “Dual”  
cannot be selected.  
Insert recordable media in both slots, and  
press the [REC] button.  
In the Dual Rec mode, recording to the media  
in both slots starts at the same time.  
Both the card slot marks turn red, and the  
status indicators of both the card slots also  
light up in red.  
282min  
100min  
50min  
00:00:00.00  
5 . 6 f t  
12 :34 :56  
Lit in red  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
K
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
5600  
102400  
.
88 Dual Rec  
   
Caution :  
Backup Rec  
0
To perform recording in the Dual Rec mode, it is  
recommended that you start recording by  
making use of two cards with the same capacity  
and from the formatted state.  
0
The Backup Rec mode allows you to make use  
of the media in slot B for backup recording by  
controlling the starting and stopping of recording  
in slot B without using the [REC] button.  
Start or stop the recording using [System] B  
[Record Set] B [Slot Mode] B [Backup Rec] or  
press the user button that is assigned with  
“Backup Trig”.  
0
You can combine the use of the Dual Rec mode  
with a special recording mode. While in the Dual  
Rec mode, you can also set [Rec Mode] to  
“Normal”, “Pre Rec”, “Clip Continuous”, “Interval  
Rec”, or “Frame Rec”.  
0
0
0
0
When both slots are inserted with recordable  
cards, the Dual Rec (simultaneous recording)  
operation can be performed. If a recordable  
media is only inserted in one of the slots, you can  
also start recording with one card.  
Slot A starts  
recording  
Slot B stops  
recording  
Slot B starts  
recording  
Slot A stops  
recording  
In the Dual Rec mode, continuous recording by  
switching from one slot to another cannot be  
performed. Continuous recording will not be  
performed if a recordable media is inserted in a  
slot after recording to the other slot has started.  
When recording to one slot is in progress with  
the recorder set to the Dual Rec mode, inserting  
a recordable media to the other slot does not  
enable the Dual Rec operation. To perform the  
Dual Rec operation, stop recording temporarily  
(excluding pausing recording in the Clip  
Continuous Rec mode), and start again.  
When one of the cards is accidentally removed  
while recording is in progress in the Dual Rec  
mode, recording to the card in the other slot will  
continue. However, repair of the accidentally  
removed card by the recovery function may fail.  
If an error occurs on one of the cards while  
recording is in progress in the Dual Rec mode,  
recording of the erroneous card stops, while that  
of the other card continues.  
Clip 2  
Clip 2  
Slot A  
Slot B  
Clip 1  
Clip 3  
.
Memo :  
0
During the Backup Rec mode (when [Slot  
Mode] is set to “Backup”), you can control  
recording to the 2 slots at different timings, and  
backup recording can only be performed on this  
camera recorder.  
0
0
You can record without worrying about missing  
the important scenes by setting slot B to be  
always recording (backup recording) and using  
the [REC] button to start/stop recording of only  
the required scenes in slot A.  
0
0
0
0
It is recommended to use a media with high  
capacity in slot B.  
Operations on clips recorded in the Dual Rec  
mode, such as clip deletion in the Media mode  
or appending of OK marks, can only be  
performed on the card in the selected slot.  
Backup cannot be selected when [WFormat] is  
configured to “High-Speed”, “Exchange” (U  
model) or “MP4” (E model).  
Dual Rec 89  
   
1
2
3
Set [System] B [Record Set] B [Slot Mode]  
to “Backup”.  
Start normal recording (normal recording  
into slot A)  
0
0
Press any of the [REC] buttons.  
Recording into the media in slot A starts.  
(The characters “RREC” appear in red.)  
The card icon of slot A turns red (unselected  
state), and the status indicator of slot A blinks  
in red.  
0
The slot mode can be identified on the status  
screen.  
0
Start backup recording. (Backup recording  
into slot B)  
0
Select “REC” in [System] B [Record Set] B  
[Slot Mode] B [Backup Rec] and press the  
Set button (R).  
Red (not selected)  
282min  
100min  
50min  
00:00:00.00  
0
You can also press the user button that is  
assigned with “Backup Trig”.  
5 . 6 f t  
12 :34 :56  
100min  
50min  
0
0
Backup recording into slot B starts.  
The card slot mark of slot B turns red  
(selected state), and the status indicator of  
slot B also blinks in red.  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
K
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
5600  
102400  
.
282min  
100min  
50min  
00:00:00.00  
4
Stop normal recording.  
0
0
Press any of the [REC] buttons again.  
Recording to slot A stops, and the card slot  
mark of slot A turns white (unselected state).  
The characters “RREC” (red) changes back  
to “STBY” (white).  
5 . 6 f t  
12 :34 :56  
100min  
50min  
0
0
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
K
1
The status indicator of slot A goes out.  
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
5600  
102400  
Red (selected)  
White (not selected)  
.
282min  
100min  
50min  
00:00:00.00  
5 . 6 f t  
12 :34 :56  
100min  
50min  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
K
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
5600  
102400  
.
90 Backup Rec  
5
Stop backup recording.  
Special Recording  
0
Select [STBY] in [System] B [Record Set] B  
[Slot Mode] B [Backup Rec] and press the  
Set button (R).  
Besides the normal recording mode, four special  
recording methods are available in this camera  
recorder. They are Pre Rec, Clip Continuous,  
Frame Rec and Interval Rec.  
0
You can also press the user button that is  
assigned with “Backup Trig”.  
Select a mode from [System] B [Record Set] B  
[Rec Mode].  
0
Recording to slot B stops, and the card slot  
mark of slot B turns white (unselected state).  
The status indicator of slot B lights up in  
green.  
Memo :  
0
0
Special recording cannot be selected when  
[System]  
B
[Record Set]  
B
[Record Format]  
B
[System] is set to “4K EXT (SSD)”, “HD+Web” or  
“High-Speed”.  
White  
282min  
100min  
50min  
00:00:00.00  
Pre Rec  
5 . 6 f t  
12 :34 :56  
0
By setting the number of seconds in the [Pre Rec  
Time], you can start recording video and audio  
before actual recording starts based on the [Pre  
Rec Time] setting.  
When starting actual recording while the camera  
recorder is in Recording Standby (STBYO)  
mode, you can start recording a few seconds  
earlier based on the [Pre Rec Time] setting.  
Using Pre Rec allows you to record a complete  
event without missing the initial scenes even if  
you start the recording late.  
100min  
50min  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
K
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
5600  
102400  
0
0
.
Memo :  
0
During backup recording, if the space of one  
card runs out, recording stops only for the card  
that is full.  
0
0
When recording to both slots is stopped,  
recording in the Regen mode will be enabled for  
the card slot in which recording started.  
When recording is started in the other slot while  
recording to one slot, the clip being recorded is  
split and simultaneous recording to the other  
card starts.  
Memo :  
0
Pre Rec Time can be set in [System] B [Record  
Set] B [Rec Mode] B [Pre Rec Time].  
0
When [System] is set to “4K”:  
Fixed at “5sec”  
0
When [System] is set to “HD” or “SD”:  
“5sec”, “10sec” or “15sec”  
0
0
When recording is stopped for either slot A or B  
while recording to both slots, the clip on the slot  
which is still recording is split.  
Although the clips are separated during  
recording the clips can be seamlessly joined by  
arranging them on the timeline of the editing  
software since they are recorded seamlessly.  
Clip Cutter Trig cannot be performed during  
backup recording.  
0
0
When [Slot Mode] is set to “Backup”, [Rec  
Mode] can only be set to “Normal”.  
Backup Rec 91  
       
Clip Continuous Rec  
Completed Clip  
0
In normal recording, when the recording stops,  
the image, audio, and accompanying data from  
the start till the end of the recording are recorded  
as one “clip” on the SD card.  
(Recorded video and audio)  
0
This mode allows you to consolidate several  
rounds of “startstop recording” into one clip.  
Recording starts a  
number of seconds  
earlier based on the  
[Pre Rec Time] setting  
Example:  
In normal recording, three clips are generated as  
Recording 1, Recording 2, and Recording 3.  
However, recording in this mode generates only  
one clip.  
Press [REC]  
Press [REC]  
(Recording starts) (Recording stops)  
.
Press [REC]  
Press [REC]  
Press [REC]  
1
Set [Rec Mode] to “Pre Rec”.  
(Recording starts) (Recording resumes)  
(Recording resumes)  
Press [REC]  
Press [REC]  
Press and hold [REC]  
0
Set [System] B [Record Set] B [Rec Mode]  
to “Pre Rec”.  
The display changes (“STBY” B “STBYO”).  
(Recording pauses) (Recording pauses) (Recording stops)  
0
Recording 1  
Recording 2  
Recording 3  
2
Press the [REC] button to start recording in  
Pre Rec mode.  
0
0
The display changes (“STBYOB RRECO”)  
and the card slot status indicator lights up in  
red.  
Completed Clip  
(Recorded video and audio)  
Press the [REC] button again to pause  
recording. The display changes (“RRECOB  
“STBYO”) and the card slot status indicator  
lights up in green.  
Recording 1 Recording 2 Recording 3  
.
1
2
Set “Rec Mode” to “Clip Continuous”.  
Caution :  
0
When the interval between start and stop  
recording is short, “STBYO” may not be  
displayed immediately after recording is  
complete.  
0
Set [System] B [Record Set] B [Rec Mode]  
to “Clip Continuous”.  
The display changes (“STBY” B “STBYL”).  
0
RRECOB “STBYO” (“STBY” blinks in red) B  
“STBYO” is displayed.  
Start recording. (Recording 1)  
0
Press the [REC] button to start recording in  
Clip Continuous mode.  
0
0
When the SD card becomes full during  
recording, recording stops and “STOP” is  
displayed.  
0
The display changes (“STBYLB RRECL”)  
and the card slot status indicator lights up in  
red.  
In the following cases, video and audio before  
the specified Pre Rec time may not be recorded  
even if recording starts.  
0
Immediately after power on  
0
Immediately after recording stops  
0
Immediately after switching from Media  
mode to Camera mode  
0
Immediately after setting [Rec Mode]  
0
Immediately after the end of Clip Review  
0
Immediately after changing file format  
0
Immediately after changing video format  
92 Special Recording  
   
Memo :  
3
Pause recording.  
0
The following operations cannot be performed  
0
Press the [REC] button again to pause  
recording. The display changes (“RRECLB  
“STBYL” (yellow text)).  
while recording is paused (STBYL, yellow text).  
0
Clip Review operation  
0
The card slot status indicator remains lighted  
in red.  
0
Switching SD card slots  
Memo :  
0
0
Switching operation mode  
When the [CANCEL] button is pressed while the  
camera recorder is paused (STBYL), the  
display changes (“STBYL” (yellow text) B  
“STBYL” (blinking yellow text) B “STBYL”  
(white text)), and a “clip” is generated. The card  
slot status indicator lights up in green.  
0
Files are split into sizes of 4 GB (or 30 minutes)  
regardless of the menu settings.  
Caution :  
0
Do not remove the SD card during recording  
(RRECL, red text) or recording pause (STBYL,  
yellow text).  
4
Resume recording. (Recording 2)  
0
To remove the SD card in the “Clip  
Continuous” mode, press the [CANCEL] button,  
check that “STBYL” (white text) is displayed and  
the card slot status indicator lights up in green  
before you remove the card.  
0
Press the [REC] button again to resume  
recording. The display changes (“STBYL”  
(yellow text) B RRECL”).  
0
The card slot status indicator remains lighted  
in red.  
0
To remove the SD card in the “Clip  
Continuous” mode, press the [CANCEL] button,  
check that “STBYL” (white text) is displayed and  
the card slot status indicator lights up in green  
before you remove the card.  
5
6
Pause recording.  
0
Press the [REC] button again to pause  
recording. The display changes (“RRECLB  
“STBYL” (yellow text)).  
0
The card slot status indicator remains lighted  
0
0
When the SD card becomes full during  
recording, recording stops and “STOP” is  
displayed.  
in red.  
Resume recording. (Recording 3)  
When the [POWER ON/OFF] switch is turned off  
during recording or recording pause, recording  
stops and power is cut off after a clip is  
generated.  
0
Press the [REC] button again to resume  
recording. The display changes (“STBYL”  
(yellow text) B RRECL”).  
0
The card slot status indicator remains lighted  
0
If the power is cut off due to low battery power,  
a proper clip may not be generated.  
in red.  
7
8
Press and hold the [REC] button.  
0
Recording stops and the display changes  
(“RRECLB “STBYL”). A “clip” is generated.  
The card slot status indicator lights up in  
green.  
0
Press the [REC] button again.  
0
The display changes (“STBYLB RRECL”)  
and the card slot status indicator lights up in  
red.  
0
A new “clip” is generated from here.  
Special Recording 93  
Frame Rec  
2
3
Set the number of frames to record in [Rec  
Frames].  
In normal recording, when the recording stops, the  
image and accompanying data from the start till the  
end of the recording are recorded as one “clip” on  
the SD card.  
0
To configure the setting, go to [System] B  
[Record Set] B [Rec Mode] B [Rec Frames].  
Start recording.  
In this mode, recording starts with every press of  
the [REC] button, and only the specified number of  
frames is recorded.  
0
Press the [REC] button to record only the  
number of frames specified in [Rec Frames]  
and pause.  
The recording can be written to the media as a  
single clip until it is stopped.  
0
0
The display changes (“STBYMB RRECM”  
B “STBYM” (yellow text)).  
Memo :  
0
0
Audio will not be recorded.  
The card slot status indicator lights up in  
Until a specified amount of recordings is  
accumulated, the file cannot be written to the  
media.  
green.  
4
Repeat Frame Rec.  
0
Press the [REC] button again to record only  
the number of frames specified in [Rec  
Frames] and pause.  
0
0
If the specified amount is not reached when  
recording is stopped, normal recording is  
performed and frames are added to the ending  
of the clip until the amount is reached. (Padding)  
After the specified number of frames is recorded  
and written to the media, recording will be  
performed until the same number is  
accumulated again.  
0
0
The display changes (“STBYMB RRECM”  
B “STBYM” (yellow text)).  
Frame Rec continues until the recording is  
stopped (step 5).  
5
Press and hold the [REC] button.  
0
The card slot status indicator lights up in  
green.  
Press [REC]  
Press and hold [REC]  
(Frame Rec stops)  
(Frame Rec starts)  
Press [REC]  
Press [REC]  
Caution :  
0
Recording resumes Recording resumes  
Do not remove the SD card during recording  
(“RRECM”, red text) or recording pause  
(“STBYM”, yellow text).  
Normal recording  
(Padding data)  
Pause  
Pause  
Pause  
0
To remove the SD card during Frame Rec, press  
the [CANCEL] button, check that “STBYM”  
(white text) is displayed and the card slot status  
indicator lights up in green before you remove  
the card.  
Records number of frames specified in [Rec Frames]  
Actual clips recorded to the media  
0
0
When [TC/UB] B [TC Generator] is set to “Free  
Run” or “Free Run(Ext)”, the time code will be  
recorded in “Rec Run”.  
Specific amount of data  
.
Audio cannot be recorded. The audio level  
meter is grayed out.  
1
Set [Rec Mode] to “Frame Rec”.  
Set [System] B [Record Set] B [Rec Mode]  
0
to “Frame Rec”.  
0
The display changes (“STBY” B “STBYM”).  
94 Special Recording  
   
Interval Rec  
3
4
Set the time interval to start recording in  
[Interval Rec].  
To configure the setting, go to [System] B  
[Record Set] B [Rec Mode] B [Rec Interval].  
In normal recording, when the recording stops, the  
image and accompanying data from the start till the  
end of the recording are recorded as one “clip” on  
the SD card.  
In this mode, recording and pause are performed  
repeatedly at the specified time interval. Only the  
specified number of frames is recorded.  
The recording can be written to the media as a  
single clip until it is stopped.  
Start recording.  
0
Press the [REC] button to record only the  
number of frames specified in [Rec Frames]  
and pause.  
0
After the specified time in [Rec Interval] has  
passed, recording starts again to record only  
the number of frames specified in [Rec  
Frames] and pause.  
Memo :  
0
0
Audio will not be recorded.  
Until a specified amount of recordings is  
accumulated, the file will not be written to the  
media.  
0
0
Interval Rec continues until the recording is  
stopped.  
0
0
After the specified number of frames is recorded  
and written to the media, recording will be  
performed until the same number is  
accumulated again.  
The display changes (“STBYNB RRECN”  
B “STBYN” (red text) B RRECNB  
“STBYN” (red text)).  
If the specified amount is not reached when  
recording is stopped, normal recording is  
performed and frames are added to the ending  
of the clip until the amount is reached. (Padding)  
The card slot status indicator lights up in red.  
5
Press the [REC] button.  
0
The card slot status indicator lights up in  
green.  
0
The display becomes “STBYN”.  
Press [REC]  
Press [REC]  
(Interval Rec starts)  
(Interval Rec stops)  
Caution :  
0
Do not remove the SD card during recording  
(RRECN, red text) or recording pause (STBYN,  
yellow text).  
Recording resumes Recording resumes  
[Rec Interval]  
[Rec Interval]  
0
To remove the SD card during Interval Rec,  
press the [CANCEL] button, check that “STBYN”  
(white text) is displayed and the card slot status  
indicator lights up in green before you remove  
the card.  
Normal recording  
Pause  
Pause  
Pause  
(Padding data)  
Records number of frames specified in [Rec Frames]  
0
0
When [TC/UB] B [TC Generator] is set to “Free  
Run” or “Free Run(Ext)”, the time code will be  
recorded in “Rec Run”.  
Actual clips recorded to the media  
Audio cannot be recorded. The audio level  
meter is grayed out.  
Specific amount of data  
.
1
Set [Rec Mode] to “Interval Rec”.  
0
Set [System] B [Record Set] B [Rec Mode]  
to “Interval Rec”.  
0
The display changes (“STBY” B “STBYN”).  
2
Set the number of frames to record in [Rec  
Frames].  
To configure the setting, go to [System] B  
[Record Set] B [Rec Mode] B [Rec Frames].  
Special Recording 95  
   
Splitting the Clips Freely  
(Clip Cutter Trig)  
Configuring Infrared  
Recording  
You can split the clips freely without having to stop  
This camera recorder comes with a infrared  
recording mode that is suitable for night recording.  
Using infrared illumination allows images to be  
captured naturally in a pitch-dark environment. It is  
recommended for observation of animals without  
alerting them or for natural facial expressions  
without firing glaring flash light at the subject.  
recording during shooting.  
1
2
Assign the “Clip Cutter Trig” function to  
any of the user buttons.  
Press the user button that is assigned with  
1
2
Set the [FULL AUTO] switch to “OFF”.  
Set [Camera Function] B [Infrared] to “On”.  
“Clip Cutter Trig” during shooting.  
A clip cut icon (Q) appears on the display  
screen for 3 seconds, and the clip is split.  
A “I” icon appears.  
Caution :  
282min  
100min  
50min  
00:00:00.00  
0
Do not use infrared recording for capturing  
strong light sources or heat sources. Doing so  
may damage the camera recorder.  
5 . 6 f t  
Memo :  
0
The settings are fixed as followed when it is  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
configured to “On”.  
4030 20 10  
0
K
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
5600  
102400  
.
0
Manual focus  
0
ND Filter“OFF”  
Memo :  
0
[Camera Function] B [Focus] B [AF Assist]  
0
Clips cannot be split again for a few seconds  
and [MF Assist] appear as “---”.  
after the operation is performed.  
0
All items other than [Color Space] and  
0
This item cannot be used when [Slot Mode] is  
set to “Backup”.  
[Reverse Picture] under [Camera Process]  
appear as “---”.  
0
This item cannot be used when [Rec Mode] is  
set to a value other than “Normal” or “Pre Rec”.  
0
0
The zoom and focus positions will be initialized  
after the settings are changed.  
When [Infrared] is configured to “On”, if the type  
of light source changes after focus is  
established, the image may go out of focus.  
0
0
The split clips are recorded seamlessly without  
interruptions in the video.  
When “4K EXT (SSD)”, Exchange (U model) or  
MP4 (E model) is selected, the clip cutter  
function cannot be used.  
96 Splitting the Clips Freely (Clip Cutter Trig)  
   
F
[OIS/2] Button  
Playing Recorded Clips  
0
Switches the selection status of the clip  
selected by the cursor.  
To play back clips recorded in a recording media,  
0
Clips being selected are displayed with  
check mark.  
switch to the Media mode.  
Press and hold the [MODE] selection button in the  
Camera mode to enter the Media mode. A  
thumbnail screen of the clips recorded on the  
recording media is displayed.  
G
H
[ONLINE/3] Button  
Enters the action selection screen.  
[DISPLAY] Button  
Switches between the “Standard Screen” and  
“Detailed Screen”.  
[STATUS] Button  
Displays the media information screen.  
You can play back the selected clip on the  
thumbnail screen.  
Memo :  
I
0
When a recording media without any clips is  
inserted, “No Clips” is displayed.  
Thumbnail Screen  
Operation Buttons  
Use the operation buttons on the side control panel  
or front side of the camera recorder to operate the  
thumbnail screen.  
0
“Standard Screen” and “Detailed Screen” are  
available.  
Use the [DISPLAY] button to switch between the  
screens.  
0
Thumbnails are displayed in order of recording  
from the oldest to most recent.  
E
F
G
Standard screen  
FOCUS ASSIST/1  
OIS/2  
ONLINE/3  
K
J
I
TIME CODE  
MENU/THUMB  
AE LEVEL  
A
B
DISPLAY STATUS  
I
H
CANCEL  
H
G
C
A D  
B
C
D
E
.
A
[MENU/THUMB] Button  
F
.
0
0
Displays the menu.  
A
Press this button to close the menu screen  
during menu display and return to the  
thumbnail screen.  
Recording Media Information  
0
Displaysthestatuswhenrepairisrequiredfor  
the selected recording media or the status of  
the write-protect switch for the SD card.  
The inserted recording media will not be  
displayed if [System] is different.  
B
C
Cross-Shaped Button (JKHI)  
0
0
Moves the cursor.  
Set (Play) Button  
Use the [SLOT SEL] button to switch  
0
0
Sets the values and items. (Confirm)  
Plays back the selected clip.  
[CANCEL] (Stop) Button  
Cancels settings and returns to the previous  
screen.  
between slots A and B. Clips from different  
slots cannot be displayed at the same time.  
D
E
W z Write-protect switch of the SD card  
:
in slot A is set.  
S
SD card in slot B needs to be  
restored or formatted, or is an  
unsupported SD card.  
:
[FOCUS ASSIST/1] Button  
0
Switches the OK mark of the clip selected by  
the cursor.  
G
SSD media in [EXT.SLOT]  
:
0
If an OK mark has been appended, it will be  
deleted. Otherwise, an OK mark will be  
appended.  
Playing Recorded Clips 97  
         
B
Clip Mark  
Memo :  
0
Displays the clip information (properties).  
This is dependent on the [System], [Format],  
[Resolution], [Frame Rate] and [Bit Rate]  
settingsinthe[System] B RecordSet B [Record  
Format] menu.  
E
A
D
C
B
E
Clip Name  
.
The file name (clip number) of the selected clip  
is displayed.  
A
OK Mark  
Clip is appended with OK mark.  
F
Operation Guide  
0
Memo :  
Displays a guide for the current operation  
buttons.  
0
Clips appended with OK marks cannot be  
0
The action selection screen is displayed  
when the [ONLINE/3] button is pressed.  
deleted on the camera recorder.  
B
Continued From Mark  
This mark indicates that the current clip is  
continued from another SD card when  
recording is divided and made on several SD  
cards.  
G
Recording Start Time  
Displays the recording start time of the clip.  
Memo :  
0
The date/time display is dependent on the  
settings in [System] B [Date Style]/[Time Style].  
C
D
Uneditable Mark  
0
This mark indicates that an OK mark cannot  
be appended to or deleted from the clip, and  
the clip cannot be deleted.  
H
Scroll Bar  
Continue Mark  
0
0
Indicates the scroll position.  
This mark indicates that recording of the current  
clip is continued to another SD card when  
recording is divided and made on several SD  
cards.  
Black space below the scroll bar (white)  
indicates that there are more pages.  
When the scroll bar (white) is at the bottom,  
this indicates the last page.  
0
E
Check Mark  
I
J
Remaining Battery Power  
0
A green check mark is displayed when the  
clip is selected.  
Number of Clips  
0
Magenta and gray check marks are  
displayed in multiple selection mode.  
0
0
If none of the clips are selected, the “running  
number/total number of clips” of the clip to be  
displayed appears.  
Even if only one clip is selected, the number  
of selected clips in the current slot is  
displayed.  
C
D
Cursor  
Clip to be worked on. Use the cross-shaped  
button (JKHI) to move the cursor.  
K
Network Connection Icon  
Thumbnail Substitution Display  
0
The network connection status is displayed.  
A
B
.
A
A clip with corrupted management information.  
It cannot be played back even if you press the  
Set (Play) button.  
B
A clip that cannot be played back nor displayed  
in thumbnail with the current video format  
settings.  
It cannot be played back even if you press the  
Set (Play) button.  
98 Playing Recorded Clips  
 
Detailed screen  
Actions  
*
Items that are common with the Standard screen  
will not be described. Refer to “[Standard  
The action selection screen is displayed when the  
[ONLINE/3] button is pressed.  
The following operations can be performed.  
Item  
Description  
A
B
Select All Clips Selects all clips.  
Select OK  
Marked  
Selects all clips appended with  
OK mark.  
Select Range  
Specifies the range when  
selecting multiple clips.  
C
.
Deselect All  
Add OK Mark  
Clears all clip selections.  
Appends an OK mark.  
A
B
Thumbnail  
Thumbnail of the clip selected by the cursor.  
Use the cross-shaped button (HI) to move the  
cursor.  
0
This Clip:  
Appends an OK mark to the  
clip pointed by the cursor.  
Selected Clips:  
0
Scroll Mark (DE)  
0
Appends an OK mark to the  
clips selected (appended  
with check mark).  
All Clips:  
If there are previous clips, D appears on the  
left.  
0
0
If there are more clips, E appears on the right.  
The marks will not be displayed if there are  
no clips before and after the current clip.  
0
Appends an OK mark to all  
clips.  
C
Metadata  
Metadata of the clip pointed by the cursor.  
You can use the cross-shaped button (JK) to  
scroll.  
Delete OK Mark Deletes the OK mark.  
0
This Clip:  
Deletes the OK mark of the  
clip pointed by the cursor.  
Selected Clips:  
0
Deletes the OK mark of the  
clips selected (appended  
with check mark).  
All Clips:  
0
Deletes the OK mark of all  
clips.  
Playing Recorded Clips 99  
 
Item  
FTP Upload  
Description  
Playing back  
Uploads a clip to the FTP server.  
Use the operation buttons on the side control panel  
0
This Clip:  
of the camera recorder to play back.  
Uploads the clip pointed by  
the cursor.  
0
Selected Clips:  
Uploads the clips selected  
(appended with check  
mark).  
0
All Clips:  
Uploads all clips.  
Delete Clips  
Deletes clip. However, clips with  
FOCUS ASSIST/1  
OIS/2  
ONLINE/3  
OK mark cannot be deleted.  
TIME CODE  
MENU/THUMB  
AE LEVEL  
A
B
0
0
This Clip:  
Deletes the clip pointed by  
the cursor.  
CANCEL  
GAIN  
C
Selected Clips:  
Deletes the clips selected  
(appended with check  
mark).  
WHT BAL  
SHUTTER  
.
A
Set Button (R)  
0
0
Plays back/pauses the clip pointed by the  
cursor.  
All Clips:  
Deletes all clips.  
0
You can press the cross-shaped button (HI)  
to perform frame-by-frame forward playback  
during pause mode.  
Trim This Clip  
Memo :  
Trims the clip pointed by the  
cursor.  
B
Cross-shaped Button (JKH I)  
0
0
0
The object of action is the clip of the current slot  
0
[J/K] Button:  
being displayed.  
Skips in the reverse or forward direction.  
[H/I] Button:  
[Selected Clips] cannot be performed if there are  
no selected (appended with check mark) clips.  
[This Clip] cannot be performed if there are more  
than one selected (appended with check mark)  
clips.  
0
0
During Playback:  
Fast forwards in the reverse or forward  
direction.  
0
While paused:  
0
If the write-protect switch of an SD card is set,  
OK mark cannot be appended or deleted, and  
the clips cannot be deleted and trimmed.  
Frame-by-frame playback in the reverse  
or forward direction.  
C
[CANCEL] Button  
Stops playback.  
1
In the thumbnail screen, move the cursor to  
the clip to be played back.  
Move the cursor to the clip to be played back  
using the cross-shaped button (JKH I).  
2
Press the Set button (R).  
Playback of the selected clip starts.  
Audio Output during Playback  
0
You can confirm the playback sound from the  
monitor speaker, or the headphone connected  
to the [x] terminal. When a headphone is  
connected to the [x] terminal, sound cannot be  
output from the monitor speaker.  
0
Adjust the volume of the monitor speaker and  
headphone using the [MONITOR +/-] volume  
adjustment button on the LCD monitor section  
of the camera recorder.  
100 Playing Recorded Clips  
       
Time Code Playback  
Time code or user’s bit recorded on an SD card can  
be displayed on the LCD monitor and viewfinder.  
Memo :  
0
The time code is also superimposed on the  
video signal output from the [SDI OUT] terminal.  
If a section without time code is played back, the  
time code will stop. However, playback will  
continue.  
0
Displaying Information during Shooting  
During playback, pressing the [DISPLAY] button  
shows the display screen. Pressing the  
[ONLINE/3] button during shooting switches the  
display information between camera information  
display, GPS display and turning off the display.  
0
0
The GPS display displays information on the  
recording location of the video being played  
back only when GPS information has been  
recorded.  
Camera information display displays only  
information of Gain, Iris, Shutter and White  
Balance that have been recorded.  
0dB  
F1.6  
1/100  
5600K  
Camera Information Display  
Display Off  
+35.483197  
+139.652172  
GPS Display  
.
Memo :  
0
Trimming information is displayed while  
trimming is in progress. In this case, pressing the  
[ONLINE/3] button does not switch the display.  
Playing Recorded Clips 101  
   
4
Deleting Clips  
Delete clip.  
Memo :  
Select [Delete] using the cross-shaped  
button (JK), and press the Set button (R).  
Deleting starts.  
0
Clips appended with OK marks cannot be  
deleted on the camera recorder.  
Delete This Clip?  
0
Read-only clips can be deleted on a PC.  
Delete  
Cancel  
4
Deleting One Clip  
Delete the clip (one clip) pointed by the cursor in  
[Delete Clips] B [This Clip] in the menu.  
Memo :  
0
Clips with OK mark cannot be deleted.  
Deleting...  
Stop  
During Thumbnail Screen  
1
Move the cursor to the clip to be deleted.  
Move the cursor to the clip to be deleted using  
the cross-shaped button (JKH I).  
.
Selecting and Deleting Multiple Clips  
To select and delete multiple clips, refer to  
1
Deleting All Clips  
.
Delete all clips that are displayed.  
2
3
Press the [ONLINE/3] button.  
The action selection screen is displayed.  
1
2
3
Press the [ONLINE/3] button.  
Select [Delete Clips] B [This Clip] and press  
The action selection screen is displayed.  
the Set button (R).  
Select [Delete Clips] B [All Clips].  
A screen to confirm deletion appears.  
Select [Delete] and press the Set button  
(R).  
A screen to confirm deletion appears.  
Deleting starts.  
Memo :  
This Clip  
Selected Clips  
All Clips  
3
0
The time taken to delete clips depends on the  
number of clips to be deleted.  
.
102 Deleting Clips  
   
During Playback or Pause Screen  
Appending/Deleting OK  
Mark  
1
Press [FOCUS ASSIST/1] button during clip  
playback.  
0
If the clip does not have an OK mark, an OK  
mark will be appended.  
0
You can append OK marks to the clips for  
0
If the clip is appended with an OK mark, the  
OK mark will be deleted.  
important scenes.  
0
Clips appended with OK marks cannot be  
deleted, thus protecting the important clips.  
0
When the camera recorder is in Media mode,  
you can delete the OK marks appended during  
recording, or append/delete OK marks after  
shooting.  
During Thumbnail Screen  
1
Press the [FOCUS ASSIST/1] button.  
0
If the clip does not have an OK mark, an OK  
mark will be appended.  
0
If the clip is appended with an OK mark, the  
OK mark will be deleted.  
OK Mark  
.
Memo :  
0
The clip pauses when an OK mark is appended  
or deleted during playback.  
Appending/Deleting OK Mark of  
Multiple Clips  
To select and append/delete OK mark for multiple  
OK Mark  
.
Appending/Deleting OK Mark 103  
   
Selecting Multiple Clips Randomly  
Selecting and Performing  
Operations on Multiple  
Clips  
1
Move the cursor to a clip without a check  
mark, and press the [[OIS/2] button.  
A green check mark appears on the clip.  
0
Multiple clips can be selected during thumbnail  
screen or playback screen display.  
0
After selecting multiple clips, perform  
1
appending/deleting of OK mark, deleting of clips  
using the action selection screen.  
0
After selecting multiple clips, the selections will  
be canceled by the following operations.  
0
When [Deselect All] in the action menu is  
.
selected  
2
Repeat Step 1 to select multiple clips.  
0
When exiting Media mode from the thumbnail  
0
0
Multiple clips can be selected.  
Press the [ONLINE/3] button while the  
multiple clips are selected.  
screen  
0
When the recording media is removed  
0
When switching the slot in use  
0
Appends OK mark together:  
[Add OK Mark] B [Selected Clips]  
Deletes OK mark together:  
0
0
[Delete OK Mark] B [Selected Clips]  
Uploading selected clips to the FTP server  
together:  
[FTP Upload] B [Selected Clips]  
Deletes selected clips together:  
[Delete Clips] B [Selected Clips]  
0
Memo :  
0
Selecting clips appended with check mark and  
pressing the [OIS/2] button will cancel the  
selection.  
0
If the operation is performed on multiple clips at  
the same time, a progress bar appears. You can  
stop the operation by pressing the Set button (R)  
while the operation is in progress. However, it is  
not possible to undo operations that are  
completed.  
104 Selecting and Performing Operations on Multiple Clips  
   
Selecting Multiple Clips Consecutively  
Press the [ONLINE/3] button.  
Select “Select Range” in the action  
selection screen, and press the Set button  
(R).  
5
Press the Set button (R) to confirm the  
range.  
1
2
0
0
The check marks change from magenta to  
green.  
Pressing the [ONLINE/3] button while the  
multiple clips are selected displays the action  
selection screen. The following operations  
can be performed.  
Select All Clips  
0
Appends OK mark together:  
Select OK Marked  
[Add OK Mark] B [Selected Clips]  
Select Range  
2
0
Deselect All  
Deletes OK mark together:  
Add OK Mark...  
[Delete OK Mark] B [Selected Clips]  
Delete OK Mark...  
FTP Upload...  
0
Uploading selected clips to the FTP server  
together:  
[FTP Upload] B [Selected Clips]  
Deletes selected clips together:  
[Delete Clips] B [Selected Clips]  
.
0
3
Move the cursor to the beginning (or end)  
of the range for multiple selection, and  
press the Set button (R).  
Memo :  
0
4
Selecting clips appended with check mark and  
pressing the [[OIS/2] button will cancel the  
selection.  
Move the cursor to the other end of the  
range.  
0
0
Magenta check marks appear on the clips  
within the range. (Including clips that were  
already selected.)  
0
If the operation is performed on multiple clips at  
the same time, a progress bar appears. You can  
stop the operation by pressing the Set button (R)  
while the operation is in progress. However, it is  
not possible to undo operations that are  
completed.  
Gray check marks appear on selected clips  
that are outside the range.  
Selected Range:  
3
Start Position  
Selected Range:  
4
End Position  
.
Selecting and Performing Operations on Multiple Clips 105  
 
Trimming Recorded Clips  
It is possible to crop (trim) the necessary parts of a  
clip that is recorded to the recording media.  
The trimmed clip is saved as a separate file to the  
recording media and the original clip remains  
intact.  
C
Trimming information  
W or Y  
:
:
:
:
Indicates the available space in  
the storage media (W or Y)  
Indicates the time code of the in  
point  
7
8
Indicates the time code of the out  
point  
9
Indicates the duration from the in  
point to the out point  
1
Switch to Media mode.  
Memo :  
Switch the mode using the [MODE] selection  
button on the side operation panel.  
0
The trimmed clip will be saved to the same card  
slot as that of the original clip.  
2
Move the cursor to the clip to be trimmed.  
Move the cursor to the clip to be trimmed using  
the cross-shaped button (JKH I).  
0
[Duration] appears in yellow if the duration is 10  
minutes or longer. Trimming cannot be  
performed in this case.  
0
When [System] B [Record Set] B [Record  
Format] B [WFrame Rate] is set to “  
70M (XHQ)”, [Duration] appears in yellow if the  
duration is 6 minutes or longer. Trimming  
cannot be performed in this case.  
2
0
When [System] B [Record Set] B [Record  
Format] B [System] is configured to “4K EXT  
(SSD)” or “4K”, [Duration] appears in yellow if  
it is 3 minutes or longer. Trimming cannot be  
performed in this case.  
.
3
4
Press the [ONLINE/3] button.  
0
0
[Duration] appears in yellow if the duration is  
longer than the recordable time on the storage  
media. Trimming cannot be performed in this  
case.  
The action selection screen is displayed.  
Select [Trim This Clip], and press the Set  
button (R).  
Playback of the selected clip starts.  
When trimming starts, the display switches to  
the Media Display screen.  
Select Range  
Deselect All  
5
Specify the in point.  
0
Operate buttons such as H/I or J/K to move  
Add OK Mark...  
Delete OK Mark...  
FTP Upload...  
the video to the in point.  
Delete Clips...  
Trim This Clip  
0
Specify the in point by pressing the [FOCUS  
ASSIST/1] button at the point you want to  
start trimming.  
4
6
7
Specify the out point.  
0
Operate buttons such as H/I or J/K to move  
1000/2000  
282min  
3840x2160  
30p 140M  
00:00:00.00  
the video to the out point.  
Jan 24,2019  
12 :34 :56  
0
Specify the out point by pressing the [OIS/2]  
button at the point you want to end trimming.  
IN  
OUT  
TRIM  
A
Perform trimming.  
0
30min  
Press the [ONLINE/3] button to perform  
trimming.  
11:22:33.00  
C
11:23:44.00  
00:08:22  
4030 20 10  
0
B
Memo :  
.
0
While trimming is in progress, you can press the  
[CANCEL] button to return to the thumbnail  
screen.  
A
Guide  
Operation guide  
Position bar  
B
0
When trimming the in and out point, the in point  
trimmed may be up to one second before the  
specified in point and the out point trimmed may  
be up to one second behind the specified out  
point.  
6 : Current position of the video  
7
8
:
:
Position to start trimming (in point)  
Position to end trimming (out point)  
106 Trimming Recorded Clips  
 
A
B
C
[FOCUS ASSIST/1] Button  
Basic Operations in Menu  
Screen  
Adds the selected menu or submenu item to the  
[Favorites Menu].  
[OIS/2] Button  
Resets settings in the [TC Preset] or [UB  
Preset] setting screen.  
0
Pressing the [MENU/THUMB] button displays  
the menu screen on the LCD monitor and  
viewfinder.  
[MENU/THUMB] Button  
0
0
Various settings for shooting and playback can  
be configured on the menu screen.  
There are two types of menu screens - [Main  
Menu] and [Favorites Menu].  
0
Displays the menu screen. The [Main  
Menu] screen is displayed by default.  
During normal usage, [Main Menu] is  
displayed if the previous menu operation  
ended at [Main Menu], and [Favorites  
Menu] if the previous menu operation ended  
at [Favorites Menu].  
0
0
[Main Menu] contains all the setting items of the  
camera recorder, classified according to  
functions and uses, while [Favorites Menu]  
allows users to customize the menu items freely.  
0
0
Press this button to close the menu screen  
during menu display and return to the normal  
screen.  
0
0
The operating procedures and main screen  
displays are the same for both menus.  
The menu screen can also be displayed on  
external monitors connected to the [SDI OUT]  
terminal.  
Pressing and holding down the button while  
the menu is displayed switches the [Main  
Menu] screen to the [Favorites Menu] or vice  
versa.  
D
E
Set Button (R)  
Sets the values and items.  
Operation Buttons  
Cross-shaped Button (JKH I)  
To operate the menu, use the cross-shaped  
buttons on the side operation panel of the camera  
recorder or the cross-shaped buttons at the front of  
the camera or at the bottom of the lens.  
J
:
:
:
:
Moves the cursor upward.  
K
H
I
Moves the cursor downward.  
Moves back to the previous item.  
Moves forward to the next item.  
F
G
[CANCEL] Button  
C
CH2  
8V  
PEAKING  
DISPLAY STATUS  
Cancels settings and returns to the previous  
screen.  
[DISPLAY] Button  
Switches between the [Main Menu] and  
[Favorites Menu] screens.  
G
A
B
FOCUS ASSIST/1  
OIS/2  
ONLINE/3  
AE LOCK/4  
TIME CODE  
MENU/THUMB  
AE LEVEL  
C
D
E
F
ZEBRA/5  
CANCEL  
GAIN  
MARKER/6  
WHT BAL  
SHUTTER  
.
Basic Operations in Menu Screen 107  
     
Changing Setting Values  
Display and Description of the Menu  
Screen  
F
E
Display Settings  
Selecting Menu Items  
A
On  
Off  
Audio Meter  
I
Battery  
Date/Time  
Date Style  
Time Style  
Shutter  
H
D
C
Display Settings  
YMD  
24hour  
SEC  
Audio Meter  
Battery  
Off  
Time  
On  
G
A
B
Date/Time  
Set  
Cancel  
B
F
E
Date Style  
Time Style  
Shutter  
YMD  
24hour  
SEC  
.
A
Menu Item to Change  
C
D
Menu item to be changed.  
Favorites  
Add  
A list of setting values F appears in a pop-up.  
.
B
C
Operation Guide  
A
B
Cursor  
Guide for the current operation buttons.  
Indicates the selected item. Use the cross-  
Setting Values Before Change  
shaped button (JK) to move the cursor  
Setting values before changing. The  
background of the item is displayed in blue.  
Menu Item  
0
Displays the names of the menu item and  
sub-menu.  
D
E
Scroll Bar  
Indicates the scroll position.  
0
Menu items with [...] after them indicates that  
there is a sub-menu to access.  
Cursor  
Indicates the selected item. Use the cross-  
shaped button (JK) to move the cursor  
C
Fixed Item  
Items that cannot be changed are displayed in  
gray and cannot be selected.  
F
List of Setting Values  
0
A pop-up displaying a list of setting values for  
selection.  
D
E
Operation Guide  
Guide for the current operation buttons.  
0
The height of the pop-up depends on the  
number of settings available. Use the scroll  
bar D to confirm the current display status.  
Setting Value  
Setting values for the menu items.  
For menus with sub-menus, values are not  
displayed.  
F
G
Scroll Bar  
Indicates the scroll position.  
Header  
Indicates the current menu type with the line  
color.  
Blue  
Green  
:
:
[Main Menu] Screen  
[Favorites Menu] (Operation  
screen)  
Magenta  
:
[Favorites Menu] (Editing screen)  
H
Remaining Battery Power  
Memo :  
0
If the supplied battery (or equivalent battery sold  
separately) is not used, the battery mark which  
indicates the battery level may not appear.  
I
Menu Title  
Title of the currently displayed menu.  
108 Basic Operations in Menu Screen  
   
Text Input with Software Keyboard  
Use the software keyboard to enter the [Setup  
File] subname, [Clip Name Prefix], and the settings  
under [Network].  
A
B
Character Entry Field  
0
0
Field for entering the title.  
You can enter up to 8 characters for the  
[Setup File] subname or up to 4 characters  
for the [Clip Name Prefix].  
Character Cursor  
Entering a subname  
Select a character using the key cursor D, and  
press the Set button (R) to input the selected  
character at the position of the character cursor.  
The character cursor moves to the next position  
on the right each time a character is input.  
The cursor can be moved using the arrow keys  
H.  
A
B
H
C
D
E
Character Keys  
C
Use the cross-shaped button (JKHI) to move  
the key cursor D to the character you want to  
enter.  
G
F
D
E
Key Cursor  
.
Indicates the currently selected character or  
item. Use the cross-shaped button (JKHI) to  
move the cursor.  
Entering the [Clip Name Prefix]  
Confirmation Buttons  
0
0
Select [Set]/[Store] and press the Set button  
(R) to confirm the title.  
A
B
Select [Cancel] and press the Set button (R)  
on the side control panel of the camera  
recorder to abort character input and return  
to the previous screen.  
H
E
C
F
G
[SP] Space Key  
Select [SP] and press the Set button (R) on the  
side control panel of the camera recorder to  
enter a space at the current position of the  
character cursor B.  
Cancel  
Set  
D
.
[3 ] Backspace Key  
Settings under [Network]  
Select [3 ] and press the Set button (R) on the  
side control panel of the camera recorder to  
delete the character on the left of the character  
cursor B.  
The keyboard displayed varies according to the  
settings.  
H
I
Arrow Keys  
A
Moves the position of the character cursor B.  
Character Switch Button  
Switches the character buttons C to the upper  
case, lower case, and symbols.  
H
G
B
C
I
F
E
D
.
Basic Operations in Menu Screen 109  
   
- [VF Bright] .................................. (A P 125)  
- [VF Contrast] .............................. (A P 125)  
- [LCD Contrast] ............................ (A P 125)  
- [LCD Backlight] .......................... (A P 125)  
- [LCD Mirror] ................................ (A P 125)  
- [Convert to ITU709] .................... (A P 125)  
- [LCD RGB Gain] ......................... (A P 126)  
- [VF RGB Gain] ............................ (A P 126)  
- [A/V Set...] ....................................... (A P 130)  
- [Video Set...] ............................... (A P 130)  
- [Audio Set...] ............................... (A P 132)  
- [Network] ........................................ (A P 135)  
- [Connection Setup...] .................. (A P 135)  
- [Live Streaming...] ...................... (A P 135)  
- [Return over IP...] ........................ (A P 135)  
- [Web...] ....................................... (A P 135)  
- [Metadata Server...] .................... (A P 135)  
- [Upload Settings] ........................ (A P 135)  
- [Import Metadata] ....................... (A P 135)  
- [Zero Config] .............................. (A P 136)  
- [Reset Network] .......................... (A P 136)  
- [Overlay Settings...] A L ......... (A P 144)  
- [Overlay Function] ...................... (A P 144)  
- [Layout] ...................................... (A P 144)  
- [Import User Layout] ................... (A P 144)  
- [Delete User Layout] ................... (A P 144)  
- [Type] ......................................... (A P 144)  
- [Overlay Custom Menu]L* ..... (A P 144)  
- [Output...] ................................... (A P 144)  
- [Sportzcast] L ........................ (A P 145)  
- [Watermark] ................................ (A P 145)  
- [Full Screen Graphic...] ............... (A P 145)  
- [Password Lock] ......................... (A P 145)  
- [System...] ....................................... (A P 147)  
- [Record Set...] ............................ (A P 147)  
- [Media] ....................................... (A P 147)  
- [Setup File] ................................. (A P 147)  
- [Tally Lamp] ................................ (A P 147)  
- [NETWORK LED] ....................... (A P 148)  
- [STATUS LED] ........................... (A P 148)  
- [LED Bright] ................................ (A P 148)  
- [GPS] A L .......................... (A P 148)  
- [Language] ................................. (A P 148)  
- [Reset All] ................................... (A P 148)  
- [Date/Time] ................................. (A P 148)  
- [Date Style] ................................. (A P 148)  
- [Time Style] ................................ (A P 149)  
- [Time Zone] ................................ (A P 149)  
- [Reserved] .................................. (A P 149)  
- [System Information] ................... (A P 149)  
Menu Screen Hierarchical  
Chart  
[Main Menu...] ..................................... (A P 110)  
- [Camera Function...] ....................... (A P 111)  
- [Bars] .......................................... (A P 111)  
- [OIS] ........................................... (A P 111)  
- [Shutter] ...................................... (A P 111)  
- [AE Level] ................................... (A P 111)  
- [AE Speed] ................................. (A P 111)  
- [AE Area] .................................... (A P 111)  
- [AGC Limit] ................................. (A P 111)  
- [Auto Iris Limit (OPEN)] .............. (A P 112)  
- [Auto Iris Limit (CLOSE)] ............ (A P 112)  
- [EEI Limit] ................................... (A P 112)  
- [Smooth Trans] ........................... (A P 112)  
- [GAIN L] ...................................... (A P 112)  
- [GAIN M] ..................................... (A P 112)  
- [GAIN H] ..................................... (A P 112)  
- [Zoom...] ..................................... (A P 112)  
- [Focus...] .................................... (A P 112)  
- [Face Detection...] ...................... (A P 112)  
- [Infrared] ..................................... (A P 113)  
- [User Switch Set...] ..................... (A P 113)  
- [KEYLOCK] ................................ (A P 113)  
- [Menu Access] ............................ (A P 113)  
- [Camera Angle[Tagging]] L .... (A P 113)  
- [Camera Process...] ........................ (A P 118)  
- [Color Space] ............................. (A P 118)  
- [Gamma] .................................... (A P 118)  
- [Detail] ........................................ (A P 119)  
- [Master Black] ............................ (A P 119)  
- [Black Toe] ................................. (A P 120)  
- [Knee] ......................................... (A P 120)  
- [White Clip] ................................. (A P 121)  
- [White Balance...] ....................... (A P 121)  
- [Color Matrix] .............................. (A P 122)  
- [Color Gain] ................................ (A P 122)  
- [Reverse Picture] ........................ (A P 122)  
- [Reset Process] .......................... (A P 122)  
- [TC/UB...] ........................................ (A P 124)  
- [TC Generator] ........................... (A P 124)  
- [TC Preset] ................................. (A P 124)  
- [UB Mode] .................................. (A P 124)  
- [Drop Frame] .............................. (A P 124)  
- [LCD/VF...] ...................................... (A P 125)  
- [Shooting Assist...] ...................... (A P 125)  
- [Marker Settings...] ..................... (A P 125)  
- [Display Type...] .......................... (A P 125)  
- [Display On/Off...] ....................... (A P 125)  
- [VF Color] ................................... (A P 125)  
Memo :  
0
Some menus cannot be set depending on the operating mode or status of the camera recorder. These  
items are displayed in gray, and they cannot be selected.  
0
Setting value with the R mark is the factory default.  
*
The display of the [Overlay Custom Menu] changes according to the imported data.  
110 Menu Screen Hierarchical Chart  
   
Shutter  
Camera Function Menu  
For specifying shutter-related settings.  
Configure the value to “Step” (fixed value) or  
“Variable” when operating the shutter with the  
cross-shaped button (J K) on the side of the  
camera recorder unit.  
Menu screen for specifying operation settings  
during shooting.  
This item can only be selected in the Camera  
mode.  
0
Variable:  
Bars  
Sets to variable scan. Use this setting when  
shooting a PC monitor.  
Step:  
For setting whether to output color bars.  
0
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Sets to step shutter, which switches the shutter  
speed by a fixed value.  
Memo :  
0
The audio test signals (1 kHz) can be output  
simultaneously with the color bar output.  
[Setting Values: Variable, RStep]  
AE Level  
For setting the convergence level during AE (Auto  
Exposure).  
OIS  
This can also be adjusted using the cross-shaped  
button (H I) on the side of the camera recorder  
unit.  
For setting whether to enable image stabilizer.  
When “On” is selected, set the Level.  
To turn on the [Hard Lock] function, configure OIS  
to “Off”.  
[Setting Values: -6 to +6 (R0)]  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
AE Speed  
For setting the convergence speed during AE (Auto  
Exposure).  
9
Level  
[Setting Values: RFast, Middle, Slow]  
For setting the level of the image stabilizer.  
[Setting Values: High, RNormal]  
AE Area  
Memo :  
For configuring the AE detection area.  
0
The icon changes according to the level set.  
[Setting Values: Center, Bottom, RNormal]  
0
When “High” is selected, correcting severe  
camera shake may cause the area surrounding  
the image to darken.  
AGC Limit  
For setting the maximum gain value of “AGC”,  
which electrically boosts the sensitivity level  
according to the brightness automatically.  
9
Hard Lock  
0
When [LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B [Gain] is set  
to “dB”:  
When the Hard Lock feature is “On”, the IS (image  
stabilization) lens is locked in place.  
Use this feature when blurry image caused by  
camera shake tends to occur due to strong  
acceleration.  
[Setting Values: 24 dB, R18 dB, 12 dB, 6 dB]  
When [LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B [Gain] is set  
to “ISO”:  
0
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
[Setting Values: ISO 12800, RISO 6400, ISO  
3200, ISO 1600]  
Memo :  
Memo :  
0
Camera shake that causes image blur occurs  
0
When [FULL AUTO] is set to “ON”, this item  
appears as “---” and cannot be selected.  
when switching between “On” and “Off”.  
Camera Function Menu 111  
                 
Auto Iris Limit (OPEN)  
GAIN L, GAIN M, GAIN H  
For setting the limit value of the OPEN end when  
auto iris is enabled.  
For setting the gain value of each position on the  
[GAIN] selection switch.  
[Setting Values: F5.6, F4, Open]  
The setting is fixed at “AGC” in the Full Auto mode.  
In addition, the sensitivity setting in [Lolux] is used.  
Memo :  
0
When [FULL AUTO] is set to “ON”, this item  
appears as “---” and cannot be selected.  
0
When [LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B [Gain] is set  
to “dB”:  
[Setting Values: 24 dB, 21 dB, 18 dB, 15 dB, 12  
dB, 9 dB, 6 dB, 3 dB, 0 dB, -3 dB, -6 dB]  
(Default values for GAIN L: 0dB, GAIN M: 6dB,  
GAIN H: 12dB)  
Auto Iris Limit (CLOSE)  
For setting the limit value of the CLOSE end when  
auto iris is enabled.  
[Setting Values: F16, RF11, F8, F5.6]  
0
When [LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B [Gain] is set  
to “ISO” and [Camera Process] B [Color  
Space] is set to a value other than “HLG”:  
[Setting Values: ISO12800, ISO10000,  
ISO8000, ISO6400, ISO5000, ISO4000,  
ISO3200, ISO2500, ISO2000, ISO1600,  
ISO1250, ISO1000, ISO800, ISO640, ISO500,  
ISO400]  
Memo :  
0
When [FULL AUTO] is set to “ON”, this item  
appears as “---” and cannot be selected.  
EEI Limit  
For setting the shutter speed control range when  
the Automatic Shutter mode (EEI) is enabled.  
[Setting Values: 4F-stop, R3F-stop, 2F-stop]  
(Default values for GAIN L: ISO800, GAIN M:  
ISO1600, GAIN H: ISO3200)  
Memo :  
0
Memo :  
When “J-Log1” is selected for [Camera  
Process] B [Color Space], the base ISO speed  
for achieving the 800% dynamic range of [J-  
Log1] is “[ISO1250]”. The square brackets  
appear only in the case of the base ISO.  
0
When [FULL AUTO] is set to “ON”, this item  
appears as “---” and cannot be selected.  
Smooth Trans  
For setting the shock reduction function, which  
slows down the sudden change when switching  
with the [GAIN] or [WHT BAL] switch.  
[Setting Values: Fast, Middle, Slow, ROff]  
Memo :  
Zoom...  
For specifying zoom settings.  
0
0
This function is disabled when AGC is operating.  
When “J-Log1” or “HLG” is selected for [Camera  
Process] B [Color Space], the setting is fixed at  
“Off” and the selection cannot be changed.  
Focus...  
For specifying focus settings.  
Face Detection...  
For specifying face detection settings.  
112 Camera Function Menu  
             
Zoom Function Settings  
Dynamic Zoom  
Infrared  
When “On” is selected, an I icon appears and the  
camera recorder switches to the infrared recording  
mode that is suitable for night recording.  
For setting whether to enable the dynamic zoom  
function.  
Using infrared illumination allows images to be  
captured naturally in a pitch-dark environment. It is  
recommended for observation of animals without  
alerting them or for natural facial expressions  
without firing glaring flash light at the subject.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
0
On:  
Enables the dynamic zoom (1x to 40x).  
Off:  
0
Enables only the optical zoom (1x to 20x).  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
Caution :  
0
When [System] is set to “4K EXT (SSD)”, “4K” or  
“High-Speed”, this item is fixed at “Off” and  
cannot be selected.  
0
Do not use infrared recording for capturing  
strong light sources or heat sources. Doing so  
may damage the camera recorder.  
0
When [Digital Extender] is set to “On”, “Off”  
becomes fixed and cannot be selected.  
Memo :  
0
This is fixed at “Off” when [FULL AUTO] is set to  
“ON”.  
9
Response  
0
The settings are fixed as followed when it is  
configured to “On”.  
For specifying the speed of zoom response when  
Dynamic Zoom is “On”.  
0
Manual focus  
[Setting Values: Slow, RNormal]  
0
ND filter “OFF”  
0
[Camera Function] B [Focus] B [AF Assist]  
Memo :  
and [MF Assist] appear as “---”.  
0
When [Dynamic Zoom] is “Off”, this item  
appears as “---” and cannot be selected.  
0
All items other than [Color Space] and  
[Reverse Picture] under [Camera Process]  
appear as “---”.  
Digital Extender  
0
0
The zoom and focus positions will be initialized  
after the settings are changed.  
For specifying whether to magnify the image (by 2  
times). When “On” is selected, a F icon appears.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
When [Infrared] is configured to “On”, if the type  
of light source changes after focus is  
established, the image may go out of focus.  
Memo :  
0
When [System] is set to “4K EXT (SSD)”, “4K” or  
“High-Speed”, this item is fixed at “Off” and  
cannot be selected.  
User Switch Set...  
For specifying user button related settings.  
0
When [Dynamic Zoom] is set to “On”, “Off”  
becomes fixed and cannot be selected.  
KEYLOCK  
Handle Zoom Speed  
For specifying the settings when the [KEYLOCK]  
switch is set to “ON”.  
[Setting Values: RKeylock Except Rec, Keylock  
All]  
This function allows you to set the zoom speed of  
the zoom lever at the handle when the [ZOOM FIX/  
VAR/OFF] switch is set to “FIX”.  
[Setting Values: 1 to 8 (R 5)]  
Menu Access  
For specifying settings on the behavior when  
accessing the menu using the [MENU/THUMB]  
button.  
[Setting Values: Press and Hold, ROne Press]  
Camera Angle[Tagging] L  
For specifying tagging settings for the camera  
angle.  
[Setting Values: SB, RSL, EZ, SL2, EZ2, TV]  
Camera Function Menu 113  
               
Focus Function Settings  
AF Assist  
Focus Tracking  
For specifying whether to track the focus during  
zooming.  
For specifying the behavior when the focus ring is  
turned during AF.  
0
On:  
Tracks the focus during zooming.  
Off:  
0
Direction:  
0
This option allows you to shift the auto focus  
point to near and far directions by turning the  
focus ring during AF.  
Gives priority to the zoom speed and does not  
track the focus during zooming.  
[Setting Values: ROn, Off]  
0
0
Manual:  
Memo :  
Temporarily switches to MF when the focus ring  
is turned during AF.  
0
Zoom speed may be affected when zooming is  
performed near the tele-end.  
Off:  
Sets the AF Assist function to “Off”.  
Preset Zoom  
[Setting Values: Direction, Manual, ROff]  
For setting the speed for shifting to the preset zoom  
position and the rate of change for starting and  
stopping the preset zoom operation of the preset  
zoom function assigned to the user button.  
Memo :  
0
This setting is effective only when the [FOCUS]  
switch is set to “AUTO”.  
9
Speed  
AF Speed  
For setting the speed to shift to the preset zoom  
For setting the AF operation speed.  
position.  
[Setting Values: Fast, RMiddle, Slow]  
[Setting Values: 1 to 21 (R11)]  
AF Sensitivity  
9
Ease In  
For specifying the sensitivity of AF in response to  
changes in the photographic subject.  
For setting the rate of change from the start of the  
zoom operation until the predetermined [Speed] is  
reached.  
0
0
0
High: High sensitivity  
Middle: Normal  
The larger the setting value, the longer it takes to  
reach the value specified in Speed.  
[Setting Values: 1 to 5, ROff]  
Low: Low sensitivity  
[Setting Values: High, RMiddle, Low]  
9
Ease Out  
AF Area  
For setting the rate of change from the  
predetermined [Speed] until the zoom operation  
stops.  
For configuring the AF area.  
0
Multi:  
Automatically configures to an area optimal for  
The larger the setting value, the longer it takes  
before the operation stops.  
recording.  
0
0
Wide:  
[Setting Values: 1 to 5, ROff]  
Extends the AF area sideways.  
Normal:  
REMOTE Zoom Ease  
Performs AF at the area near the center of the  
image.  
For specifying whether to zoom in or zoom out  
slowly when zoom operation starts or during  
zooming using a wired remote control.  
[Setting Values: ROn, Off]  
[Setting Values: Multi, Wide, RNormal]  
Web Zoom Ease  
For specifying whether to zoom in or zoom out  
slowly when zoom operation starts or during  
zooming using the View Remote feature.  
[Setting Values: ROn, Off]  
114 Camera Function Menu  
       
Face Detection Function Settings  
Mode  
MF Assist  
For specifying the behavior when the focus ring is  
turned during MF.  
For configuring the behavior when operating the  
user button that is assigned with the “Face  
Detection” function in the Auto Focus mode.  
Select the control to track results of face detection.  
0
On:  
Turning the focus ring during MF activates AF  
for a short interval after the operation, after  
which the camera recorder returns to the MF  
mode. However, it does not function while in the  
expanded focus mode.  
0
AF&AE:  
Sets auto focus and exposure control for the  
face that is being tracked.  
0
Off:  
Does not switch temporarily to AF when the  
focus ring is turned during MF.  
0
AF:  
Sets auto focus for the face that is being tracked.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
[Setting Values: RAF&AE, AF]  
Limitter  
For specifying the closest focusing distance.  
When [LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B [Focus] is set  
to “Meter”:  
Memo :  
0
When “AF&AE” is selected, this function will be  
activated when the [FOCUS AUTO/MANU]  
switch is set to “AUTO” and when at least one of  
the Iris, Shutter and Gain items is configured to  
Auto mode.  
[Setting Values: 5 m - ∞, 3 m - ∞, 1 m - ∞, ROff]  
When [LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B [Focus] is  
configured to “Feet”:  
[Setting values: 16 ft - ∞, 10 ft - ∞, 3 ft - ∞, ROff]  
0
When “AF” is specified, this function will be  
activated only when the [FOCUS AUTO/  
MANU] switch is set to “AUTO”.  
AF Hold during Zoom  
For specifying AF operation during zoom  
operation.  
Face Only AF  
0
Hold:  
For activating auto focusing only for the face of the  
subject.  
Constricts AF operation and performs silent  
zooming during the zoom operation.  
Off:  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
0
Activates AF operation during zooming.  
Memo :  
[Setting Values: Hold, ROff]  
0
When a face cannot be detected when this is  
configured to “On”, the camera recorder  
switches to manual focusing.  
Sensitivity  
For setting the level of ease of face detection.  
[Setting Values: RHigh, Middle, Low]  
Holding Duration  
For specifying duration to maintain the current  
focus when the camera loses track of the face.  
Set to “Short” to select another object immediately  
if the face on the screen is lost.  
Set to “Long” to operate at the same position for  
some time even if the face on the screen is lost.  
[Setting Values: Long, RNormal, Short]  
Camera Function Menu 115  
     
User Switch Set Item  
Lolux  
To increase the sensitivity when in dim  
USER1 to USER9, USER10 ▲, USER11 ▼,  
USER12 ◀, USER13 ▶  
surroundings, set a value in the Lolux mode.  
0
When [LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B [Gain] is set  
to “dB”:  
Assigning one of the functions in the following  
menu to the [FOCUS ASSIST/1], [OIS/2],  
[ONLINE/3], [AE LOCK/4], [ZEBRA/5], [MARKER/  
6], [USER7], [USER8] or [EXP.FOCUS/9] button or  
the [▲/10], [▼/11], [◀/12] or [▶/13] front cross-  
shaped button enables operation of the said  
preconfigured function (on/off, launching,  
switching).  
[Setting Values: R36 dB, 30 dB]  
When [LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B [Gain] is set  
to “ISO”:  
0
[Setting Values: RISO 51200, ISO 25600]  
Clip Review  
For configuring the behavior when operating the  
user button that is assigned with the “Clip  
Review” function.  
Set according to the shooting conditions. Usable in  
the Camera mode.  
0
0
0
Last 5sec:  
Views about 5 seconds of the clip from the  
[Setting Values: Cancel, Menu, Slot Select, Return  
Video, Return over IP, Auto Upload, Live  
Streaming, Load Picture File, Clip Review, OK  
Mark, Clip Cutter Trig, Backup Trig, Rec, LCD  
Backlight, Spot Meter, Focus Assist, Expanded  
Focus, Focus Assist +, Marker, Histogram, Zebra,  
AWB, White Balance, Preset Zoom3, Preset  
Zoom2, Preset Zoom1, Digital Extender, OIS,  
Black Compress, Black Stretch, Face Only AF,  
Face Detection, AE Lock, Lolux, Bars, None]  
ending.  
Top 5sec:  
Views about 5 seconds of the clip from the  
beginning.  
Clip:  
Views the entire clip.  
[Setting Values: RLast 5sec, Top 5sec, Clip]  
Spot Meter  
For configuring the behavior when operating the  
user button that is assigned with the “Spot Meter”  
function.  
Memo :  
0
0
0
0
“Cancel” and “Menu” can only be assigned to  
[USER7] or [USER8].  
0
Max & Min:  
“Rec” cannot be assigned to [FOCUS  
ASSIST/1], [OIS/2] and [ONLINE/3].  
“Focus Assist +” is a combination of the “Focus  
Assist” and “Expanded Focus” functions.  
The following functions can be assigned only for  
GY-HC500SPCU.  
Displays the brightest and darkest areas of the  
image.  
0
0
0
Max:  
Displays the brightest area of the image.  
Min:  
Displays the darkest area of the image.  
Manual:  
[ODK Tagging]OFF, [ODK Tagging]KO, [ODK  
Tagging]KOR, [ODK Tagging]P, [ODK  
Tagging]PR, [ODK Tagging]FG, [ODK  
Tagging]FGB, [ODK Tagging]REMOVE  
Displays the image brightness at a specified  
position.  
[Setting Values: RMax & Min, Max, Min, Manual]  
Memo :  
0
When “HLG” is selected in [Camera Process] B  
[Color Space], the value of the spot meter  
changes according to the setting of [LCD/VF] B  
[Convert to ITU709]/[White Level].  
116 Camera Function Menu  
       
AE Lock  
Expanded Focus  
For configuring the behavior when operating the  
user button that is assigned with the “AE Lock”  
function.  
For configuring the behavior when operating the  
user button that is assigned with the “Expanded  
Focus” function.  
0
0
0
FAW:  
0
Limited Time:  
Use this to fix the FAW (Full-time Auto White  
Balance) function to the value when the user  
button assigned with “AE Lock” is pressed.  
AE:  
Activates the timer.  
Turns off the “Expanded Focus” function about  
3 seconds after the user button assigned with  
“Expanded Focus” is pressed.  
Momentary:  
Use this to fix the Auto function of Gain, Iris, or  
Shutter to the value when the user button  
assigned with “AE Lock” is pressed.  
AE/FAW:  
0
0
The “Expanded Focus” function is enabled  
during the interval while the user button  
assigned with “Expanded Focus” is pressed.  
Toggle:  
Use this to fix the FAW (Full-time Auto White  
Balance) function and the Auto function of Gain,  
Iris, or Shutter to the value when the user button  
assigned with “AE Lock” is pressed.  
Pressing the user button assigned with  
“Expanded Focus” each time switches the  
“Expanded Focus” function to on or off.  
[Setting Values: FAW, RAE, AE/FAW]  
[Setting Values: Limited Time, Momentary,  
Memo :  
RToggle]  
0
This feature only works when Iris, Shutter, Gain  
Memo :  
or White Balance is set to Auto mode.  
0
When one of the [J/10], [K/11], [H/12], [I/13]  
buttons is assigned with “Expanded Focus” and  
“Toggle” is selected, press the [CANCEL] button  
to turn off the function.  
0
“AE Lock” is canceled when the user button  
assigned with “AE Lock” is pressed, or when any  
of the functions that can be locked is operated  
regardless of the mode (Manual or Auto).  
“AE Lock” is canceled in the following cases.  
0
0
When the user button that is assigned with  
“AE Lock” is pressed  
0
When changes are made to the iris, gain or  
shutter settings  
0
When changes are made to the AE level  
0
When there is a switch between the Camera  
and Media modes  
Camera Function Menu 117  
   
9
Colorimetry  
Camera Process Menu  
For configuring the standard for converting R, G, B  
signals to Y, Cb, Cr signals when [Color Space] is  
configured to “HLG” or “ITU2020”.  
Menu screen for adjusting the quality of camera  
images.  
0
ITU2020:  
This item cannot be selected in the Media mode.  
Records and outputs ITU2020 RGB signals  
using the Y-Cb-Cr signal conversion coefficient.  
ITU709:  
Color Space  
0
For configuring the color space that is used inside  
the camera.  
Records and outputs ITU709 RGB signals using  
the Y-Cb-Cr signal conversion coefficient.  
The gamma and color gamut change automatically  
according to the selected color space.  
When [System] is configured to a setting other than  
“SD”  
[Setting Values: RITU2020, ITU709]  
Memo :  
0
0
0
This item is available when [Color Space] is set  
to “HLG” or “ITU2020”.  
0
0
0
0
J-Log1:  
This is fixed at “ITU709” when [Color Space] is  
set to “J-Log1” or “ITU709”.  
Color space that supports 800% dynamic range  
and log gamma  
HLG:  
This is fixed at “ITU601” when [System] is set to  
“SD”.  
Color space that supports the ITU2100 HLG  
HDR  
ITU2020:  
Gamma  
Color space that supports the ITU2020 wide  
color gamut  
For adjusting the gamma curve that determines the  
gradation expression.  
ITU709:  
ITU709 color space  
[Setting Values: J-Log1, HLG, ITU2020, RITU709]  
0
0
0
Cinema 2:  
When [System] is set to “SD”  
Sets to a gamma curve with soft expression  
giving priority to high luminance gradation.  
Cinema 1:  
0
0
ITU601 (EBU):  
Color space that supports the EBU color gamut  
ITU601 (170M):  
Sets to a gamma curve with similar gradation to  
the screen characteristics of movies.  
Standard:  
Color space that supports the SMPTE170M  
color gamut  
0
ITU709:  
Sets to a standard gamma curve.  
ITU709 color space  
[Setting Values: Cinema 2, Cinema 1, RStandard]  
Memo :  
0
[Setting Values: ITU601 (EBU), ITU601 (170M),  
RITU709]  
[Gamma] cannot be configured when [Color  
Space] is set to “HLG” or “J-Log1”. “HLG  
Gamma” is used during “HLG” and “J-Log1  
Gamma” is used during “J-Log1”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
Memo :  
0
When [System] is configured to a setting other  
than “SD” and “J-Log1” or “HLG” is selected,  
some menu items under [Camera Process]  
cannot be configured.  
0
0
The AE function does not function when “J-  
Log1” or “HLG” is selected.  
118 Camera Process Menu  
       
9
9
Level  
Frequency  
The amount of correction can be specified  
separately when [Gamma] is set to “Standard”,  
“Cinema 1” or “Cinema 2”.  
For specifying the correction frequency of the  
contour. Set this according to the object.  
0
High:  
Emphasizes the high frequency range. Use this  
when shooting objects with fine patterns.  
Middle:  
When [Gamma] is set to “Standard”  
[Setting Values: 0.35 to R 0.45 to 0.55 (in steps of  
0.02)]  
0
0
Emphasizes the intermediate frequency range.  
Low:  
0
Increase the number:  
Finer gradation at bright areas and coarser  
gradation at dark areas.  
Emphasizes the low frequency range. Use this  
when shooting objects with large patterns.  
0
Decrease the number:  
[Setting Values: High, RMiddle, Low]  
Finer gradation at dark areas and coarser  
gradation at bright areas.  
Memo :  
When [Gamma] is set to “Cinema 1” or “Cinema 2”  
0
Available when [System] is set to “4K EXT  
(SSD)” or “4K”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
[Setting Values: +5 to R 0 to -5]  
0
Increase the number:  
0
Finer gradation at dark areas and coarser  
gradation at bright areas.  
0
Decrease the number:  
Master Black  
Finer gradation at bright areas and coarser  
gradation at dark areas.  
For adjusting the pedestal level (master black) that  
serves as the reference black.  
Memo :  
Increasing the value increases the pedestal.  
[Setting Values: +50 to -50 (R-3)]  
0
When [Gamma] is set to “Standard” with the  
value set at [0.45], the gamma adjusted  
conforms to ITU709 or ITU2020.  
Memo :  
0
If [Gamma] is set to “Cinema 2”, the maximum  
peak signal decreases from 109% as the  
number becomes smaller in the setting values  
from 0 to -5. When the level is at -5, the video  
input with a dynamic range of 400% will be kept  
within a 100% output.  
0
0
0
This item cannot be configured when [Color  
Space] is set to “J-Log1”.  
The setting value of this item is stored separately  
when [Color Space] is set to “HLG”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
0
0
This item cannot be configured when [Color  
Space] is configured to “HLG” or “J-Log1”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
Detail  
For adjusting the contour (detail) enhancement  
level.  
Increasing the value increases the sharpness of  
the contour.  
[Setting Values: +10 to -10, Off]  
(Default Value: -6 for “J-Log1” and “HLG” of Color  
Space; 0 for all other settings)  
Memo :  
0
The setting values of this item and [Adjust...] are  
stored separately when [Color Space] is set to  
“HLG” or “J-Log1”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
0
Camera Process Menu 119  
   
9
Black Toe  
Compress Level  
Compression amount increases when a larger  
Process the dark areas according to the balance of  
bright and dark areas in the image to adjust the  
overall balance of contrast.  
value is specified.  
[Setting Values: 5 to 1 (R 3)]  
Memo :  
For altering the gain of dark areas. Adjust this item  
according to the condition of the captured video  
signals.  
0
This item is displayed only when [Black Toe] is  
set to “Compress”. Otherwise, this item appears  
as “---” and cannot be selected.  
This item cannot be configured when [Color  
Space] is set to “J-Log1” or “HLG”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
0
Stretch:  
Increases the gain of dark areas in an image to  
stretch the signals of these areas only, thereby  
showing the contrast between bright and dark  
areas more clearly.  
0
0
Specify the amount of stretch with [Stretch  
Level].  
0
0
Normal:  
Knee  
Normal condition.  
For specifying the “Knee” operation, which  
compresses video signals beyond a certain level to  
show the gradation of the highlighted portion. To  
check the gradation of a bright area, set to “Manual”  
and adjust the knee point (starting point of knee  
operation) manually.  
Compress:  
Compresses the gain of dark areas to increase  
the contrast when the entire image appears  
bright and contrast is weak. Specify the  
compression amount with [Compress Level].  
[Setting Values: Stretch, RNormal, Compress]  
0
Manual:  
Memo :  
Enables manual adjustment of knee point using  
0
This item cannot be configured when [Color  
Space] is set to “J-Log1” or “HLG”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
[Level].  
Auto:  
0
0
Adjusts the knee point automatically according  
to the luminance level.  
[Setting Values: Manual, RAuto]  
9
Stretch Level  
Memo :  
Stretch amount increases when a larger value is  
0
This item cannot be configured when [Color  
Space] is set to “J-Log1” or “HLG” and when  
[Gamma] is set to “Cinema 2”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
specified.  
[Setting Values: 5 to 1 (R 3)]  
Memo :  
0
0
This item is displayed only when [Black Toe] is  
set to “Stretch”. Otherwise, this item appears as  
“---” and cannot be selected.  
This item cannot be configured when [Color  
Space] is set to “J-Log1” or “HLG”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
9
Level  
0
0
For setting the starting point (knee point) of knee  
compression when [Knee] is set to “Manual”.  
[Setting Values: 100.0%, 97.5%, R95.0%, 92.5%,  
90.0%, 87.5%, 85.0%, 82.5%, 80.0%, 77.5%,  
75.0%, 72.5%, 70.0%]  
Memo :  
0
0
This item cannot be configured when [Knee] is  
set to “Auto”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Color  
Space] is set to “J-Log1” or “HLG” and when  
[Gamma] is set to “Cinema 2”.  
0
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
120 Camera Process Menu  
   
9
Sensitivity  
White Clip  
For setting the response speed of the “Knee”  
operation when [Knee] is set to “Auto”.  
Set to “Slow” when shooting an object under a  
condition where there is drastic change in the light  
intensity.  
For setting the point to apply white clip for video  
signals with a high luminance level.  
0
0
0
109%:  
Applies white clip at the point where the  
luminance level is 109%.  
103%:  
[Setting Values: RFast, Middle, Slow]  
Applies white clip at the point where the  
luminance level is 103 %.  
100%:  
Memo :  
0
This item cannot be configured when [Knee] is  
set to “Manual”.  
Applies white clip at the point where the  
luminance level is 100 %. Set to this value when  
the system in use limits Y output signals within  
100 %.  
0
This item cannot be configured when [Color  
Space] is set to “J-Log1” or “HLG” and when  
[Gamma] is set to “Cinema 2”.  
[Setting Values: R109%, 103%, 100%]  
0
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
Memo :  
0
The setting value of this item is stored separately  
when [Color Space] is set to “HLG” or “J-Log1”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
9
Peak Filter  
0
For configuring the response speed of the “Knee”  
operation with respect to a high-luminance point  
light source and the like when [Knee] is configured  
to “Auto”.  
[Setting Values: RHigh, Middle, Low]  
Memo :  
White Balance...  
Menu for adjusting white balance.  
0
This item cannot be configured when [Knee] is  
set to “Manual”.  
*
0
This item cannot be configured when [Color  
Space] is set to “J-Log1” or “HLG” and when  
[Gamma] is set to “Cinema 2”.  
0
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
Camera Process Menu 121  
   
Color Matrix  
Color Gain  
For setting the color matrix.  
For adjusting the video signal color level.  
Increasing the value deepens the color.  
[Setting Values: +15 to -50, Off (R0)]  
0
Natural:  
Sets to a brighter and more natural color matrix  
than the standard. Effective for shooting under  
a strong single color light source such as stage  
lightings.  
Memo :  
0
0
0
0
Images are displayed in black-and-white when  
this is set to “Off”.  
0
0
Cinema Subdued:  
This item cannot be configured when [Color  
Space] is set to “J-Log1”.  
The setting value of this item is stored separately  
when [Color Space] is set to “HLG”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
Sets to a subdued color matrix that is similar to  
the screen characteristics of movies.  
Cinema Vivid:  
Sets to a vivid color matrix that is similar to the  
screen characteristics of movies.  
Standard:  
0
0
Sets to a standard color matrix.  
Off:  
Reverse Picture  
Sets the color matrix function to Off.  
[Setting Values: Natural, Cinema Subdued,  
For recording images correctly by setting this item  
to “Rotate” when the lens image appears upside  
down or laterally inverted.  
Cinema Vivid, RStandard, Off]  
Memo :  
0
Rotate:  
0
This item cannot be configured when [Color  
Space] is set to “J-Log1” or “HLG”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
Enables horizontal/vertical inversion of the  
image.  
0
0
Off:  
Disables horizontal/vertical inversion of the  
image.  
9
Adjust  
[Setting Values: Rotate, ROff]  
This item is used to adjust [Color Matrix] to a color  
Reset Process  
according to the user’s preference.  
The adjusted values of “Natural”, “Standard”,  
“Cinema Vivid”, and “Cinema Subdued” in [Color  
Matrix] can be stored individually.  
Restores all items in the [Camera Process] menu  
to their default settings.  
0
The saturation and hue of Red, Green and Blue  
can be configured individually.  
[Setting range for Saturation: -10 to +10] (roughly  
± 10%)  
[Setting range for Hue: -10 to +10]  
Memo :  
0
0
0
This item cannot be configured when [Color  
Space] is set to “J-Log1”.  
This item cannot be selected when [Color  
Matrix] is set to “Off”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Infrared]  
is set to “On”.  
122 Camera Process Menu  
     
White Balance Item  
Preset Temp.  
AWB Paint  
For adjusting the R (red)/B (blue) component in the  
AWB (Auto White Balance) mode.  
For setting the color temperature when the [WHT  
BAL] switch is set to “PRESET”.  
0
Increase the number:  
Strengthens the red/blue.  
Decrease the number:  
Weakens the red/blue.  
0
Alternative Temp.  
[Setting Values: -32 to +32 (R 0)]  
For setting the alternative color temperature in the  
Preset mode.  
Memo :  
0
This item is selectable when the [WHT BAL]  
switch is set to “A” or “B”. When “PRESET” is set,  
this item appears as “---” and cannot be  
selected.  
When the [WHT BAL] switch is set to “PRESET”,  
pressing the [y] or the user button assigned with  
the “AWB” function each time switches the color  
temperature setting in the Preset mode. ([Preset  
Temp.]1[Alternative Temp.])  
0
0
Different values can be specified for “A” and “B”.  
When [Clear Paint After AWB] is configured to  
“On”, pressing the [y] button or the user button  
assigned with the “AWB” function to readjust the  
white balance switches the R and B values to  
“0”.  
Preset Paint Memory  
For configuring whether to configure the color  
temperature individually or collectively in the  
Preset mode. Adjustment is performed in [Preset  
Paint].  
Clear Paint After AWB  
For specifying whether to clear the [AWB Paint] (R  
value and B value) settings after executing AWB  
(Auto White Balance).  
0
Individual:  
Each of the 9 types of color temperatures  
(2300K, 3000K, 3200K, 4200K, 4800K, 5200K,  
5600K, 6500K, 7500K) are configured  
individually.  
0
On:  
Sets the [AWB Paint] (R value and B value)  
settings to “0” after executing AWB (Auto White  
Balance).  
0
Common:  
The entire color temperature range is configured  
collectively.  
0
Off:  
Does not change the [AWB Paint] (R value and  
B value) settings after executing AWB (Auto  
White Balance).  
[Setting Values: Individual, RCommon]  
Preset Paint  
[Setting Values: ROn, Off]  
For adjusting the R (red) and (B) blue components  
in the Preset mode.  
FAW Paint  
0
Increase the number:  
Strengthens the red/blue.  
Decrease the number:  
Weakens the red/blue.  
For adjusting the R (red)/B (blue) component  
during FAW (Full Auto White Balance) mode.  
0
0
Increase the number:  
Strengthens the red/blue.  
Decrease the number:  
Weakens the red/blue.  
[Setting Values: +32 to -32 (R 0)]  
0
[Setting Values: -32 to +32 (R 0)]  
Camera Process Menu 123  
     
UB Mode  
TC/UB Menu  
Menu screen for setting time code and user’s bit.  
This item cannot be selected in the Media mode,  
or during recording.  
For setting the recording mode of the user’s bit.  
0
0
0
Date:  
Records the date.  
Time:  
Records the time.  
Preset:  
TC Generator  
Records according to the preset setting.  
For setting the operation of the time code.  
0
Free Run(GPS)L:  
[Setting Values: Date, Time, RPreset]  
Timecodeinformationcanbesynchronizedwith  
the date/time information acquired from the  
GPS.  
Memo :  
0
If [UB Mode] is set to “Time”, the user’s bit  
operates in the 24-hour format even if the LCD  
display is in the 12-hour format.  
0
0
Free Run(Ext):  
External time code input will be synchronized  
with this and the time code will be recorded.  
Free Run:  
9
Preset  
The time code operates in the run mode at all  
times regardless of the recording status. It  
continues to run even when the power of the  
camera recorder is turned off.  
For setting the user’s bit. (Digit by digit)  
Display AB CD EF 01  
:
Memo :  
0
0
Rec Run:  
0
When [UB Mode] is set to “Date” or “Time”, this  
item appears as “---” and preset is disabled.  
When [TC Generator] is set to “Regen”, this item  
appears as “<Regen>” and preset is disabled.  
The time code operates in the run mode during  
recording. It continues to run in the order of the  
recorded clips as long as the SD card is not  
replaced. If the SD card is removed and  
recording is made on another card, time code  
will be recorded on the new card from where it  
was left off in the previous card.  
0
Drop Frame  
Regen:  
For setting the framing mode of the time code  
generator.  
The time code operates in the run mode during  
recording. When the SD card is replaced, the  
last time code recorded on the card is read and  
recorded on a new card so that the time code  
continues in running order.  
0
Non Drop:  
Internal time code generator works in the non-  
drop-frame mode. Use this setting when placing  
emphasis on the number of frames.  
Drop:  
[Setting Values: Free Run(GPS), L, Free  
0
Run(Ext), Free Run, RRec Run, Regen]  
Internal time code generator works in the drop-  
frame mode. Use this setting when placing  
emphasis on the recording time.  
Memo :  
0
When [Rec Mode] is configured to “Interval  
Rec” or “Frame Rec”, only “Rec Run” and  
“Regen” are selectable.  
When [System] is configured to “High-Speed”,  
only “Rec Run” and “Regen” are selectable.  
When [Frame Rate] is set to “24p”, “Free  
Run(GPS)” cannot be selected.  
[Setting Values: Non Drop, RDrop]  
Memo :  
0
This item can be set only when [System] B  
[Record Set] B [Record Format] B [WFrame  
Rate] is set to “60p”, “30p”, or “60i”.  
0
0
However, when “Free Run(GPS)” is selected for  
[TC Generator], this item is fixed at “Drop” and  
cannot be selected. L  
TC Preset  
0
0
When [Frame Rate] is “24p”, “Non Drop”  
becomes fixed and cannot be selected.  
When [Frame Rate] is “50p”, “25p”, or “50i”, this  
item appears as “---” and cannot be selected.  
For setting the time code (hour, minute, second,  
frame).  
Display  
:
:
Drop setting 02:02:25.20  
Non Drop setting 02:02:25:20  
124 TC/UB Menu  
       
LCD Contrast  
LCD/VF Menu  
For setting the difference in luminance between the  
darkest and brightness areas in the LCD monitor.  
Increasing the value increases the contrast.  
[Setting Values: +10 to +1, R0, -1 to -10]  
Item for specifying settings related to the LCD  
monitor or viewfinder screen.  
This menu screen can be used to specify settings  
related to the Focus Assist mode, zebra pattern  
display, screen size, marker, and safety zone. In  
addition, it is also used for selecting whether to  
display characters on the LCD monitor or  
viewfinder screen, as well as for adjusting the  
picture quality of the LCD monitor.  
LCD Backlight  
For setting the brightness of the LCD monitor  
backlight.  
Increasing the value increases the brightness.  
[Setting Values: +1, R 0, -1]  
Shooting Assist...  
LCD Mirror  
Menu for setting the Shooting Assist function.  
For specifying the image display method when  
facing the LCD monitor.  
Select “Mirror” to display the image after laterally  
inverting it. (Mirror display)  
Marker Settings...  
For setting items such as the safety zone and  
center mark.  
[Setting Values: Mirror, RNormal]  
Memo :  
Display Type...  
0
The setting of this item is valid only in Camera  
mode.  
For specifying display-related settings.  
0
During color bar, expanded focus, menu screen  
and status screen display, the “Mirror” setting is  
disabled.  
Display On/Off...  
For configuring the on/off setting of the screen  
display.  
Convert to ITU709  
When [Color Space] is set to “ITU2020”, “J-Log1”  
or “HLG”, the video images on the LCD monitor and  
viewfinder are converted to the ITU709 color space  
for display.  
VF Color  
For selecting whether to display the image on the  
viewfinder screen in color or black-and-white.  
Select “On” to display in color, and “Off” to display  
in black-and-white.  
0
Cam + Return:  
The camera and return videos are converted  
from the color space configured in [Color  
Space] to the ITU709 color space.  
Cam:  
[Setting Values: ROn, Off]  
VF Bright  
0
0
Only the camera video is converted to the  
ITU709 color space.  
For setting the brightness of the viewfinder screen.  
Increasing the value increases the brightness.  
[Setting Values: +10 to +1, R0, -1 to -10]  
Off:  
Not converted.  
VF Contrast  
[Setting Values: Cam + Return, Cam, ROff]  
Memo :  
For setting the difference in luminance between the  
darkest and brightness areas in the viewfinder  
screen.  
0
This item can be configured only when [Color  
Space] is set to “ITU2020”, “J-Log1” or “HLG”.  
Increasing the value increases the contrast.  
[Setting Values: +10 to +1, R0, -1 to -10]  
LCD/VF Menu 125  
                     
9
Shooting Assist Item  
Focus Assist  
White Level  
For configuring the white level during adjustment of  
the dynamic range that is visible in the LCD monitor  
or viewfinder when [Color Space] is set to “HLG”.  
When [Color Space] is set to “HLG” and [Convert  
to ITU709] is set to a value other than “Off”, this item  
can be used to configure the output luminance level  
(%) of HLG videos that corresponds to 100% on  
the ITU709 gamma curve during the conversion.  
[Setting Values: 80.0%, 77.5%, 75.0%, R 72.5%,  
70.0%, 67.5%,65.0%, 62.5%, 60.0%, 57.5%,  
55.0%, 52.5%, 50.0%]  
For setting whether to add color to the contour of  
the focused image upon switching the image to  
black-and-white.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
9
Type  
For configuring the behavior when operating the  
user button that is assigned with the [Focus  
Assist] function.  
Memo :  
0
0
ACCU-Focus:  
0
0
This item can be configured only when [Color  
Space] is set to “HLG”.  
The value on the spot meter changes in tandem  
with this setting.  
Enables the Focus Assist and ACCU-Focus  
(forced focus) functions. The depth of field of the  
object becomes shallower to enable easier  
focusing. The ACCU-Focus function switches  
automatically to “Off” after about 10 seconds.  
Normal:  
Example: When [White Level] is set to “75.0%”,  
the point at which the HLG output is 75% is  
displayed as 100% on the spot meter.  
to the ITU709 color space is performed with  
gamma and knee adjusted such that the  
maximum HDR dynamic range is visible during  
the conversion.  
Enables only the Focus Assist function. The  
focused area is displayed in color to enable  
easier focusing. Display color can be specified  
with [Color].  
0
[Setting Values: ACCU-Focus, RNormal]  
9
Color  
For setting the display color of the focused area  
when Focus Assist is activated.  
LCD RGB Gain  
[Setting Values: RBlue, Green, Red]  
For adjusting the R (red), G (green) and B (blue)  
gain level of the LCD monitor.  
Zebra  
For selecting whether to display zebra patterns at  
the bright areas of the subject.  
Select “On” to display zebra patterns or “Off” to  
hide.  
[Setting Values: +127 to R 0 to -128]  
9
Reset  
Restores [LCD RGB Gain] to the default settings.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
VF RGB Gain  
9
Detect  
For adjusting the R (red), G (green) and B (blue)  
gain level of the viewfinder.  
For configuring the timing to detect the zebra  
pattern display.  
[Setting Values: +127 to R 0 to -128]  
0
0
Converted ITU709:  
Performs detection after converting to the  
ITU709 color space.  
9
Reset  
Restores [VF RGB Gain] to the default settings.  
HLG/J-Log1:  
Performs detection before converting to the  
ITU709 color space.  
[Setting Values: Converted ITU709, RHLG/J-  
Log1]  
Memo :  
0
This item is selectable only when [Color  
Space] is set to “J-Log1” or “HLG” and [Convert  
to ITU709] is set to “Cam” or “Cam + Return”.  
126 LCD/VF Menu  
             
9
9
Top  
Histogram Bottom  
For setting the maximum luminance level for the  
For selecting the minimum brightness limit for  
changing the histogram display color.  
[Setting Values: 0% to 105% (in 5% increments)]  
(R 20%)  
zebra pattern display.  
[Setting Values: Over, 100%, 98%, 95% to 5% (in  
5% increments)] (R80%)  
0
When [Color Space] is set to “J-Log1”  
9
Bottom  
[Setting Values: -6F-stop, -5F-stop, -4F-stop,  
R-3F-stop(2%), -2F-stop, -1F-stop, 0F-stop(18%),  
F-stop, F-stop, 1F-stop, 1 F-stop, 1 F-  
stop, 2F-stop, 2 F-stop(90%), 2 F-stop, 3F-  
stop, 3 F-stop, 3 F-stop, 4F-stop, 4 F-stop,  
4 F-stop, 5F-stop, 5 F-stop]  
For setting the minimum luminance level for the  
zebra pattern display.  
[Setting Values: 100%, 98%, 95% to 0% (in 5%  
increments)] (R70%)  
Memo :  
0
The relation between Top and Bottom is such  
that Top>Bottom always holds. To maintain this  
relation during setting, the setting value is  
automatically corrected.  
Memo :  
0
When [Color Space] is set to “J-Log1”, a green  
line appears which corresponds to the “0F-  
stop(18%)” portion of the subject with 18%  
reflectance.  
Peaking Frequency  
For setting the frequency bandwidth for  
emphasizing the outline using the [PEAKING]  
button.  
Marker Settings Item  
For setting the marker and safety zone, which are  
useful in helping you determine the angle of view  
for the image according to the shooting purpose.  
[Setting Values: High, RMiddle, Low]  
Histogram  
For setting whether to display the histogram, which  
shows the distribution of different points with  
different levels of brightness in an image.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
0
During Clip Review or when in the Media mode,  
the markers do not appear regardless of the  
setting.  
9
Histogram Top  
For selecting the maximum brightness limit for  
changing the histogram display color.  
[Setting Values: 5% to 110% (in 5% increments)]  
(R 80%)  
Marker  
For setting whether to display marker, safety zone,  
and center marks on the screen.  
0
When [Color Space] is set to “J-Log1”  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
[Setting Values: -5F-stop, -4F-stop, -3F-stop(2%),  
-2F-stop, -1F-stop, 0F-stop(18%), F-stop, F-  
stop, 1F-stop, 1F-stop, 1F-stop, 2F-stop, 2 ⅓  
F-stop(90%), 2 F-stop, R3F-stop, 3 F-stop, 3  
F-stop, 4F-stop, 4 F-stop, 4 F-stop, 5F-  
stop, 5 F-stop, 5½F-stop]  
9
Grid Marker  
For setting whether to display a 3x3 grid on the  
screen.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
Memo :  
0
When [Grid Marker] is set to “On”, [Aspect  
Ratio], [Aspect Marker], and [Safety Zone] do  
not function.  
0
When [Color Space] is set to “J-Log1”, a green  
line appears which corresponds to the “0F-  
stop(18%)” portion of the subject with 18%  
reflectance.  
LCD/VF Menu 127  
       
9
Display Type Item  
Aspect Ratio  
For selecting the final image aspect ratio to be used  
This menu is used to set the displays on the LCD  
from the overall angle of view.  
monitor and viewfinder screen.  
[Setting Values: 16:9(+4:3), 2.35:1 Top, 2.35:1  
Center, 1.85:1 Top, 1.85:1 Center, R16:9, 1.75:1,  
1.66:1, 14:9, 13:9, 4:3]  
Battery  
For setting the display of the remaining battery  
power on the LCD monitor and viewfinder screen.  
Memo :  
0
When [System] B [Record Set] B [Record  
Format] B [SD Aspect] is set to “4:3”, this item  
is fixed at “4:3” and cannot be selected.  
0
0
0
Time:  
Displays the remaining battery power in  
minutes. (min)  
Capacity%:  
Displays the remaining battery power in  
percentage. (%)  
9
Aspect Marker  
Voltage:  
For specifying how boundary markers are to be  
used to indicate the parts of an image that are  
beyond the range of the aspect ratio selected in  
[Aspect Ratio].  
Displays the current battery voltage in units of  
0.1 V. (V)  
[Setting Values: RTime, Capacity%, Voltage]  
Memo :  
0
Line+Halftone:  
0
The battery mark that appears before the “Time”,  
“Capacity%” or “Voltage” value changes according to  
Displays the boundary using lines, and areas  
outside the boundary in halftone.  
Halftone:  
the remaining battery power.  
0
0
0
In addition, the plug mark is added during charging.  
Displays areas outside the boundary in halftone.  
Line:  
4 S  
D R  
C Q  
B P  
:
:
:
:
10 % and below  
11 % to 30 %  
31% to 70 %  
Displays the boundary using lines.  
Off:  
Hides the boundary markers.  
71 % to 100 %  
[Setting Values: Line+Halftone, Halftone, Line,  
0
0
0
When the remaining battery power is low, “RES”  
ROff]  
instead of the value is displayed.  
Replace the battery as soon as possible.  
The remaining battery power and remaining time are  
intended as reference values for the shooting  
duration.  
Memo :  
0
When [Aspect Ratio] is set to “16:9” or  
“16:9(+4:3)”, this item is fixed at “Off” and cannot  
be selected.  
The time, capacity or voltage will not be displayed  
during charging.  
9
Safety Zone  
For setting the percentage of area that is to be  
deemed as valid area (Safety Zone) within the  
boundary of the aspect ratio selected in [Aspect  
Ratio].  
TC/UB  
For specifying whether to display the time code  
(TC) or user’s bit (UB) rate in the display on the LCD  
monitor and viewfinder screen.  
[Setting Values: 95%, 93%, 90%, 88%, 80%, ROff]  
[Setting Values: UB, RTC]  
9
Center Mark  
Zoom  
For specifying whether to display a mark to indicate  
the screen center within the aspect ratio selected  
in [Aspect Ratio].  
For setting the display method of the zoom  
position.  
[Setting Values: ROn, Off]  
0
Number:  
Displays the zoom position in numbers.  
Bar:  
0
Displays the zoom position in a bar.  
[Setting Values: Number, RBar]  
128 LCD/VF Menu  
         
Focus  
Gain  
For setting the display method of the approximate  
distance to the subject in focus.  
For setting the gain display to be displayed on the  
LCD monitor and viewfinder screen.  
0
0
Feet:  
ISO:  
Displays the distance in feet.  
Meter:  
Displays the gain as ISO sensitivity.  
dB:  
0
0
Displays the distance in meters.  
Displays the gain in dB (decibel).  
[Setting Values: Feet, RMeter]  
[Setting Values: ISO, RdB]  
Memo :  
0
ND Filter  
This item cannot be configured when [Color  
Space] is set to “HLG”.  
For specifying how the filter position is to be  
displayed.  
0
Normal + Assist:  
Displays the current filter position.  
If the ND filter setting is inappropriate, the  
appropriate ND filter to select will appear  
blinking.  
Display On/Off Item  
For setting whether to turn on or off the display of  
an item on the LCD monitor and viewfinder screen.  
0
Normal:  
Battery, Clip Info, High-Speed, Media Status,  
Rec Trigger, TC/UB, Media Remain, Record  
Format, Video Format, Guide, GPS A L,  
Return over IP, Live Streaming, Network,  
Date, Time, Operation Lock, Zoom, Focus,  
Zebra, Focus Assist, Color Space, Black Toe,  
ND Filter, OIS, Face Detection, Infrared, AE  
Level, Iris, Shutter, Gain, White Balance,  
Audio Meter, Position Bar, Camera  
Displays the current filter position.  
[Setting Values: Normal + Assist, RNormal]  
Shutter  
For setting the shutter display to be displayed on  
the LCD monitor and viewfinder screen.  
0
DEG:  
Displays the shutter speed in degrees in the  
same way as film cameras.  
SEC:  
Angle[Tagging]L, ODK[Tagging]L  
0
Displays the shutter speed in seconds.  
For configuring whether to display or hide an item.  
[Setting Values: DEG, RSEC]  
[Setting Values: ROn, Off]  
Memo :  
Memo :  
0
“DEG” is selectable only when [WFrame Rate]  
is set to “24p” or “25p”.  
0
This may not be selectable depending on the  
operating mode and status.  
When [WFrame Rate] is set to other values, the  
shutter display setting is fixed at “SEC” and  
cannot be selected.  
LCD/VF Menu 129  
     
9
3G-SDI Mapping  
A/V Set Menu  
Menu screen for video output and audio.  
For configuring the mode of mapping for signals  
output from the [SDI OUT] terminal.  
[Setting Values: Level B, RLevel A]  
Video Set...  
Memo :  
0
SDI output is configurable only when the setting  
For specifying video output-related settings.  
is set to “1080p”.  
0
When [SDI OUT] is configured to “Off”, this item  
cannot be configured.  
Audio Set...  
For specifying audio-related settings.  
9
Rec Trigger  
For configuring whether to superimpose trigger  
signals on the [SDI OUT] terminal in tandem with  
the [REC] button.  
Video Set Item  
SDI OUT  
If “Type-A” or “Type-B” is specified, it is possible to  
recordonadeviceequippedwithSDIrecordtrigger  
in tandem with the operation of the [REC] button.  
When a compatible device is connected,  
recording/stop control signals are output in tandem  
with the operation of the [REC] button.  
The record trigger output status to the connected  
device is indicated by REC B /STBY B on the  
display screen.  
For configuring video output from the [SDI OUT]  
terminal.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
0
When a resolution with no SDI output is  
selected, the setting is fixed at “Off”.  
When “4K EXT (SSD)” is selected for the  
[System] item, video images are not output from  
the [SDI OUT] terminal.  
0
[Setting Values: Type-A, Type-B, ROff]  
Memo :  
0
If “Type-A” does not work, it may operate in the  
“Type-B” setting, but the user’s bit to the  
connected device will not be correctly output.  
Even if REC B /STBY B is displayed on the  
display screen, the compatible device may not  
necessarily be recording.  
9
Character  
For configuring whether to show the display and  
menu on the [SDI OUT] terminal.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
0
0
9
Resolution  
This item can be configured when [SDI OUT] is  
configured to “On” and [Rec Mode] is configured  
to “Normal”, “Pre Rec” or “Clip Continuous”.  
Set to “Off” if connecting to a device that does  
not support record trigger.  
For selecting the resolution of video output from the  
[SDI OUT] terminal according to the monitor to be  
connected.  
0
[Setting Values: 1080psF, R1080p, 1080i, 720p,  
576i, 480i, 480i (2:3pd)]  
Memo :  
0
The selectable options vary according to the  
[System] B [Record Set] B [Record Format] B  
[System]/[WResolution] setting.  
Cross conversion output is not possible.  
When [A/V Set] B [Video Set] B [SDI OUT] B  
[Resolution] is set to “1080p”, configuring  
[System] B [GPS] to “On” changes the setting to  
“1080i”. A L  
0
0
130 A/V Set Menu  
         
9
HDMI OUT  
Colorimetry  
For configuring the colorimetry of the HDMI signal  
when [Camera Process] B [Color Space] B  
[Colorimetry] is set to “ITU2020”.  
For configuring video output from the [HDMI]  
terminal.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
0
0
0
ITU2020:  
Memo :  
Outputs using the colorimetry of ITU2020  
0
Monitor and menu displays are not output from  
regardless of the device that is connected via  
the [HDMI] terminal.  
HDMI.  
ITU709:  
9
Resolution  
Outputs using the colorimetry of ITU709  
regardless of the device that is connected via  
For selecting the resolution of video output from the  
[HDMI] terminal according to the monitor to be  
connected.  
HDMI.  
Auto:  
Switches the colorimetry automatically  
according to the device that is connected via  
HDMI.  
[Setting Values: 2160/60p, 2160/50p, 2160/30p,  
2160/25p, 2160/24p, 1080/60p, 1080/50p,  
1080/30p, 1080/25p, 1080/24p, 1080p, R1080i,  
720p, 576p, 576i, 480p, 480i, 480p(2:3pd)]  
[Setting Values: ITU2020, ITU709, RAuto]  
Memo :  
Memo :  
0
0
0
This item can be configured when [HDMI OUT]  
is set to a setting other than “Off”.  
0
The selectable options vary according to the  
settings in [System] B [Record Set] B [Record  
Format] B [System] and [WResolution]/  
[GResolution].  
This item can be configured when [HDMI  
Color] is set to “Auto”.  
0
0
Cross conversion output is not possible.  
When in the Camera mode, selecting “SD” for  
[System] B [Record Set] B [Record Format] B  
[System] fixes the resolution at “480p” or “576p”.  
This item cannot be configured when [Camera  
Process] B [Color Space] B [Colorimetry] is set  
to a setting other than “ITU2020”.  
9
Enhance  
9
Color  
For setting the color range of HDMI signals. When  
connecting to a PC monitor, set this to “On”.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
For setting the color format of HDMI signals.  
[Setting Values: RGB, RAuto]  
Memo :  
Memo :  
0
This item can be configured when [HDMI OUT]  
is set to a setting other than “Off”.  
0
This item can be configured when [HDMI OUT]  
is set to a setting other than “Off”.  
A/V Set Menu 131  
 
9
Audio Set Item  
Input1 Mic Ref.  
Rec Trigger  
For configuring whether to superimpose trigger  
signals on the [HDMI] out terminal in tandem with  
the [REC] button.  
For setting the reference input level when the  
[INPUT1] selection switch is set to “MIC” or “MIC  
+48V”.  
[Setting Values: -62dB, -56dB, R-50dB, -44dB,  
-38dB, -32dB]  
If “On” is specified, it is possible to record on a  
device equipped with HDMI record trigger in  
tandem with the operation of the [REC] button.  
When a compatible device is connected,  
recording/stop control signals are output in tandem  
with the operation of the [REC] button.  
The HDMI record trigger output status to the  
connected device is indicated by REC B/STBY B  
on the display screen.  
Input2 Mic Ref.  
For setting the reference input level when the  
[INPUT2] selection switch is set to “MIC” or “MIC  
+48V”.  
[Setting Values: -62dB, -56dB, R-50dB, -44dB,  
-38dB, -32dB]  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
0
Even if REC B/STBY B is displayed on the  
display screen, the compatible device may not  
necessarily be recording.  
Int. Mic Gain  
Forsettingthesensitivityofthebuilt-inmicrophone.  
0
This item can be configured when [HDMI OUT]  
is set to a value other than “Off”, and [Rec  
Mode] is set to “Normal”, “Pre Rec” or “Clip  
Continuous”.  
[Setting Values: 12 dB, 6 dB, R0dB]  
AUX Gain  
For setting the sensitivity of the [AUX] terminal  
input.  
0
Set to “Off” if connecting to a device that does  
not support record trigger.  
[Setting Values: 12 dB, 6 dB, R0dB]  
9
TC  
Ref. Level  
For setting whether to superimpose time code to  
For setting the recording reference level. (Applies  
to both [CH1/CH2].)  
[Setting Values: -12dB, -18dB, R-20dB]  
the [HDMI] terminal.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
0
This item can be configured when [HDMI OUT]  
is set to a setting other than “Off”.  
Set to “Off” if connecting to a device that does  
not support HDMI TC.  
Limiter  
For setting the limiter operation.  
0
0
0
0
-9dBFS:  
Sets “-9dBFS” to the maximum recording level.  
-6dBFS:  
Sets “-6dBFS” to the maximum recording level.  
Off:  
Depending on the settings of the [CH1/CH2  
AUTO/MANUAL] selection switches, the  
operation may be different as described below.  
0
The limiter does not function when  
“MANUAL” is set.  
0
The limiter functions at -6dBFS when “AUTO”  
is set.  
[Setting Values: -9dBFS, R-6dBFS, Off]  
132 A/V Set Menu  
             
AGC Response  
Int. Mic Separation  
For setting the enhancement level of the stereo  
effect of the built-in microphone.  
9
Attack Time  
Sets the time to activate the limiter.  
0
On:  
[Setting Values: Fast, RMiddle, Slow]  
Enhances the stereo effect.  
Off:  
0
9
Decay Time  
Does not enhance the stereo effect.  
Sets the time to deactivate the limiter operation.  
[Setting Values: ROn, Off]  
[Setting Values: Fast, RMiddle, Slow]  
Memo :  
0
AGC Mode  
Both [CH1] and [CH2] selection switches are set  
to “INT”.  
For setting whether to link the limiter operation of  
[CH1] and [CH2].  
Select “Link” to link or “Separate” to separate.  
[Setting Values: Link, RSeparate]  
0
When [Int. Mic Separation] is set to “On”, a  
icon is displayed on the status screen (audio  
input) while the function is operating.  
Memo :  
Test Tone  
0
Enabled only when both the [AUX] input terminal  
and [INPUT1/INPUT2] input terminal are set to  
“LINE” or “MIC”, and CH1/CH2 of the [CH1/CH2  
AUTO/MANUAL] switch is set to “AUTO”.  
For specifying whether to output the audio test  
signals (1 kHz) during color bar output.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
INPUT1/2 Wind Cut  
XLR Manual Level  
For selecting whether to cut the low frequencies of  
theaudioinputsignals(low-cut)whenthe [INPUT1/  
INPUT2] switch is set to “MIC” or “MIC+48V”.  
Set this item to reduce wind noise from the  
microphone.  
For setting whether to link manual audio  
adjustment operation between [INPUT1] and  
[INPUT2] terminals.  
Select “Link” to link or “Separate” to separate.  
When this item is set to “Link”, adjust the recording  
level using the [CH1] recording level adjustment  
knob.  
0
0
0
0
Both:  
Enables low-cut on both the [INPUT1] and  
[INPUT2] terminals.  
[Setting Values: Link, RSeparate]  
Memo :  
INPUT2:  
Enables low-cut on the audio of the [INPUT2]  
0
Enabled only when both the [INPUT1/INPUT2]  
input terminals are set to “LINE” or “MIC”, and  
both [CH1]/[CH2] of the [CH1/CH2 AUTO/  
MANUAL] selection switches are set to  
“MANUAL”.  
When this item is set to “Link”, [CH2] recording  
level adjustment knob is disabled.  
terminal only.  
INPUT1:  
Enables low-cut on the audio of the [INPUT1]  
terminal only.  
Off:  
Disables low-cut.  
0
[Setting Values: Both, INPUT2, INPUT1, ROff]  
Int. Mic Wind Cut  
For selecting whether to cut the low frequencies of  
the audio input signals (low-cut) from the built-in  
microphone. Set this item to “On” to reduce wind  
noise from the microphone.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
A/V Set Menu 133  
 
Equalizer  
IFB/RET Monitor...  
You can correct the characteristic and enhance the  
sound of the connected microphone using this  
equalizer setting.  
9
CH1(/2)  
For configuring the output from the [x] terminal  
during IFB Return over IP of each channel.  
For setting the audio frequency from a 5-band  
equalizer.  
0
Auto:  
Outputs upon mixing the IFB/Return over IP  
audio with the microphone audio when IFB/  
Return over IP audio input is detected. Outputs  
only the microphone audio when IFB/Return  
over IP audio input is not detected.  
IFB/RET Only:  
0
Frequency:  
100Hz, 330Hz, 1kHz, 3.3kHz, 10kHz  
Variable level:  
0
± 6dB (1dB step)  
Memo :  
0
0
0
Audio will be recorded in the characteristic set  
Outputs only the IFB/Return over IP audio at all  
times.  
in the equalizer.  
0
0
Set all bands to “0 dB” to bypass the equalizer.  
When the equalizer level is set to the + side, the  
audio may be distorted. In this case, reduce the  
recording level in Manual mode.  
Off:  
IFB/Return over IP audio is not output.  
[Setting Values: RAuto, IFB/RET Only, Off]  
Memo :  
0
0
0
If the values of multiple frequencies are  
changed, the specified levels and the actual  
levels may be different due to interference  
between the frequency bands.  
To enable different settings for CH1 and CH2 of  
[IFB/RET Monitor], set [Monitor] to “Stereo”.  
Alarm Level  
This function is enabled only when both  
[INPUT1/2 Wind Cut] and [Int. Mic Wind Cut] are  
set to “Off”.  
For selecting whether to turn on the warning tone  
as well as setting the volume.  
The warning tone is output from the monitor  
speaker or [x] terminal.  
Monitor  
[Setting Values: RHigh, Middle, Low, Off]  
For setting the audio sound of the [x] terminal to  
stereo or mixed sound when the [MONITOR]  
selection switch on the LCD monitor is set to  
“BOTH”.  
Audio On FULL AUTO  
For setting whether to enable Auto for audio when  
the [FULL AUTO] switch is set to “ON”.  
0
0
Mix:  
Auto:  
Outputs mixed sound (mixed sound of CH1 and  
CH2) to both L and R.  
Sets audio recording mode to the auto mode.  
SW Set:  
0
0
Stereo:  
Sets the audio recording mode following the  
[CH1/CH2 AUTO/MANUAL] selection switch  
setting.  
Outputs stereo sound (outputs audio sound of  
CH1 to L, and CH2 to R).  
[Setting Values: RMix, Stereo]  
[Setting Values: RAuto, SW Set]  
Memo :  
0
If both CH1 and CH2 are built-in microphones,  
stereo sound is output from the [x] terminal  
regardless of the [Monitor] setting.  
134 A/V Set Menu  
       
Return over IP...  
Network Menu  
For specifying network-related settings.  
The display of the software keyboard for input  
varies according to the item you are setting.  
For configuring settings related to Return over IP.  
This function allows video and audio to be received  
via the network.  
Memo :  
Connection Setup...  
0
Users cannot access this menu in the following  
cases.  
For configuring the network connection settings.  
A [Wizard] screen will appear according to the  
mode of connection. Follow the instructions to  
perform the setting.  
0
When [Record Format] B [System] is set to a  
setting other than “HD” or “SD”  
0
When [Record Format] B [Frame Rate] is set  
The preconfigured settings can be loaded, saved  
or deleted.  
to “24p”  
0
When [Overlay Settings] B [Overlay  
Function] is set to “Enable”A L  
0
Memo :  
When [Record Set] B [Time Stamp] is set to  
0
Users cannot access this menu in the following  
“On”  
cases.  
0
During manual FTP transfer  
Web...  
0
During live streaming  
0
Return over IP in Progress  
For setting the functions that make use of the web  
browser.  
Live Streaming...  
For configuring settings for distributing live video  
images and audio.  
Metadata Server...  
For registering the FTP server for importing the  
metadata and the path of the file to be imported.  
Up to 4 settings can be registered.  
Memo :  
0
Users cannot access this menu in the following  
cases.  
0
When [Record Format] B [System] is set to a  
Upload Settings...  
setting other than “HD” or “SD”  
For configuring the method for uploading to the  
FTP server as well as the server and directory for  
uploading the clip recorded in the media to the FTP  
server.  
0
During FTP transfer  
0
When [Record Format] B [Frame Rate] is set  
to “24p”  
Import Metadata  
0
0
For importing metadata from the FTP server.  
Metadata loaded by the setup files (“User File”/  
“All File”) will be deleted.  
Memo :  
0
This option is not selectable if the network  
connection is not established.  
This option is not selectable while using the  
network.  
0
Network Menu 135  
             
Zero Config  
Setup File  
For allowing this camera recorder to be detected  
automatically by external devices (such as  
switchers) connected to the same LAN.  
Connection can be established via one link from  
the menu of the external device.  
9
Load  
Loads the settings on the [Wizard] screen.  
9
Memo :  
Store  
0
The Zero Config function is not equipped with  
the function to change the settings of the camera  
recorder.  
Saves the settings on the [Wizard] screen.  
9
Delete  
9
Announcement  
Deletes the saved settings.  
For configuring the method of connection from an  
external device during automatic detection of this  
camera recorder.  
FTP Proxy...  
[Setting Values: ROn, Off]  
For setting the FTP proxy.  
9
9
Hostname Prefix  
Type  
Part of the host name can be changed.  
It will appear in the format of “XXXX-YYYY.local”  
on the Status screen (network).  
Select the type of FTP proxy.  
[Setting Values: RNo Proxy, HTTP]  
9
XXXX : Character string (maximum 8 characters)  
configured in [Hostname Prefix]  
Server  
Set the FTP proxy server name.  
Memo :  
0
0
YYYY : Serial number of this camera recorder  
Memo :  
Enter the name using the onscreen keyboard.  
You can enter characters not more than 127  
bytes using single-byte alphanumeric  
characters (a to z, 0 to 9), single-byte hyphen  
(“-”) or dot (“.”).  
0
When [Announcement] is configured to “Off”,  
this item does not appear on the status screen  
(Connection Setup).  
0
When [Type] is set to “No Proxy”, changes  
cannot be made.  
Reset Network  
Restores all items in the [Network] menu to their  
default settings.  
9
Port  
Set the FTP proxy port number.  
Memo :  
Connection Setup Item  
Wizard  
0
0
Enter the name using the onscreen keyboard.  
Enter an integer between 1 and 65535.  
Displays a [Wizard] screen for connecting to the  
network.  
APN  
Follow the instructions on the screen.  
For specifying APN (Access Point Name).  
*
This item is grayed out and cannot be selected  
if APN cannot be set for the adapter attached.  
Caution :  
0
The APN setting is written into the cellular  
adapter, not this camera recorder.  
Setting a wrong APN may result in  
communication failure or expensive bills from  
the telecommunications company. Set the APN  
correctly.  
136 Network Menu  
       
Live Streaming Item  
Live Streaming  
Server  
For selecting the server for live streaming.  
[Setting Values: RServer1, Server2, Server3,  
Server4]  
Starts live distribution when “On” is selected.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
Memo :  
0
The setting cannot be changed during live  
0
streaming (when [Live Streaming] set to “On”).  
“On” cannot be selected if streaming is not  
possible with the selected resolution, frame rate  
and bitrate combination.  
9
Streaming Server  
0
“On” cannot be selected if connection of the  
selected network is not established.  
“On” cannot be selected when FTP is running.  
Live streaming switches to “Off” when the power  
is turned off.  
For setting the server for live streaming.  
Memo :  
0
0
0
The setting cannot be changed during live  
streaming (when [Live Streaming] set to “On”).  
9
Server1, Server2, Server3, Server4  
9
Auto Restart  
*
The name that is set in [Alias] is displayed  
individually.  
Alias  
When the network is reconnected after  
disconnection, live streaming will resume  
automatically.  
o
0
On:  
For setting a name to distinguish the settings of this  
Once the network is reconnected, live streaming  
resumes automatically.  
camera.  
The name set in this item will be displayed in the  
[Server] options.  
0
Off:  
Live streaming does not resume automatically  
even when the network is reconnected.  
*1 The default value is “Server1/Server2/  
Server3/Server4”.  
*2 You can enter up to 31 characters and ASCII  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
0
characters.  
Type  
When the power of the camera is turned off,  
regardless of the settings in [Auto Restart], live  
streaming does not begin automatically even  
when power is turned on again and network  
connection is established.  
o
For configuring the system for transferring video  
and audio to be distributed.  
[Setting Values: RMPEG2-TS/UDP, MPEG2-TS/  
TCP, MPEG2-TS/RTPRTSP/RTP, ZIXI, RTMP]  
A
0
The setting cannot be changed during live  
streaming (when live streaming is configured to  
“On”).  
[Setting Values: RMPEG2-TS/UDP, MPEG2-TS/  
TCP, MPEG2-TS/RTP, RTSP/RTP, RTMP] B  
Memo :  
0
0
0
Use reception devices that are compatible with  
the respective transfer systems.  
To use the “ZIXI” setting, a dedicated server is  
needed separately. A  
The following items that can be set vary  
depending on the setting of this item.  
o
Destination Address  
For setting details such as the host name and the  
IP address of the live distribution destination.  
*
Enter not more than 127 characters using  
single-byte alphanumeric characters (a to z, 0 to  
9), single-byte hyphen [-], or dot [.].  
Network Menu 137  
   
o
o
Destination URL  
Username  
For entering the URL of the live distribution  
destination beginning with “rtmp://”.  
There is no default value (blank).  
For setting the user name.  
The default value is “JVC”.  
*
Enter not more than 31 characters.  
*
You can enter up to 191 characters and ASCII  
Memo :  
0
characters.  
This item is selectable only when [Type] is set to  
“RTSP/RTP”.  
Memo :  
0
This item is selectable only when [Type] is set to  
“RTMP”.  
o
Password  
For setting the [Stream ID] password.  
For ZIXI, there is no default value (blank).  
For RTSP/RTP, a random alphanumeric value that  
varies with each model is assigned as the default  
value.  
o
Destination Port  
Enter the network port number of the live  
distribution destination using an integer between 1  
and 65535.  
When [Type] is set to “MPEG2-TS/UDP”, “MPEG2-  
TS/TCP” or “MPEG2-TS/RTP”, the default value is  
“6504”. If “ZIXI” is set, the default value is “2088”.  
*
Enter not more than 127 characters. Enter not  
more than 31 characters for RTSP/RTP setting.  
o
Latency A  
Memo :  
0
For setting the latency mode.  
When [Type] is set to “MPEG2-TS/RTP”, only  
even numbers from 2 to 65530 can be specified  
for the port number.  
[Setting Values: High, Medium, RLow, Min]  
Memo :  
0
This item is selectable only when [Type] is set to  
“ZIXI”.  
0
When [Type] is set to “MPEG2-TS/RTP” and  
[SMPTE 2022-1 FEC] is set to “On”, N+2 and N  
+4 port numbers are also used in addition to the  
specified port number (N).  
o
Adaptive Bit Rate A  
If “On” is selected, the bit rate setting value of live  
streaming is set to maximum limit, and the bit rate  
is changed automatically according to changes in  
the network bandwidth.  
o
Stream ID A  
For setting the registered stream ID of the live  
distribution destination.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
0
The default value varies with the product model.  
*
Enter not more than 63 characters.  
[Adaptive Bit Rate] can be configured when  
[Type] is configured to “ZIXI”.  
Memo :  
0
This item is selectable only when [Type] is set to  
“ZIXI”.  
*
The bit rate is displayed on the status screen  
only when “On” is set.  
SMPTE 2022-1 FEC  
o
Stream Key  
o
Enter the stream key specified at the live  
Set to “On” to use FEC (Forward Error Correction).  
A transmission system that recovers the missing  
packets in the decoding process without having to  
retransmit the missing packets.  
transmission destination.  
There is no default value (blank).  
*
Enter not more than 127 characters.  
Memo :  
0
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
*
This item is selectable only when [Type] is set to  
“RTMP”.  
The decoder must be compatible with SMPTE  
2022-1.  
Memo :  
0
This item is selectable only when [Type] is set to  
“MPEG2-TS/RTP”.  
138 Network Menu  
   
o
FEC Matrix  
Bit Rate  
For setting the amount of FEC (Forward Error  
Correction) overhead for configuring  
SMPTE2022-1.  
For setting the encode bitrate of the video image  
during live distribution.  
The selectable options vary according to the  
settings in [Live Streaming Set] B [Resolution] and  
[Bit Rate].  
Memo :  
0
This item is selectable only when [SMPTE  
2022-1 FEC] is set to “On”.  
For details on the settings, please refer to  
Resolution  
Memo :  
For setting the resolution of the video image during  
live distribution.  
0
The setting cannot be changed during live  
streaming (when [Live Streaming] set to “On”).  
Depending on the type of network adapter used  
and the connection, images and audio sound  
during live streaming may be choppy.  
The available options vary according to the settings  
for [WResolution] and [WFrame Rate] under  
[Record Format].  
0
W Resolution  
Setting Value  
1920x1080  
1920x1080, 1280x720,  
640x360, 720x480,  
720x576  
Return over IP Item  
1440x1080  
Function A  
1280x720  
1280x720,  
For configuring the Return over IP function to  
Enable or Disable when in the QuickTime(MPEG2)  
or MXF(MPEG2) mode.  
640x360  
720x480 (U model) 720x480  
720x576 (E model) 720x576  
Memo :  
[Setting Values: Enable, RDisable]  
Memo :  
0
The setting cannot be changed during live  
streaming (when [Live Streaming] set to “On”).  
The Aspect Ratio for the live streaming image is  
fixed to “16:9”.  
0
Configure this item when “QuickTime(MPEG2)”  
or “MXF(MPEG2)” is selected for [System] B  
[Record Set] B [Record Format] B [WFormat].  
The live streaming images may turn out different  
depending on whether this item is configured to  
“Enable” or “Disable”. It is recommended that  
this item be configured to “Disable” if only live  
streaming is to be used.  
0
Frame Rate  
For setting the frame rate of the video image during  
live distribution.  
0
When this is configured to “Enable” and  
[Camera Process] B [Color Space] is  
The options vary according to the settings of [Live  
Streaming Set] B [Resolution] and the [WFrame  
Rate] settings under [Record Format].  
configured to “J-Log1” or “HLG”, live streaming  
settings will be as follows.  
W Frame Rate  
60p, 60i  
50p, 50i  
30p  
Setting Value  
60p, 60i, 30p  
50p, 50i, 25p  
30p  
0
[Color Space] “ITU709”  
0
[Gamma] “Standard”  
0
0
[Knee]“Manual”/[Level]“95.0%”  
[Color Matrix] “Standard”  
25p  
25p  
Return over IP  
Memo :  
0
The setting cannot be changed during live  
streaming (when live streaming is configured to  
“On”).  
For configuring Return over IP to On/Off.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
0
This is fixed at “Off” when [Return over IP] B  
[Function] is set to “Disable”. A  
Network Menu 139  
   
o
Protocol  
Server  
For configuring the protocol of the video/audio  
For selecting the source server for sending out  
Return over IP audio/video.  
source server to be connected.  
[Setting Values: RUDP, TCP]  
[Setting Values: RServer1, Server2, Server3,  
Server4]  
Memo :  
0
This item is selectable only when [Type] is set to  
“RTSP/RTP”.  
Memo :  
0
The setting cannot be changed while Return  
over IP is operating (when [Return over IP] is set  
to “On”).  
When [Return over IP] B [Function] is  
configured to “Disable”, this item cannot be  
changed. A  
o
Source Address  
For configuring details such as the host name and  
IP address of the video/audio transmission source.  
There is no default value (blank).  
0
*
You can enter up to 191 characters and ASCII  
characters.  
9
Return Server  
o
Source Port  
For configuring the source server for sending out  
Enter the network port number of the video/audio  
transmission source using an integer between 1  
and 65535.  
Return over IP audio/video.  
Memo :  
The default value is “554” when [Type] is set to  
“RTSP/RTP”, “2077” when it is set to “ZIXI”, and  
“5000” when it is set to Icecast.  
0
The setting cannot be changed while Return  
over IP is operating (when [Return over IP] is set  
to “On”).  
Memo :  
0
9
Server1, Server2, Server3, Server4  
When [Type] is set to “RTSP/RTP”, only even  
numbers from 2 to 65530 can be specified for  
the port number.  
*
The name that is set in [Alias] is displayed  
individually.  
o
Alias  
o
Stream ID  
For setting a name to distinguish the settings of this  
For configuring the stream ID registered on the  
camera.  
video/audio transmission source.  
The name set in this item will be displayed in the  
[Server] options.  
There is no default value (blank).  
*
Enter not more than 63 characters.  
*1 The default value is “Server1/Server2/  
Server3/Server4”.  
*2 You can enter up to 31 characters and ASCII  
Memo :  
0
This item is available for setting when [Type] is  
set to “RTSP/RTP” or “ZIXI”.  
characters.  
Type  
o
Username  
o
For setting the user name.  
For configuring the system for transferring video  
There is no default value (blank).  
and audio to be distributed.  
[Setting Values: RRTSP/RTP, ZIXI, Icecast] A  
[Setting Values: RRTSP/RTP, Icecast] B  
*
Enter not more than 63 characters.  
Memo :  
0
Memo :  
This item is selectable only when [Type] is set to  
“RTSP/RTP”.  
0
0
0
0
Operates as IFB when the setting is configured  
to “Icecast”.  
Use transmission devices that are compatible  
with the respective transfer systems.  
To use the “ZIXI” setting, a dedicated server is  
needed separately.  
The following items that can be set vary  
depending on the setting of this item.  
140 Network Menu  
o
Password  
Web Item  
For setting the password.  
There is no default value (blank).  
Web Access  
*
You can enter up to 31 characters when [Type]  
is set to “RTSP/RTP”.  
You can enter up to 127 characters when [Type]  
is set to “ZIXI”.  
To access via a web browser, set to “On”.  
[Setting Values: ROn, Off]  
*
Camera Name  
For setting the name to be displayed on the web  
browser. Enter not more than 8 characters using  
the software keyboard.  
Memo :  
0
This item is available for setting when [Type] is  
set to “RTSP/RTP” or “ZIXI”.  
(Default value: HC550 A, HC500 B)  
o
Name A  
Username  
For configuring the name.  
The default value is “HC550”.  
For setting the user name. Enter not more than 31  
characters using the software keyboard.  
(Default value: jvc)  
*
Enter not more than 31 characters.  
Memo :  
0
This item is selectable only when [Type] is set to  
“ZIXI”.  
Password  
Changes the password for accessing via a web  
browser.  
o
Latency A  
The current password is displayed. Enter a new  
password directly.  
For setting the latency mode.  
[Setting Values: Medium, RMin, Off]  
Enter not more than 31 characters using the  
software keyboard.  
Memo :  
0
This item is selectable only when [Type] is set to  
“ZIXI”.  
(Default value: random alphanumeric value that  
varies with each model)  
Port  
o
Mountpoint  
Enter the mountpoint (character string for  
identifying a stream) for streaming servers that  
support multiple streams.  
For configuring the port number during access to a  
web page from an external source.  
Memo :  
There is no default value (blank).  
0
0
Enter the name using the software keyboard.  
Enter an integer between 1 and 65535. (Default  
value: 80)  
*
Enter not more than 63 characters.  
Memo :  
0
This item is selectable only when [Type] is set to  
“Icecast”.  
0
To configure the setting to a number other than  
the default value, specify the number of an  
unused port.  
0
For more details, please consult the  
administrator of the network in use.  
Network Menu 141  
     
o
Password  
Metadata Server Item  
Enter the password for connecting to the FTP  
server.  
*
Meta-FTP1, Meta-FTP2, Meta-FTP3, Meta-  
FTP4  
Enter not more than 31 characters.  
PASV Mode  
o
*
The name that is set in [Alias] is displayed  
individually.  
For setting whether to set the communication mode  
used for file transfer to the passive mode.  
Set to “On” if the camera is inside a firewall, and a  
connection from the FTP server to the camera  
cannot be established.  
o
Alias  
For setting a name to distinguish the settings of this  
camera.  
The name set in this item will be displayed in the  
[Import Metadata] options.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
0
*
Enter not more than 31 characters.  
Protocol  
When [Protocol] is set to “SFTP”, this item  
appears as “---” and cannot be selected.  
o
For setting the protocol of the FTP server to be  
connected.  
0
0
0
FTP:  
Upload Settings Item  
Upload  
Protocol that does not encrypt the incoming and  
outgoing data.  
SFTP:  
Protocol that encrypts incoming and outgoing  
data using SSH.  
For configuring the method for uploading to the  
FTP server.  
FTPS:  
0
Auto:  
Protocol that encrypts incoming and outgoing  
data using SSL or TLS. It uses an implicit mode  
(starts encrypted communication once  
connection starts).  
Select this option for automatic FTP transfer.  
FTP transfer starts when [Auto Upload] is  
configured to “On”.  
0
Manual:  
0
FTPES:  
Select this option for manual FTP transfer from  
the Media mode.  
Protocol that encrypts incoming and outgoing  
data using SSL or TLS. It uses an explicit mode  
(starts encrypted communication after  
permission is granted).  
[Setting Values: RAuto, Manual]  
Auto Upload  
[Setting Values: RFTP, SFTP, FTPS, FTPES]  
When [Upload] is configured to “Auto”, FTP  
transfer starts automatically when the setting is  
configured to “On”.  
o
Server  
For setting the server name (“mystation.com”, etc.)  
or the IP address (“192.168.0.1”, etc.) of the FTP  
server.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
*
Enter not more than 127 characters using  
single-byte alphanumeric characters (a to z, 0 to  
9), single-byte hyphen [-], or dot [.].  
0
This is fixed at “Off” when [System] is set to  
“High-Speed”.  
0
o
Configuring [Auto Upload] to “On” disables  
configuration of all the settings under the Upload  
Settings item.  
Port  
Enter the FTP server port number to use using an  
integer between 1 and 65535.  
The default value varies with the protocol setting.  
(FTP: 21, SFTP: 22, FTPS: 990, FTPES: 21)  
9
Slot  
o
File Path  
For selecting the recording media slot to enable  
Enter the path name for the metadata file (“/pub/  
automatic upload.  
meta.xml”, “/home/user/meta2.xml”, etc.)  
[Setting Values: RA, B]  
0
o
Enter not more than 127 characters.  
Username  
Memo :  
0
This is fixed at “EXT” when [System] is set to “4K  
EXT (SSD)”.  
Enter the user name for connecting to the FTP  
server.  
*
Enter not more than 31 characters.  
142 Network Menu  
     
o
Server  
9
Cellular  
For setting the server name (“mystation.com”, etc.)  
or the IP address (“192.168.0.1”, etc.) of the FTP  
server.  
For configuring whether to enable connection via a  
USB cellular adapter.  
[Setting Values: Enable, RDisable]  
*
Enter not more than 127 characters using  
single-byte alphanumeric characters (a to z, 0 to  
9), single-byte hyphen [-], or dot [.].  
9
Server  
For configuring the server for uploading to the FTP  
server.  
o
Port  
[Setting Values: RClip-FTP1, Clip-FTP2, Clip-  
FTP3, Clip-FTP4]  
Enter the FTP server port number to use using an  
integer between 1 and 65535.  
The default value varies with the protocol setting.  
(FTP: 21, SFTP: 22, FTPS: 990, FTPES: 21, ZIXI:  
2088)  
Clip Server  
9
Clip-FTP1, Clip-FTP2, Clip-FTP3, Clip-  
o
Dir. Path  
FTP4  
Enter the path name for the directory to upload to  
*
The name that is set in [Alias] is displayed  
individually.  
(“/pub”, “/home/user”, etc.)  
*
o
Enter not more than 127 characters.  
Username  
o
Alias  
For setting a name to distinguish the settings of this  
Enter the user name for connecting to the FTP  
camera.  
server.  
The name set in this item will appear on the [FTP  
Upload] action screen of the thumbnail display.  
*
Enter not more than 31 characters.  
o
Stream ID A  
*
o
Enter not more than 31 characters.  
Protocol  
For configuring the stream ID that is registered at  
the distribution destination.  
For setting the protocol of the FTP server to be  
The default value varies with the product model.  
connected.  
*
Enter not more than 63 characters.  
0
0
0
FTP:  
Protocol that does not encrypt the incoming and  
outgoing data.  
Memo :  
0
This item is selectable only when [Type] is set to  
“ZIXI”.  
SFTP:  
Protocol that encrypts incoming and outgoing  
data using SSH.  
o
Password  
FTPS:  
Enter the password for connecting to the FTP  
Protocol that encrypts incoming and outgoing  
data using SSL or TLS. It uses an implicit mode  
(starts encrypted communication once  
connection starts).  
server.  
*
Enter not more than 31 characters. Enter not  
more than 127 characters for ZIXI setting.  
o
PASV Mode  
0
0
FTPES:  
For setting whether to set the communication mode  
used for file transfer to the passive mode.  
Set to “On” if the camera is inside a firewall, and a  
connection from the FTP server to the camera  
cannot be established.  
Protocol that encrypts incoming and outgoing  
data using SSL or TLS. It uses an explicit mode  
(starts encrypted communication after  
permission is granted).  
ZIXI:  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
Enables stable transmission by reducing jitter  
and packet loss significantly through  
communicating via a relay server.  
0
When [Protocol] is configured to “SFTP” or  
“ZIXI”, this item appears as “---” and cannot be  
selected.  
[Setting Values: RFTP, SFTP, FTPS, FTPES,  
ZIXI] A  
[Setting Values: RFTP, SFTP, FTPS, FTPES] B  
Memo :  
0
To use the “ZIXI” setting, a dedicated server is  
needed separately.  
0
If “ZIXI” is set, the resume function is enabled.  
Network Menu 143  
 
Type  
Overlay Settings Menu  
By selecting [Type], overlay images can be  
displayed.  
A L  
The selectable types of scoreboards vary with the  
[Layout] settings. L  
This screen is used to configure overlay settings.  
Images can be overlaid onto recorded video and  
live stream video.  
[Setting Values: Broadcast, RNone] A  
[Setting Values: Broadcast, Basketball, Baseball,  
Football, Type 2, Type 1, RNone] L  
Overlay Function  
Memo :  
For specifying whether to activate the overlay  
function.  
0
Selecting [Layout] or [Type] of the scoreboard  
overlay imported using [Import User Layout]  
displays the team settings menu. L  
[Setting Values: Enable, RDisable]  
Memo :  
0
The setting cannot be changed during  
recording, streaming or Return over IP.  
When [System] is configured to a setting other  
than “HD” and “HD+Web”, this item is fixed at  
“Disable”.  
When “Disable” is selected, settings of the  
overlay function cannot be changed.  
Overlay Custom Menu  
The display changes according to the imported  
data.  
0
Output  
0
For specifying overlay output settings.  
9
HD Recording  
Layout  
For setting whether to record overlay images  
together with the recorded video into an SD card.  
For selecting a SDP file.  
Memo :  
0
0
On:  
Saves the video with overlay images into an SD  
0
Create a SDP file using SDP Generator in  
card.  
Windows or Mac before recording.  
Off:  
Overlay images are not recorded into an SD  
card.  
Import User Layout  
[Setting Values: ROn, Off]  
Load the SDP file that is created by using SDP  
9
HDMI  
Generator onto this camera recorder.  
Memo :  
For setting whether to display overlay images on  
HDMI output.  
0
Maximum 4 files can be saved in this camera  
0
0
On:  
recorder.  
Displays overlay images on streaming videos  
0
The SDP file may not be saved depending on  
the available memory capacity of the camera  
recorder.  
and HDMI output.  
Off:  
Displays overlay images only on streaming  
videos.  
Delete User Layout  
[Setting Values: ROn, Off]  
For deleting the SDP file.  
Memo :  
9
SDI (Fixed)  
Displays overlay images on the SDI output. Setting  
0
The SDP file is not deleted by selecting [System]  
B [Reset All]. Delete the file from the camera  
recorder.  
is fixed at “On” and cannot be changed.  
Overlay Settings Menu A L  
144  
                 
9
Proxy Recording (Fixed)  
Full Screen Graphic  
Displays overlay images on the recording in slot B  
when [System] is configured to “HD+Web”. Setting  
is fixed at “On” and cannot be changed.  
Images can be displayed across the whole screen.  
9
Status  
For displaying the number of images saved in this  
camera recorder and the memory capacity used.  
9
Live Streaming (Fixed)  
Displays overlay images on live streaming videos.  
Setting is fixed at “On” and cannot be changed.  
9
Import Graphic W / Y  
Sportzcast L  
For reading the images to be used in Full Screen  
This camera recorder can be linked to a Sporzcast  
product to automatically import the scoreboard  
data at sports stadiums.  
Graphic from an SD card.  
Memo :  
0
0
0
JPEG and PNG formats are supported.  
Enter not more than 31 characters for the file  
name.  
Connect:  
Connects to the preconfigured Sportzcast  
server.  
0
Disconnect:  
9
Delete Graphic  
Terminates the current connection with the  
Sportzcast server.  
For deleting all images saved in this camera  
[Setting Values: Connect, RDisconnect]  
recorder.  
Memo :  
Password Lock  
0
“Connect” cannot be selected if network  
connection is not established.  
The Overlay Settings menu can be locked with a  
password.  
0
Switches to “Disconnect” upon shifting to a  
mode other than the Record mode or when the  
unit is powered off.  
0
On:  
A password is required to open the Overlay  
Settings menu.  
0
[Settings] cannot be selected when [Overlay  
Settings] B [Sportzcast] is configured to  
“Connect”.  
0
Off:  
Opens the Overlay Settings menu without a  
password.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Caution :  
0
9
Settings  
For specifying settings related to Sporzcast.  
Do not forget the password that you have set. If  
the password is lost or forgotten, you cannot  
deactivate the password protection function.  
Watermark  
Inserting watermarks (digital watermark) on  
recorded videos protects the content of your work.  
0
0
On:  
Displays watermark.  
Off:  
Does not display watermark.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
0
It can be displayed when the SDP file for which  
“Watermark” is preconfigured is selected in  
[Layout].  
9
Position  
The display position of the watermark can be  
changed by using the cross-shaped button.  
Overlay Settings Menu A L  
145  
       
9
Settings Item L (Sportzcast)  
BOT Number  
Enter the BOT number provided by Sportzcast.  
Server  
9
Channel  
Select the server to connect to.  
Enter the channel provided by Sportzcast.  
0
Cloud:  
For configuring the setting when connecting to  
the Sportzcast cloud service.  
Score Input Source  
For selecting whether to acquire the next score  
information from the server or to manually input the  
score from the web browser screen when  
[Sportzcast] is set to “Connect”. This option comes  
in handy when you want to manually enter only a  
part of the information.  
[Setting Values: RCloud, Server1 to Server3]  
9
Sever Settings  
o
Alias  
For setting a name to distinguish the settings of this  
camera. The name set in this item will be displayed  
in the [Server] options.  
Memo :  
0
0
0
The [Display] and [Overlay] buttons on the web  
browser screen remain enabled at all times  
regardless of the setting of this item.  
The [Display] and [Overlay] buttons on the web  
browser screen remain enabled at all times  
regardless of the setting of this item.  
If the overlay display is not updated even though  
the camera recorder is connected to a  
Sportzcast server, check whether “Sportzcast”  
is selected for each of the [Score Input Source]  
items.  
*1 The default value is “Cloud/Server1/Server2/  
Server3”.  
*2 You can enter up to 31 characters and ASCII  
characters.  
o
Address  
For configuring details such as the host name and  
the IP address of the destination of connection.  
*
Enter not more than 127 characters using  
single-byte alphanumeric characters (a to z, 0 to  
9), single-byte hyphen [-] or dot [.].  
o
Broadcast  
9
Set to “On” when connecting 3 or more Scorebot  
units to the camera at the same time.  
The broadcast setting on the Scorebot also needs  
to be set to “On”. For details on how to configure  
the setting on the Scorebot, please consult  
“Sportzcast”.  
Display Order (Home)  
For selecting whether to display the score  
information of the home team that is acquired from  
the Sportzcast in the left or right column (or upper  
or lower row). However, in the case of a baseball  
game, the score is always displayed in the lower  
row regardless of the setting.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
0
Last:  
9
Search Local Server  
Displays the score in the right column or lower  
For searching local servers (Scorebot) that are  
connected to the same local network as the camera  
through the Wizard and configuring the selected  
Scorebot to the [Server Settings].  
row.  
0
First:  
Displays the score in the left column or upper  
row.  
[Setting Values: RLast, First]  
Memo :  
0
If a Scorebot is currently being connected,  
searchcannotbeperformeduntiltheconnection  
has been terminated.  
9
Team Name  
For selecting the data reference source for the  
team name.  
0
0
Old settings that are saved in [Server Settings]  
at the storage destination will be overwritten.  
Connection is automatically established upon  
exiting the Wizard, and the [Server] setting  
switches to [Server Settings] while the camera  
is connected to the Scorebot.  
[Setting Values: RSportscast, Web]  
9
Shot Clock  
For selecting the data reference source for the shot  
clock.  
[Setting Values: RSportscast, Web]  
9
Others  
9
License Name  
For selecting the data reference source for score  
information not included in the respective settings.  
[Setting Values: RSportscast, Web]  
Enter the license name provided by Sportzcast.  
A license name that is currently in use by another  
camera cannot be used.  
Overlay Settings Menu A L  
146  
   
Setup File  
System Menu  
This allows you to save the menu settings as well  
as the performance results of shutter speed and  
AWB.  
This menu screen allows system-related settings.  
For configuring recording settings, formatting and  
restoration of a recording media, tally lamp setting,  
date/time, time zone and other settings.  
It can also be used to reset the menu settings to  
their default values.  
It is useful to save settings according to different  
shooting conditions.  
9
Load File...  
Loads the settings.  
Record Set...  
9
Store File...  
For specifying recorded video-related settings.  
Saves the settings.  
Media  
9
Delete File...  
9
Format Media  
Deletes the settings.  
For formatting (initializing) a recording media.  
Select a card slot, select [Format] from [Cancel]/  
[Format], and press the Set button (R) to format  
(initialize) the card.  
Tally Lamp  
For setting whether to light up the tally lamp during  
recording, when the remaining space warning is  
displayed, or during live streaming.  
Memo :  
0
9
Restore Media  
The blinking warning display, such as when the  
remaining battery level is low, is enabled in a  
setting other than “Off”.  
For restoring a recording media.  
Select a card slot, and press the Set button (R) to  
restore the recording media.  
0
0
Rec/Live Streaming:  
Memo :  
Lights up during recording or live streaming.  
Live Streaming:  
0
[! RESTORE] appears in the remaining level  
display area when a recording media that  
requires repair is inserted. However, it is not  
selectable when recording in Camera mode and  
during Clip Review.  
Lights up during live streaming. Does not light  
up during recording.  
0
0
Rec:  
Lights up during recording.  
External:  
Lights up when the camera recorder is  
controlled by an external device such as RM-  
LP100.  
When external is selected, [PVW] is displayed  
on the LCD/VF screen during Preview Tally, and  
[PGM] is displayed on the LCD/VF screen  
during Program Tally.  
0
Off:  
Turns off the indicator.  
[Setting Values: Rec/Live Streaming, Live  
Streaming, RRec, External, Off]  
System Menu 147  
           
NETWORK LED  
Reset All  
When this is configured to “On”, it lights up in red  
when live streaming is in progress.  
Resets all menu settings.  
Memo :  
The LED lights up in orange during poor streaming  
connection or connection failure.  
0
[Date/Time] and [Time Zone] cannot be reset.  
[Setting Values: ROn, Off]  
0
This item is not selectable when recording in  
Camera mode, during Clip Review, during live  
streaming and in Media mode.  
STATUS LED  
For configuring the STATUS LED.  
0
REC/Pre Rec:  
Lights up in red during recording or transition to  
recording. Lights up in orange when the  
remaining space on the recording media is  
running low. Lights up in green when Pre Rec is  
on standby.  
Date/Time  
For setting the year, month, day, hour, and minute.  
Memo :  
0
The display order of the date (year, month, day)  
follows the setting in [Display Settings] B [Date  
Style]. However, the 24-hour format is used for  
the hour display regardless of the [Time Style]  
setting.  
0
External:  
Lights up in red while in the Program mode when  
an external device such as RM-LP100 is  
connected. Lights up in green while in the  
Preview mode.  
0
0
Return over IP:  
0
For setting the time acquired from the GPS  
satellite by pressing the [FOCUS ASSIST/1]  
button if radio wave reception from the GPS  
satellite allows for setting of the date and time.  
The [USER1] button is grayed out if information  
for setting the date and time cannot be acquired  
from the GPS satellite. A L  
Lights up in green during Return over IP or when  
IFB is in progress. Lights up in orange when an  
error has occurred.  
Off:  
Does not light up.  
[Setting Values: RREC/Pre Rec, External, Return  
over IP, Off]  
LED Bright  
Date Style  
For specifying the brightness of the NETWORK  
LED and STATUS LED.  
For setting the date display sequence for display  
on the LCD monitor and viewfinder screen as well  
as for time stamp recording.  
[Setting Values: High, Middle, Low]  
Display examples of the setting values are as  
follows.  
GPS A L  
For setting the GPS function to On or Off (power  
on/off).  
0
0
0
0
0
DMY2: 30 Jun 2019  
DMY1: 30-06-2019  
MDY2: Jun 30, 2019  
MDY1: 06-30-2019  
YMD: 2019-06-30  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Memo :  
0
When [A/V Set] B [Video Set] B [SDI OUT1  
Res.] is set to “1080p”, configuring [System] B  
[GPS] to “On” changes the setting to “1080i”.  
[Setting Values: DMY2, DMY1, MDY1, MDY2,  
YMD]  
(Default values: MDY2 (U model), DMY1 (E  
model))  
Language  
Switches between languages in the menu screen.  
[Setting Values: REnglish, Français, Español] (U  
model)  
[Setting Values: REnglish, Français, Deutsch,  
Italiano, Español, Pусский, Türkçe] (E model)  
148 System Menu  
             
Record Set Item  
Record Format  
Time Style  
For setting the time display for display on the LCD  
monitor and viewfinder screen as well as for time  
stamp recording.  
After setting of all items in the [Record Format]  
menu is complete, select [Set] at the bottom of the  
screen to apply the new settings on the camera  
recorder and switch the recording format. A  
“Please Wait...” message appears during  
switching.  
[Setting Values: R24hour, 12hour]  
Time Zone  
For setting the UTC time difference in units of 30  
minutes.  
[Setting Values: UTC-12:00-UTC-00:30, UTC,  
UTC+00:30-UTC+14:00 (in 30 min increments)]  
(Default values: UTC-05:00 (U model), UTC (E  
model))  
9
System  
For selecting a system definition.  
0
4K EXT (SSD):  
Records videos in “4K EXT” quality to  
Memo :  
[EXT.SLOT] (SSD media).  
0
If [Date/Time] is already set, the [Date/Time]  
item is automatically adjusted when [Time  
Zone] is altered.  
0
0
4K:  
Records in “4K” quality for both slots A and B.  
HD:  
Records in “HD” (High Definition) quality for both  
Reserved  
slots A and B.  
0
0
SD:  
For setting the additional function to “On” or “Off”.  
Records in “SD” (Standard Definition) quality for  
both slots A and B.  
9
Reserved 1 to Reserved 16  
HD+Web:  
Normally set to “Off”.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
Records in “HD” (high definition) for slot A, and  
in resolution suitable for web distribution for slot  
B.  
System Information  
0
High-Speed:  
9
Version  
Records slow motion videos in “HD” (High  
Definition) for both slot A and slot B.  
Displays information on the firmware version.  
[Setting Values: 4K EXT (SSD), 4K, RHD, SD, HD  
Display  
:
0000-0000  
+Web, High-Speed]  
9
Fan Hour  
Caution :  
For displaying the usage time of the internal fan.  
Memo :  
0
The selectable options for the [WFormat]/  
[GFormat], [WResolution]/[GResolution],  
[WFrame Rate]/[GFrame Rate], [WBit Rate]/  
[GBit Rate], [WAudio]/[GAudio], [YFormat],  
[YResolution], [YFrame Rate], [YBit Rate] and  
[YAudio] settings vary depending on the setting  
of this item.  
0
Under normal environment, dust will  
accumulate on the internal fan when the camera  
recorder is used over a long period. Dust may  
enter the camera recorder especially if it is used  
outdoors. This may affect the image and sound  
quality of the camera recorder. Check and  
replace the fan after every 9000 hours  
(suggested guideline).  
9
Open Source License  
Displays the license for the open source software  
used by this camera recorder.  
System Menu 149  
             
9
9
WFormat/ GFormat  
WResolution/ GResolution  
For selecting the format of the file to be recorded to  
For selecting the size of the still image to be  
recorded to the recording media in slot A or  
[EXT.SLOT]. (Horizontal x vertical)  
the recording media in slot A or [EXT.SLOT].  
0
0
0
0
0
QuickTime(MPEG2):  
QuickTime file format (.MOV)  
MXF(MPEG2):  
The available options vary according to the settings  
of [System] and [WFormat].  
MXF (material exchange format)  
QuickTime(H.264):  
0
When [System] is set to “4K EXT (SSD)” or “4K”:  
Fixed at “3840x2160”.  
QuickTime file format (.MOV)  
Exchange: (U model only)  
Sports Video Interop Group format  
MP4 (H.264): (E model only)  
MP4 file format  
0
When [System] is set to “HD”, and [WFormat] is  
set to “QuickTime(MPEG2)” or “MXF(MPEG2)”:  
[Setting Values: R1920x1080, 1440x1080,  
1280x720]  
0
0
0
When [System] is set to “HD”, and [WFormat] is  
set to “QuickTime(H.264)”:  
[Setting Values: QuickTime(MPEG2),  
MXF(MPEG2), RQuickTime(H.264), Exchange]  
(U model only)A  
[Setting Values: 1920x1080, 1280x720]  
When [System] is set to “HD”, and [WFormat] is  
set to “Exchange” (U model only):  
[Setting Values: QuickTime(MPEG2),  
MXF(MPEG2), RQuickTime(H.264), MP4 (H.  
264)](E model only)A  
[Setting Values: 1920x1080, 1280x720]  
When [System] is set to “HD”, and [WFormat] is  
set to “MP4(H.264)” (E model only):  
[Setting Values: 1920x1080, 1280x720]  
When [System] is set to “HD+Web”:  
[Setting Values: 1920x1080, 1280x720]  
When [System] is set to “High-Speed”:  
Fixed at “1920x1080”.  
[Setting Values: RQuickTime(H.264), Exchange]  
(U model only)B  
[Setting Values: RQuickTime(H.264), MP4 (H.  
264)](E model only)B  
0
0
0
[Setting Values: QuickTime(H.264), RExchange]  
L
Memo :  
0
When [System] is set to “4K EXT (SSD)”, this  
item is fixed at “ProRes”.  
When [System] is set to “4K”, “SD”, “HD+Web”,  
or “High-Speed”, this item is fixed at  
“QuickTime(H.264)”.  
Exchange file format can be selected only when  
[System] is set to “HD”.  
Exchange format is used under license from  
Sports Video Interoperability Group, Inc..  
When [System] is set to “SD”:  
Fixed at either “720x480” or “720x576”.  
0
Memo :  
0
The selectable values of [WFrame Rate]/  
[GFrame Rate] and [WBit Rate]/[GBit Rate]  
vary according to the setting of this item.  
0
0
150 System Menu  
 
9
9
WFrame Rate/ GFrame Rate  
WBit Rate/ GBit Rate  
For selecting the frame rate for recording to the  
recording media in slot A or [EXT.SLOT].  
The available options vary according to the settings  
for [System], [WResolution]/[GResolution] and  
[WFormat]/[GFormat].  
For selecting the bit rate for recording to the  
recording media in slot A or [EXT.SLOT].  
The available options vary according to the settings  
for [System], [WResolution]/[GResolution] and  
[WFormat]/[GFormat].  
0
When [System] is set to “4K EXT (SSD)”:  
[Setting Values: 422HQ, 422, 422LT]  
When [System] is set to “4K”:  
0
0
0
When [System] is set to “4K EXT (SSD)”:  
[Setting Values: 60p, 50p, 30p, 25p, 24p]  
When [System] is set to “4K”:  
0
[Setting Values:  
150M, 150M, 70M]  
[Setting Values: 30p, 25p, 24p]  
When [System] is set to “HD”, [WFormat] is set  
to “QuickTime(MPEG2)” or  
“MXF(MPEG2)”A, and [WResolution] is set  
to “1920x1080”:  
0
When [System] is set to “HD”, [WFormat] is set  
to “QuickTime(MPEG2)” or  
“MXF(MPEG2)”A, and [WResolution] is set  
to “1440x1080”:  
[Setting Values: 60i, 50i, 30p, 25p]  
When [System] is set to “HD” or “HD+Web”,  
[WFormat] is set to “QuickTime(H.264)”, and  
[WResolution] is set to “1920x1080”:  
[Setting Values: 60p, 60i, 50p, 50i, 30p, 25p,  
24p]  
[Setting Values: 35M (HQ), 25M (SP)]  
0
*
When [WResolution] is set to a setting other than  
“1440x1080”, it is fixed at “35M (HQ)”.  
0
When [System] is set to “HD” or “HD+Web” and  
[WFormat] is set to “QuickTime(H.264)”:  
0
When [WResolution] is set to “1920x1080”,  
and [WFrame Rate] is set to “60p” or “50p”:  
0
0
0
0
When [System] is set to “HD”, and  
[WResolution] to “1440x1080”:  
[Setting Values: 60i, 50i]  
[Setting Values:  
70M (XHQ),  
When [System] is set to “HD” or “HD+Web” and  
[WResolution] is set to “1280x720”:  
[Setting Values: 60p, 50p]  
50M (XHQ), 50M (XHQ)]  
0
When [WResolution] is set to “1920x1080”,  
and [WFrame Rate] to “60i”/“50i”/“30p”/“25p”/  
“24p”:  
When [System] is set to “HD”, and [WFormat] to  
“Exchange”:  
[Setting Values:  
50M (XHQ), 50M  
Fixed at “60p”. (U model only)  
When [System] is set to “HD”, and [WFormat] to  
“MP4(H.264)”:  
(XHQ), 35M (UHQ)]  
0
When [WResolution] is set to “1280x720”:  
[Setting Values:  
(UHQ)]  
50M (XHQ), 35M  
Fixed at “50p”. (E model only)  
0
0
0
When [System] is set to “SD”:  
0
0
When [System] is set to “HD”, and [WFormat] to  
“Exchange” (U model only):  
Fixed at “60i”. (U model only)  
When [System] is set to “SD”:  
When [System] is set to “HD”, and [WFormat] to  
“MP4(H.264)” (E model only):  
Fixed at “50i”. (E model only)  
When [System] is set to “High-Speed”:  
[Setting Values: 120/60p, 100/50p, 120/30p,  
100/25p, 120/24p]  
0
When [WResolution] is set to “1920x1080”:  
Fixed at “12M(LP)”.  
0
When [WResolution] is set to “1280x720”:  
Fixed at “8M(LP)”.  
0
0
When [System] is set to “SD”:  
Fixed at 8M (HQ).  
When [System] is set to “High-Speed”:  
0
When [WFrame Rate] is set to “120/60p” or  
“100/50p”  
[Setting Values:  
70M (XHQ),  
50M (XHQ), 50M (UHQ)]  
0
When [WFrame Rate] is configured to a  
setting other than “120/60p” and “100/50p”  
[Setting Values:  
50M (XHQ), 50M  
(XHQ), 35M (UHQ)]  
System Menu 151  
 
9
9
WAudio/ GAudio  
Y Frame Rate  
For switching to the audio that is to be recorded to  
the recording media in slot A or [EXT.SLOT].  
The selectable options vary according to the  
settings in [WFormat]/[GFormat] or [WBit Rate]/  
[GBit Rate].  
The frame rate of the image to be recorded to the  
SD card in slot B is fixed when [System] is set to  
“HD+Web”.  
The value fixed varies according to the settings for  
[WFrame Rate].  
0
Fixed at “60i”, “50i”, “30p”, “25p” or “24p”.  
9
Y Format  
Memo :  
For selecting the format of the file to be recorded to  
the SD card in slot B when [System] is configured  
to “HD+Web”.  
0
When [System] is set to other than “HD+Web”,  
this item is fixed at the same setting as [WFrame  
Rate].  
This is fixed at QuickTime (H.264).  
Memo :  
9
Y Bit Rate  
0
When [System] is set to other than “HD+Web”,  
this item is fixed at the same setting as  
[WFormat].  
The bit rate of the image to be recorded to the SD  
card in slot B is fixed when [System] is set to “HD  
+Web”.  
The value fixed varies according to the settings for  
[YResolution].  
9
Y Resolution  
For selecting the size of the image to be recorded  
to the SD card in slot B when [System] is configured  
to “HD+Web”. (Horizontal x vertical)  
0
“3M(HQ)” when [YResolution] is configured  
to “960x540”  
0
“1.2M(LP)” when [YResolution] is configured  
0
When [System] is set to “HD+Web”:  
to “480x270”  
0
When [WFrame Rate] is configured to “60p”/  
0
“8M(HQ)” when [YResolution] is configured  
“60i”/“30p”  
to “720x480” or “720x576”  
Memo :  
[Setting Values: 960x540, 720x480,  
480x270]  
0
0
When [System] is set to other than “HD+Web”,  
this item is fixed at the same setting as [WBit  
Rate].  
When [WFrame Rate] is configured to “50p”/  
“50i”/“25p”  
[Setting Values: 960x540, 720x576,  
480x270]  
9
Y Audio  
0
When [WFrame Rate] is configured to “24p”  
[Setting Values: 960x540, 480x270]  
The audio to be recorded to slot B is the same as  
the audio to be recorded to slot A.  
Memo :  
0
When [System] is set to other than “HD+Web”,  
this item is fixed at the same setting as  
[WResolution].  
9
SD Aspect  
For setting the aspect ratio of the image when  
[System] is set to “SD”.  
[Setting Values: R16:9, 4:3]  
Memo :  
0
For conditions other than those above, this item  
is fixed at “16:9”.  
152 System Menu  
   
Rec Mode  
Slot Mode  
0
For selecting the mode for recording to the  
recording media.  
For setting the operation of the card slot.  
0
Series:  
Mode that activates slots A and B sequentially.  
Dual:  
0
[Setting Values: RNormal, Pre Rec, Clip  
Mode that activates slots A and B  
simultaneously.  
Continuous, Interval Rec, Frame Rec]  
Memo :  
Backup:  
0
0
When [Slot Mode] is set to “Backup”, this item is  
fixed at “Normal”.  
0
Mode that enables recording to slot B without  
using the [REC] button. This item is selectable  
only when [Rec Mode] is set to “Normal”.  
Record, start and stop operations can be  
controlled from the [Backup Rec] menu or using  
the user button that is assigned with “Backup  
Trig”.  
[Setting Values: RSeries, Dual, Backup]  
Memo :  
This is fixed at “Normal” when [System] B  
[Record Format] B [System] is configured to any  
of the following.  
0
4K EXT (SSD)  
0
HD+Web  
0
High-Speed  
9
Pre Rec Time  
For setting the pre-recording time when [Rec  
Mode] is set to “Pre Rec”.  
0
When this is configured to “Series” and  
recordable media is inserted into slot A or slot B  
or both the slots, pressing the [REC] button  
starts recording only to the card in the selected  
slot (active slot).  
[Setting Values: R5sec, 10sec, 15sec]  
Memo :  
0
When [System] B [Record Set] B [Record  
Format] B [System] is set to “4K”, this item is  
fixed at “5sec”.  
0
When this is configured to “Dual” and recordable  
media are inserted into both slots A and B,  
pressing the [REC] button starts simultaneous  
recording to the cards in both slots.  
9
Rec Frames  
For setting the number of frames to record when  
[Rec Mode] is set to “Frame Rec” or “Interval Rec”.  
[Setting Values: R1frame, 3frames, 6frames]  
0
0
When [System] is configured to 4K EXT (SSD)  
or “HD+Web”, “---” is displayed.  
When [System] is set to “High-Speed”, this item  
is fixed at “Series”.  
9
Rec Interval  
For setting the recording time interval when [Rec  
Mode] is set to “Interval Rec”.  
9
Backup Rec  
[Setting Values: R1sec, 2sec, 5sec, 10sec, 30sec,  
1min, 2min, 5min, 10min, 30min, 1hour]  
For starting/stopping backup recording with [REC]/  
[STBY].  
This item is selectable only when [Slot Mode] is set  
to “Backup”.  
Memo :  
0
When recording is stopped due to no remaining  
space on the media, etc., this item is fixed at  
“STOP” and cannot be selected.  
System Menu 153  
       
4GB File Spanning(SDXC)  
Clip Set  
A recording file is automatically split when the size  
exceeds 4 GB, but if an SDXC card is used, you  
can record clips larger than 4 GB by setting this  
option to “Off”. (Up to a maximum of 64 GB or 4  
hours)  
9
Clip Name Prefix  
For configuring the first four characters of the name  
oftheclipfiletoberecordedtotherecordingmedia.  
Enter any of the 36 characters including alphabets  
(upper case) and numbers (0 to 9) using the  
software keyboard.  
0
On:  
Splits a file when it exceeds 4 GB or 30 minutes.  
Off:  
[Setting Values: xxxG] (The default value of xxx is  
the last three digits of the serial number.)  
0
Splits a file when it exceeds 64 GB or 4 hours.  
[Setting Values: ROn, Off]  
9
Reset Clip Number  
Memo :  
0
For assigning a new number (Clip Number) by  
This option is only valid if the SD card used for  
resetting it (0001).  
recording is of the SDXC format.  
0
Select [Reset] and press the Set button (R) to reset  
the number.  
During simultaneous recording, such as Dual  
Rec and backup recording, this option is valid  
only when the SD cards in slots A and B are of  
the SDXC format.  
If there are other clips on the recording media, it will  
be assigned with the smallest available number.  
0
Example:  
If the [Clip Name Prefix] is “ABCD” and  
“ABCD0001” already exists on the recording  
media, “ABCD0002” will be assigned.  
LPCM (QuickTime)  
For setting the audio recording format of  
QuickTime.  
[Setting Values: Dual Mono, RStereo]  
Clear Planning Metadata  
Time Stamp  
Erases the planning metadata downloaded from  
the FTP server.  
For setting whether to display shooting date/time  
information in the recorded video.  
[Setting Values: On, ROff]  
This item also deletes the metadata loaded using  
the setup files (“User File”/“All File”).  
Memo :  
0
The date/time display style can be changed in  
[Date Style]/[Time Style].  
0
0
The setting cannot be changed during  
recording, streaming or Return over IP.  
When [System] is set to “4K EXT (SSD)”, “4K” or  
“High-Speed”, this item is fixed at “Off”.  
When [Overlay Function] is set to “Enable”, this  
item is fixed at “Off”. A L  
0
154 System Menu  
       
Adding Menu Items to Favorites Menu  
Adding/Editing  
1
2
Press the [MENU/THUMB] button to open  
the [Main Menu] screen.  
Select the menu or submenu item to add.  
Frequently Used Menu  
Items (Favorites Menu)  
You can select and add/edit frequently used menu  
items freely to create a personal menu screen  
(Favorites Menu).  
Display Settings  
Focus  
Meter  
2
Memo :  
0
[Favorites Menu] is only enabled in the Camera  
mode. [Favorites Menu] remains unchanged  
even when the recording format changes.  
Up to 20 menu items can be added.  
0
0
Added items in [Favorites Menu] will not be reset  
even when [System] B [Reset All] is executed.  
Long descriptive names may be displayed for  
the menu items in [Favorites Menu] to enable  
better understanding.  
.
Memo :  
0
0
Adding items to [Favorites Menu] cannot be  
performed in the following cases. [USER1  
Add] is displayed in gray in the operation guide.  
0
Selected item is already added to [Favorites  
Menu].  
0
Number of menu items that can be added (20  
items) is exceeded.  
3
Press the [FOCUS ASSIST/1] button.  
A screen to confirm the addition appears.  
4
Select [Add] and press the Set button (R).  
The selected menu item is added to [Favorites  
Menu].  
Add to Favorites Menu?  
Focus  
Add  
Cancel  
4
.
Adding/Editing Frequently Used Menu Items (Favorites Menu) 155  
   
Editing Favorites Menu  
4
Press the [OIS/2] button.  
A delete mark (b) appears at the beginning of  
the menu item.  
You can delete or change the order of the items  
added to [Favorites Menu].  
Deleting Items from [Favorites Menu]  
Edit Favorites  
Aspect Marker  
1
Open the [Favorites Menu] screen.  
A
Press the [MENU/THUMB] button to  
open the [Main Menu] screen.  
B
Press the [DISPLAY] button or press and  
hold down the [MENU/THUMB] button to  
open the [Favorites Menu] screen.  
2
.
Select [Edit Favorites] and press the Set  
button (R) or crossed-shaped button (I).  
The header turns magenta and the editing  
mode is activated.  
Memo :  
0
When the [OIS/2] button is pressed again while  
the menu item with the delete mark (b) is  
selected, the menu item will be excluded from  
the items to be deleted and the delete mark (b)  
disappears.  
Favorites Menu  
5
Press the [FOCUS ASSIST/1] button.  
The option menu to exit the [Favorites Menu]  
editing mode appears.  
Select [Save & Exit] and press the Set  
button (R).  
Edit Favorites  
2
6
Edit Favorites  
Camera Function...  
Edit Favorites  
Header  
(Magenta)  
Save & Exit  
Exit without Saving  
Cancel  
6
.
.
3
Select the menu or submenu item to delete.  
Memo :  
0
0
0
Deletion is not complete until the changes are  
saved with [Save & Exit].  
Edit Favorites  
To exit the editing mode without deleting any  
items, select [Exit without Saving].  
To return to the editing mode, select [Cancel].  
Aspect Marker  
3
.
156 Adding/Editing Frequently Used Menu Items (Favorites Menu)  
 
Changing the Order of Items in [Favorites  
Menu]  
3
Select the menu or submenu item to move  
and press the Set button (R).  
The moving mode is activated and a position  
selection bar for the move appears.  
1
Open the [Favorites Menu] screen.  
Press the [MENU/THUMB] button to open the  
[Favorites Menu] screen.  
Edit Favorites  
2
Select [Edit Favorites] and press the Set  
button (R) or crossed-shaped button (I).  
The header turns magenta and the editing  
mode is activated.  
TC/UB  
3
Favorites Menu  
Edit Favorites  
Edit Favorites  
2
TC/UB  
Position  
Selection  
Bar  
Edit Favorites  
Camera Function...  
Header  
(Magenta)  
.
4
Select the position to move to with the  
cross-shaped button (JK).  
Move the position selection bar with the cross-  
shaped button (JK) and select a position to  
move to.  
5
Press the Set button (R).  
.
The selected item moves to the new position.  
Edit Favorites  
4
TC/UB  
Edit Favorites  
TC/UB  
5
.
Adding/Editing Frequently Used Menu Items (Favorites Menu) 157  
6
7
Press the [FOCUS ASSIST/1] button.  
The option menu to exit the [Favorites Menu]  
editing mode appears.  
Select [Save & Exit] and press the Set  
button (R).  
Edit Favorites  
Save & Exit  
Exit without Saving  
Cancel  
7
.
Memo :  
0
0
0
Moving is not complete until the changes are  
saved with [Save & Exit].  
To exit the editing mode without saving any  
changes, select [Exit without Saving].  
To return to the editing mode, select [Cancel].  
158 Adding/Editing Frequently Used Menu Items (Favorites Menu)  
W
!INCORRECT  
:
Display Screen in Camera  
Mode  
When the display setting for [LCD/VF] B [Display  
On/Off] is set to “Off”, the corresponding display is  
hidden. However, the display may appear during  
event display or warning display.  
0
Recording media is not supported.  
When an SD card lower than Class 10 is  
inserted while in the XHQ mode.  
0
W!REC INH  
:
0
When attempting to record more than 4  
GBwhileanSDcardthatdoesnotsupport  
recording of more than 4 GB is inserted.  
The following icons are displayed during FTP  
upload.  
Memo :  
0
When the display setting for [LCD/VF] B  
[DisplayOn/Off]issetto “On”, thedisplayscreen  
appears only in the following cases if it has been  
turned off.  
Icon  
Status  
[Auto Upload] is configured to  
“On” and in the standby state.  
“A” is displayed at the top left  
corner of the icon while in the  
Auto FTP mode.  
0
Approximately 3 seconds when changes are  
.
being made  
0
During event display or warning display  
Display Screen  
Auto FTP transfer is in progress.  
Three images are alternately  
displayed, and the arrows  
become animated.  
e
k j  
h
.
f
d
i
g
c b  
a
Z
120/60fps  
1080 /30p  
282min  
100min  
50min  
00:00:00.00  
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
Y
W
U
FTP transfer is in progress.  
Three images are alternately  
displayed, and the arrows  
become animated. In this case,  
instead of the remaining  
recordable time on the  
5 . 6 f t  
X
V
12 :34 :56  
.
SB  
P
T
R
P
S
Q
0
COMPRESS  
ITU709  
ND1  
AE  
/64  
0
ꢀꢁ ꢂꢁ ꢃꢁ ꢄꢁ  
recording media, an estimated  
value of the remaining transfer  
time is displayed.  
K
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
5600  
/ 60  
102400  
J K L M  
N
O
.
A
Voltage/Battery Power  
Error has occurred during FTP  
Displays the current status of the power supply  
in use.  
transfer.  
.
(Yellow)  
Memo :  
Memo :  
0
0
The displayed time is an estimate.  
0
Even when the display screen is turned off and  
[LCD/VF] B [Display On/Off] B [Battery] is set to  
“Off”, this will be displayed when there is a  
warning.  
Even when the display screen is hidden and  
[LCD/VF] B [Display On/Off] B [Media  
Remain] is set to “Off”, this will be displayed  
when there is a warning.  
B
Remaining Space on Media  
C
Volume Operation Indicator  
Displays the remaining recording time for the  
recording media in slot A and slot B separately.  
Displayed when there are changes made to the  
volume of the headphone(x) (0 to 15), the  
values of LCD BRIGHT (E) or PEAKING (J)  
(-10 to +10).  
W Y  
G
:
Currently selected slot. (White card)  
W z  
W!INVALID  
:
Write-protect switch of SD card is set.  
D
Operation lock  
:
When a recording media  
writing/reading error has  
occurred, or when the  
recording media is  
irreparable.  
The r icon appears during operation lock.  
Memo :  
0
The s icon appears for 3 seconds after  
operation lock is turned off.  
W!FORMAT  
:
:
Recording media requires  
formatting.  
W!RESTORE  
Recording media requires  
repair.  
Display Screen in Camera Mode 159  
       
E
F
L
Camera Angle [Tagging] L  
Shutter  
0
Displays the camera angle tagging information  
The current shutter speed appears on the  
screen.  
when [WFormat] is configured to “Exchange”.  
ODK [Tagging] L  
0
When the camera recorder is switched to the  
Full Auto shooting mode by turning the [FULL  
AUTO] switch to “ON” or when it is switched  
to the Automatic Shutter mode with [Camera  
Function] B [Shutter] configured to “EEI”, the  
a icon appears on the left side of the shutter  
speed.  
Displays the ODK (Offence, Defence, Kick)  
tagging information when [WFormat] is  
configured to “Exchange”. It flashes in red when  
in the REMOVE mode.  
G
Black Toe  
Displays the Black Toe setting.  
Memo :  
0
Memo :  
0
The “Normal” appears for 3 seconds after  
changing to Normal.  
The variable range of the shutter speed varies  
according to the video format settings.  
While in the Automatic Shutter mode, and [AE  
H
Color Space Display  
0
Displays the color space.  
Lock] is set to “AE” or “AE/FAW”, a  
icon  
Memo :  
0
appears on the left side of the shutter speed  
This can be configured in [Camera Process] B  
[Color Space].  
during lock operation.  
0
0
“[OFF]” appears for 3 seconds after Shutter is  
configured to Off.  
I
“[OFF]” is displayed when in the low-light  
shooting mode.  
Audio Level Meter  
0
0
Displays the audio levels for CH-1 to CH-2.  
a appears on the screen when in the Auto  
mode.  
M
AE Level  
0
0
Displayed when the AE function is activated.  
When operated while manual operation is  
disabled, “AE” blinks for about 5 seconds.  
4030 20 10  
0
.
N
Gain  
0
This is grayed out when in a mode that does  
not support audio recording or when the  
audio is not supported.  
0
You can select to display the gain in “dB” or  
“ISO”.  
J
Iris F-Number  
0
0
0
Displays the gain value when in the Manual  
Gain mode.  
Displays F-number of the lens iris.  
A a icon appears on the left side of the gain  
value in the “AGC” mode.  
Memo :  
“LUX” is displayed to the left of the gain value  
when in the Low-light shooting mode.  
0
A a icon appears on the left side of the lens  
aperture value (F-number) during Auto Iris  
mode.  
Memo :  
0
0
While in the Auto Iris mode, and [AE Lock] is set  
While in the “AGC” mode, and [AE Lock] is set  
to “AE” or “AE/FAW”, a icon appears on the  
left side of the gain value during lock operation.  
to “AE” or “AE/FAW”, a  
icon appears on the  
left side of the lens aperture value (F-number)  
during lock operation.  
K
ND Filter Position  
Displays the current ND filter position.  
160 Display Screen in Camera Mode  
 
O
T
White Balance Mode  
Focus Assist  
0
Displays the current white balance mode.  
(*****K indicates color temperature)  
” is displayed when auto focus is  
activated.  
0
When ACCU-Focus is enabled, “ACCU  
A *****K  
B *****K  
P *****K  
:
:
:
When the [WHT BAL B/A/PRESET]  
switchissettoAintheManualWhite  
Balance mode.  
blinks for about 10 seconds while Focus  
Assist starts up, after which the “  
indicator lights up.  
When the [WHT BAL B/A/PRESET]  
switch is set to “B” in the Manual  
White Balance mode.  
0
If recording starts while [ACCU-Focus] is  
active, [ACCU-Focus] will be forcibly  
deactivated.  
When the [WHT BAL B/A/PRESET]  
switch is set to “PRESET” in the  
Manual White Balance mode.  
During Full Auto White Balance  
mode.  
U
V
Luminance Information  
Displayed when the Spot Meter function is  
activated.  
a
FAW  
FAW  
:
:
While in the Full Auto White Balance  
mode, and [AE Lock] is set for “FAW”  
or “AE/FAW” during lock operation.  
MAX  
:
:
Maximum luminance  
Minimum luminance  
MIN  
Zebra pattern  
During zebra pattern display,  
(zebra icon)  
is displayed on the display screen in Camera  
mode.  
Memo :  
0
When [Preset Paint], [AWB Paint] or [FAW  
Paint] is set to a setting other than the default  
value, a q icon is displayed to the right of the  
color temperature.  
W
Time Display  
Displays the current time.  
Memo :  
0
The date/time display style can be configured in  
P
Expanded Focus/Histogram  
[System] B [Date/Time].  
Displayed upon pressing the user button that is  
assigned with “Expanded Focus” and  
“Histogram”.  
0
When [System] B [Record Set] B [Time  
Stamp] is set to “On”, this item is not displayed.  
X
Focus Display  
Memo :  
0
Displays the focus state and the approximate  
distance to the subject in focus.  
Display switches in the order of “Expanded  
Focus” > “Histogram”.  
d
e
:
:
:
Manual focus  
Autofocus  
Q
Infrared Recording  
Autofocus lock  
I” is displayed when the infrared recording is  
C
D
:
:
[AF Area]-“Wide”  
[AF Area]-“Multi”  
ON.  
R
S
Face Detection  
Displayed when Face Detection is ON.  
Memo :  
0
q
:
:
When [Face Detection] is set to  
“ON”  
When [Face Only AF] is configured  
to “ON” while [Face Detection] is  
“ON”  
The displayed unit of measurement (feet or  
meter) can be configured in [LCD/VF] B [Display  
Type] B [Focus].  
When focus display is grayed, Auto Focus  
cannot function.  
H
0
Image Stabilizer Mark  
Displayed when the image stabilizer is ON.  
i
:
When [Level] of [OIS] is set to  
“Normal”.  
When [Level] of [OIS] is set to “High”.  
j
:
Memo :  
0
When Image Stabilizer is configured to “OFF”,  
h is displayed for 3 seconds.  
Display Screen in Camera Mode 161  
   
Y
a
Zoom Display  
Time Code (I)/User’s Bit (J) Display  
0
0
Displays the zoom position. (Zoom bar or  
value)  
Displays the time code (hour: minute:  
second: frame) or user’s bit data.  
Example of time code display:  
Display Screen  
0
Dynamic Zoom Off:  
.
0 0 : 0 0 : 0 0 : 0 0  
Dynamic Zoom On:  
*
.
.
*
Colon (:) denotes non-drop frames and dot  
(.) denotes drop frames.  
0
0
0
The zoom bar will only be displayed for 3  
seconds after the zoom operation is  
activated.  
0
Example of user’s bit display:  
Display Screen  
The value will always be displayed.  
Dynamic Zoom Off: Z00 to Z99  
Dynamic Zoom On: DZ000 to DZ149  
When[DigitalExtender]isconfiguredtoOn”,  
F” is displayed to the right of the zoom  
display.  
FF EE DD 20  
.
Memo :  
0
Use [LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B [TC/UB] to  
toggle between the time code display and user’s  
bit display.  
Memo :  
0
The mode of display (value or bar) can be  
configured in [LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B  
[Zoom].  
b
Time Code Lock Indicator  
When the built-in time code generator is  
synchronized to the external time code data  
input during the synchronization of time code  
with another camera recorder, Z lights up.  
Z
Network Connection Icon  
The network connection status is displayed.  
c
IFB/RET Mark  
Icon  
Status  
Displays the status of the IFB or Return over IP.  
Wireless LAN connection from the  
Icon  
Status  
During audio feed only  
host terminal (USB) is established  
.
Wired LAN connection from the  
host terminal (USB) is established  
.
.
When an error occurs during  
audio feed only  
Cellular adapter connection from  
the host terminal (USB) is  
established  
.
.
(Yellow)  
During video+audio feed  
When a USB adapter different  
from the connection settings is  
detected  
.
.
When an error occurs during  
video+audio feed  
Built-in wireless LAN connection is  
.
established  
.
(Yellow)  
A
LAN terminal connection is  
established  
0
When an unusable USB  
adapter is detected  
When the LAN cable is not  
connected  
(No  
0
display)  
Memo :  
0
Yellow display indicates preparation for  
connection in progress.  
162 Display Screen in Camera Mode  
   
d
f
SDI/HDMI Record Trigger  
Media Status  
----  
STBY B : When [A/V Set] B [Video Set] B  
[SDI OUT] B [Rec Trigger] is set to  
“Type-A” or “Type-B”, or [HDMI  
OUT] B [Rec Trigger] is set to “On”  
and recording is stopped  
:
A card is not detected in the  
selected slot, and [Tally  
Lamp] is configured to a setting  
other than “External” or  
[STATUS LED] is configured to  
a setting other than “External”  
Recording standby  
REC B  
:
When [A/V Set] B [Video Set] B  
[SDI OUT] B [Rec Trigger] is set to  
“Type-A” or “Type-B”, or [HDMI  
OUT] B [Rec Trigger] is set to “On”  
and recording is in progress  
STBY  
:
:
:
RREC  
REVIEW  
Recording  
Clip Review  
e
GPS Mark A L  
When [System] B [GPS] is set to “On”, the  
signal reception status is displayed.  
STBY O  
:
Pre Rec recording standby  
RRECO Pre Rec recording  
STBY L  
:
Memo :  
0
0
:
Clip Continuous Rec recording  
standby  
The display changes according to the signal  
reception sensitivity. If signals cannot be  
received, the H mark appears in yellow  
regardless of the [LCD/VF] B [Display On/Off]  
B [GPS] setting.  
This item is not displayed when [GPS] is set to  
“Off”.  
RRECL  
:
Clip Continuous Rec recording  
STBYL  
:
Clip Continuous Rec recording  
(displayed in pause  
yellow)  
STBY N  
:
Interval Rec recording standby  
STBYN  
(displayed in  
red)  
:
Interval recording pause  
RRECN  
:
Interval Rec recording  
STBY M  
RRECM Frame Rec recording  
:
Frame Rec recording standby  
:
STBYM  
:
Frame Rec recording pause  
(displayed in  
yellow)  
STOP  
:
Unable to record to the card in  
the slot  
P.OFF  
:
:
Power OFF  
Q
During clip cutter recording  
(displayed for 3 seconds)  
PGM  
:
Receiving program signals  
from an external device, such  
as a remote control unit  
PVW  
:
Receiving preview signals  
from an external device, such  
as a remote control unit  
Display Screen in Camera Mode 163  
 
g
Live streaming mark  
When [Network] B [Live Streaming] B [Live  
Streaming] is set to “On”, the distribution status  
is displayed.  
Icon  
(Red)  
(Red)  
Status  
Distribution in progress (good  
connection quality)  
.
Distribution in progress (poor  
connection quality)  
.
Waiting for connection  
(RTSP/RTP only), connection  
failed  
.
(Yellow)  
High-Speed Frame Rate  
h
0
When [System] B [Record Set] B [Record  
Format] B [System] is configured to “High-  
Speed”, the setting value for [WFrame Rate]  
is displayed.  
i
j
OK Mark  
Displayed when OK mark has been appended.  
Recording Format  
Displays the recording format.  
Memo :  
0
The resolution, frame rate and bit rate can be  
viewed on the status screen.  
k
Event/Warning Display Area  
Displays error messages.  
164 Display Screen in Camera Mode  
 
F
Position Bar  
Display Screen in Media  
Mode  
When the display setting for [LCD/VF] B [Display  
On/Off] is set to “Off”, the corresponding display is  
hidden.  
Displays the current position in the video.  
During trimming, the position bar appears in  
green, and icons for the in and out points are  
displayed.  
6 : Current position of the video  
7
:
:
Position to start trimming  
(In point)  
8
Position to end trimming  
Memo :  
(Out point)  
0
Display on the information display area can be  
toggled using the [ONLINE/3] button.  
When the display setting for [LCD/VF] B  
[DisplayOn/Off]issettoOn”, thedisplayscreen  
appears only in the following cases if it has been  
turned off.  
G
H
Volume Operation Indicator  
0
Displayed when there are changes made to the  
volume of the headphone(x), speaker(K) (0  
to 15), the values of LCD BRIGHT (E) or  
PEAKING (J) (-10 to +10).  
0
During event display or warning display  
Information Display  
Use the [ONLINE/3] button to switch between  
camera information display, GPS display and  
turning off the display.  
Q P  
O
N
M
L
K
A
1000/2000  
282min  
3840x2160  
30p 140M  
00:00:00.00  
J
I
B
C
0
0
The GPS display displays information on the  
recording location of the video being played  
back only when GPS information has been  
recorded.  
Jan 24,2019  
12 :34 :56  
D
E
Camera information display displays only  
information of Gain, Iris, Shutter and White  
Balance that have been recorded.  
0
4030 20 10  
0
F
G
H
.
A
Voltage/Battery Power  
0dB  
F1.6  
1/100  
5600K  
Displays the current status of the power supply  
in use.  
Camera Information Display  
Memo :  
Display Off  
0
Even when the display screen is turned off and  
[LCD/VF] B [Display On/Off] B [Battery] is set to  
“Off”, this will be displayed when there is a  
warning.  
+35.483197  
+139.652172  
B
C
D
Resolution  
Displays the video image resolution.  
Frame Rate/Bit Rate  
GPS Display  
Displays the frame rate and bit rate in pairs.  
.
Operation Guide  
Memo :  
Displays a guide for the current operation  
buttons.  
0
Trimming information is displayed while  
trimming is in progress. In this case, pressing the  
[ONLINE/3] button does not switch the display.  
The information display area is not subject to the  
display settings of the items in [LCD/VF] B  
[Display On/Off].  
E
Audio Level Meter  
Displays the audio levels of CH1 and CH2.  
0
4030 20 10  
0
.
0
The display appears when the volume (0 to  
15) of the headphone or speaker changes.  
Display Screen in Media Mode 165  
 
I
K
Date/Time Display  
Time Code (I)/User’s Bit (J) Display  
0
Displays the date/time that is recorded on the  
currently played recording media.  
Displays the time code (hour: minute:  
second: frame) or user’s bit data recorded in  
the recording media being played back.  
Example of time code display:  
Memo :  
0
0
The date/time display style can be specified in  
[System] B [Date Style]/[Time Style].  
0 0 : 0 0 : 0 0 : 0 0  
*
.
*
Colon (:) denotes non-drop frames and dot  
(.) denotes drop frames.  
J
Network Connection Icon  
The network connection status is displayed.  
Icon  
Status  
0
Example of user’s bit display:  
Wireless LAN connection from the  
FF EE DD 20  
.
host terminal (USB) is established  
.
Memo :  
Wired LAN connection from the  
host terminal (USB) is established  
0
Use [LCD/VF] B [Display Type] B [TC/UB] to  
toggle between the time code display and user’s  
bit display.  
.
Cellular adapter connection from  
the host terminal (USB) is  
established  
When a USB adapter different  
from the connection settings is  
detected  
.
L
M
N
Check Mark  
Displayed when the currently played clip is  
selected.  
.
OK Mark  
Displayed when OK mark has been appended.  
Built-in wireless LAN connection is  
established  
.
A
Media Status  
LAN terminal connection is  
established  
PLAY  
STILL  
FWD *  
:
:
:
Playing  
Still picture playback mode  
High-speed playback in the  
forward direction (* playback  
speed: 5x, 15x, 60x, or 360x)  
High-speed playback in the  
reverse direction (* reverse  
playback speed: 5x, 15x, 60x, or  
360x)  
0
When an unusable USB  
adapter is detected  
When the LAN cable is not  
connected  
(No  
0
display)  
REV *  
:
Memo :  
0
The icon appears blinking when the camera  
recorder is starting up, and is displayed in yellow  
while getting ready to connect.  
STOP  
P.OFF  
:
:
Stop mode  
Power OFF  
O
P
Clip Information  
Displays current clip number/total number of  
clips.  
Media  
0
Displays the media slot of the currently  
played clip.  
0
z appears when the write-protect switch of  
the SD card is set.  
Q
Event/Warning Display Area  
Displays error messages.  
166 Display Screen in Media Mode  
Record Format Screen  
Status Screen  
For checking the settings of the camera recorder.  
For checking settings related to the recording  
format.  
USER Switch Set Screen  
For checking the status (functions assigned) of the  
user buttons.  
.
Audio Screen  
For checking the audio settings.  
.
Camera Screen  
For checking information related to shooting using  
the camera recorder.  
.
Video Screen  
For checking the settings related to video output.  
.
LCD/VF Screen  
For checking information related to the contents  
displayed on the LCD monitor and viewfinder  
screens.  
.
Planning Metadata Screen  
For checking the current planning metadata  
setting.  
.
.
Status Screen 167  
   
Network Screen  
For checking the network login information.  
.
Connection Setup Screen  
For checking the network connection information.  
.
Streaming Screen  
For viewing information related to live streaming.  
.
168 Status Screen  
Memo :  
Marker and Safety Zone  
Displays (Camera Mode  
Only)  
0
You can turn On/Off the safety zone and center  
mark displays using [LCD/VF] B [Marker  
Settings] B [Aspect Ratio], [Safety Zone], and  
[Center Mark].  
The marker and safety zone displays are useful in  
helping you determine the angle of view for the  
image according to the shooting purpose.  
The marker is displayed only in the Camera mode.  
Color Bar Output  
Displaying the Grid Marker  
Color bars can be output on this camera recorder.  
Memo :  
The audio test signals (1 kHz) can be output  
simultaneously with the color bar output.  
1
Set [LCD/VF] B [Marker Settings] B [Grid  
Marker] to “On”.  
A grid that divides the screen into 3x3 is  
displayed.  
0
To Output the Color Bar Using the Menu  
To output color bars, follow the setting procedure  
below.  
1
Set [Camera Function] B [Bars] to “On”.  
Color bars are output.  
.
To Output the Color Bar Using the User Button  
Memo :  
0
When [Grid Marker] is set to “On”, [Aspect  
Ratio], [Aspect Marker], and [Safety Zone] do  
not function.  
1
Assign the “Bars” function to any of the  
user buttons.  
0
Example of display when [Aspect Ratio] = “4:3”,  
[Aspect Marker] = “Line+Halftone”, and [Center  
Mark] = “On”  
2
Press the user button that is assigned with  
“Bars”.  
Color bars are output.  
Safety Zone  
Center Mark  
Aspect Marker  
.
Marker and Safety Zone Displays (Camera Mode Only) 169  
         
HLG and J-Log1 Gamma  
Adjusting the Gamma  
The gamma curve can be adjusted to various  
characteristics when Color Space is set to a value  
other than “HLG” and “J-Log1”.  
The gamma switches automatically to the  
respective “HLG Gamma” and “J-Log1 Gamma”  
when [Color Space] is set to “HLG” or “J-Log1”.  
The HLG Gamma becomes an ITU2100 HLG HDR  
gamma. Output signals above 100 IRE can be  
clipped by adjusting “White Clip”.  
The J-Log1 Gamma becomes a Log gamma with  
dynamic range of max 800%.  
Standard  
:
Standard gamma curve based on  
video standard.  
The adjustable level is 0.35 to 0.45  
to 0.55 in steps of 0.02.  
120  
100  
When the level is at 0.45, the  
gamma curve becomes one that  
conforms to the ITU709 standard.  
Sets to a cinema-like gamma  
curve.  
80  
J-Log1  
HLG  
60  
HLG  
Cinema 1  
Cinema 2  
:
:
STANDARD0.45  
+KNEE 95%  
J-Log1  
40  
ITU709+KNEE  
20  
0
The level can be adjusted  
extensively from -5 to 0 to +5.  
Sets to a gamma curve with soft  
expression giving priority to high  
luminance gradation.  
0
100  
200  
300  
400  
500  
600  
700  
800  
INPUT (%)  
.
The level can be adjusted  
extensively from -5 to 0 to +5.  
Gamma Variation  
The typical characteristics are shown in the  
following figure. The figure shows the  
characteristics when “Standard”, “Cinema 1” or  
“Cinema 2” is configured and [Knee Level] is set to  
“95%” for the “Standard” or “Cinema 1” graph.  
120  
Cinema1  
+5  
STANDARD  
0.45  
100  
Cinema2  
-5  
Cinema2  
+5  
80  
60  
STANDARD 0.45  
Cinema2  
0
Cinema2 NORMAL  
Cinema1  
0
Cinema2 -5  
Cinema2 +5  
Cinema1 NORMAL  
Cinema1 -5  
Cinema1  
-5  
Cinema1 +5  
40  
20  
0
0
100  
200  
SCEAN(%)  
300  
400  
.
170 Adjusting the Gamma  
 
3
Adjusting Color Matrix  
Adjust Saturation.  
0
0
0
Press the cross-shaped button (I) to move  
the cursor to Saturation.  
0
The color matrix of the camera recorder can be  
adjusted to a color of the user’s preference.  
When shooting is performed using multiple  
cameras, the colors of the different cameras can  
be adjusted, and a color of the user’s preference  
can be set on this camera recorder.  
Each of the colors changes in the direction  
indicated by the arrow on the vector scope.  
Pressing the cross-shaped button (J) moves  
the color outward from the center of the circle  
on the vector scope.  
0
0
Pressing the cross-shaped button (K) moves  
the color toward to the center of the circle on  
the vector scope.  
0
0
The Saturation and Hue of the three colors (red,  
green and blue) can be configured individually.  
Adjust the color on the vector scope and  
waveform monitor using the DSC color chart.  
Red  
R
Mg  
I
*
The adjusted values of “Natural”, “Standard”,  
“Cinema Vivid”, and “Cinema Subdued” in  
[Color Matrix] can be stored individually.  
Y
B
G
Cy  
1
2
Select [Camera Process] B [Color Matrix]/  
[Adjust].  
Blue  
R
Mg  
I
Y
Adjust Hue.  
B
0
Select the color using the cross-shaped  
button (JK) and confirm using the cross-  
shaped button (I). (The cursor moves to  
Hue.)  
G
Cy  
Green  
R
Mg  
I
0
0
Pressing the cross-shaped button (J)  
rotates the hue in the clockwise direction on  
the vector scope.  
Y
B
Pressing the cross-shaped button (K)  
rotates the hue in the anti-clockwise direction  
on the vector scope.  
G
Cy  
.
Red  
R
Mg  
I
Y
B
G
Cy  
Blue  
R
Mg  
I
Y
B
G
Cy  
Green  
R
Mg  
I
Y
B
G
Cy  
.
Adjusting Color Matrix 171  
   
Number of Storable Setup Files  
Configuring Setup Files  
Camera recorder  
SD slot A  
SD slot B  
:
:
:
[CAM1] to [CAM4]  
[ W 1 ] to [ W 8 ]  
[ Y 1 ] to [ Y 8 ]  
The menu settings can be stored on the camera  
recorder or an SD card by saving them as a setup  
file.  
Compatibility  
Loading a saved setup file enables you to  
reproduce the appropriate setup state speedily.  
The following types of setup files are available.  
o
User File/All File  
0
Only User File/All File of the GY-HC550 and  
GY-HC500 series can be loaded.  
When User File/All File saved using GY-  
HC550 are loaded using GY-HC500, the  
functions that only exist on GY-HC550 are  
ignored.  
o
Picture File:  
File that contains image creation settings in  
accordance to the shooting conditions ([Camera  
Process] menu items).  
0
o
o
All File:  
o
Picture File  
File that contains all menu settings, ranging from  
video format settings to image creation settings  
such as device settings and shooting  
conditions, as well as the contents of the  
[Favorites Menu]. Settings in Network Settings  
are not saved.  
Only Picture File of the GY-HC550 and GY-  
HC500 series can be loaded.  
User File:  
File that contains settings from All File that are  
not included in the [Camera Process] menu  
items.  
Memo :  
0
Make use of the [Setup File] menu to save or  
load a setup file.  
0
The following operations can be performed on  
the [Setup File] menu.  
0
0
0
0
Even when [Record Format] B [System] is  
configured to “4K EXT (SSD)”, setup files will be  
saved to this camera recorder or the SD card.  
172 Configuring Setup Files  
 
Saving Setup Files  
6
Select [Store] and press the Set button (R).  
1
Display the [Setup File] menu.  
Select [System] B [Setup File] and press the  
Set button (R).  
2
3
Select [Store File] and press the Set button  
5
(R).  
Select [Picture File], [User File] or [All File],  
and press the Set button (R).  
6
The existing files are displayed.  
.
4
Select the file to be newly saved (or  
overwritten) using the cross-shaped  
button (JK), and press the Set button (R).  
7
Save the file.  
0
A confirmation screen appears when you  
choose to overwrite.  
Select [Overwrite] on the confirmation  
screen, and press the Set button (R). Saving  
starts, andStoring...” appears on the screen.  
4
Overwrite Picture File?  
Overwrite  
.
7
Cancel  
Memo :  
0
Files cannot be written in the following cases.  
(Displayed in gray, selection disabled)  
0
Load Picture File  
When the inserted SD card is not supported or  
.
not formatted. (File name appears as “---”.)  
0
Saving starts, and “Storing...” appears on the  
screen when the file is newly saved.  
0
When a write-protected SD card is inserted  
(a z mark appears beside the SD card icon).  
5
Name the file.  
0
Enter the subname using the software  
keyboard.  
0
You can enter up to 8 characters for the  
[Store File]/[Picture File] subname.  
Memo :  
0
When overwriting an existing file, the subname  
of the existing file is displayed.  
.
0
Select [Cancel] and press the Set button (R), or  
press the [CANCEL] button to return to the  
previous screen.  
8
Saving is complete.  
After saving of the file is complete, “Complete”  
appears on the screen, and the menu screen  
closes automatically.  
Configuring Setup Files 173  
   
Loading a Setup File  
Deleting Setup Files  
1
1
Display the [Setup File] menu.  
Select [System] B [Setup File] and press the  
Set button (R).  
Display the [Setup File] menu.  
Select [System] B [Setup File] and press the  
Set button (R).  
2
3
2
3
Select [Load File] and press the Set button  
Select [Delete File] and press the Set button  
(R).  
(R).  
Select [Picture File], [User File] or [All File],  
Select [Picture File], [User File] or [All File],  
and press the Set button (R).  
and press the Set button (R).  
The existing files are displayed.  
The existing files are displayed.  
4
4
Select the file to load using the cross-  
shaped button (JK), and press the Set  
button (R).  
Select the file to delete using the cross-  
shaped button (JK), and press the Set  
button (R).  
Delete Picture File  
4
CAM1  
CAM2  
4
.
.
Memo :  
0
When the write-protect switch of the inserted SD  
card is set, a z mark appears beside the SD  
card icon. Setup files can be loaded from an SD  
card even if the write-protect switch is set.  
Setup files that are completely incompatible will  
not be displayed.  
Memo :  
0
Setup File saved on the SD card cannot be  
deleted.  
0
5
Select [Delete] on the confirmation screen,  
and press the Set button (R).  
Deletion starts, and “Deleting...” appears on the  
screen.  
5
Select [Load] on the confirmation screen,  
and press the Set button (R).  
Loading starts, and “Loading...” appears on the  
screen.  
Delete Picture File?  
CAM1 :SUNSET  
Delete  
5
Cancel  
5
.
6
Deletion is complete.  
After file deletion is complete, “Complete”  
appears on the screen.  
.
6
Reading is complete.  
After reading of the file is complete, “Complete”  
appears on the screen, and the menu screen  
closes automatically.  
174 Configuring Setup Files  
   
Connecting External  
Monitor  
0
To output live or playback video images and  
audio sound to an external monitor, select the  
output signals from the camera recorder, and  
connect using an appropriate cable according to  
the monitor to be used.  
0
0
Choose the most suitable terminal according to  
the monitor in use.  
[SDI OUT] terminal:  
Outputs either the 3G-SDI/HD-SDI signal or SD-  
SDI signal.  
0
[HDMI] terminal:  
Outputs HDMI signals.  
Memo :  
0
If the [SDI OUT] terminal or [HDMI] terminal is  
connected, configure the settings in the [A/V  
Set] menu according to the monitor to be  
connected.  
SDI IN  
HDMI  
0
To connect the output signal in the 4K(2160p)  
setting, use a Premium High Speed HDMI cable  
(supports 18Gbps).  
.
*
When connecting in the 4K(2160p) 59.94p or  
50p setting, it is recommended that the cable  
used does not exceed 2 m.  
Select the output signal in [A/V Set] B [SDI  
OUT]/[HDMI OUT].  
*
*
When [Record Format]  
B
[System] is set to “SD”,  
only SD-SDI signals are output.  
To display the menu screen or display screen on  
the external monitor, set [A/V Set] B [Video  
Set] B [SDI OUT] B [Character] to “On”.  
Connecting via SDI  
0
Digital video signals, together with embedded  
(superimposed) audio signals and time code  
signals, are output for both the 3G-SDI/HD-SDI  
and SD-SDI signals.  
Memo :  
0
The sampling frequency for embedded  
(superimposed) audio signals is 48 kHz. Time  
code of the built-in time generator as well as  
playback time code are also output.  
Connecting External Monitor 175  
     
Connect the headphone.  
Connecting Wired Remote  
Control  
0
Audio output from the [x] terminal can be  
selected using the [A/V Set] B [Monitor] item or  
the [MONITOR] selection switch on the camera  
recorder.  
You can operate the functions of this unit with a  
wired remote control.  
Memo :  
0
When the switches of the camera recorder and  
remote control unit are operated at the same  
time, the switch operation of the remote control  
unit takes priority over that of the camera  
recorder.  
0
The different combinations of settings that are  
output from the [x] terminal and monitor  
speaker are as follows.  
[x]  
[MONITOR]  
Selection  
[Monitor]  
Setting  
Terminal  
Speaker *  
CH1  
Switch Setting  
[CH1]  
L
R
1
Connect a wired remote control to the  
camera recorder.  
-
[Mix]  
[Stereo]  
-
CH1  
[BOTH]  
CH1+CH2 CH1+CH2  
CH1 CH2  
Connect the wired remote control (sold  
separately) to the [REMOTE] terminal of this  
camera recorder.  
[CH2]  
CH2  
CH2  
*
Audio is output from the speaker only in Media  
mode. Does not output in the Camera mode.  
Connect the wired  
remote control  
REMOTE  
.
Caution :  
0
Turn off the power of the camera recorder when  
connecting a wired remote control.  
2
Turn on the power of the camera recorder.  
.
Memo :  
0
If both CH1 and CH2 are set to built-in  
microphone and the [MONITOR] selection  
switch has been set to “BOTH”, stereo sound is  
output from the [x] terminal regardless of the  
[Monitor] setting.  
176 Connect the headphone.  
   
List of Functions  
Importing Metadata  
Functions of Network  
Connection  
The network feature comprises web-browser-  
based functions using devices such as a  
smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC, as well as FTP  
and live streaming functions that run via thumbnail  
screens and menu operation.  
You can download a metadata settings file (XML  
format) from the FTP server and store metadata in  
the camera recorder.  
Uploading Recorded Clips  
Memo :  
Clips recorded to a recording media can be  
uploaded to a preconfigured FTP server.  
0
When [System] B [Record Set] B [Record  
Format] B [System] is set to “High-Speed”, only  
“Planning Metadata” can be used for the [LAN]  
terminal connection.  
Memo :  
0
Uploading can also be performed via a web  
browser.  
Connecting to the Network  
0
0
0
[LAN] Terminal  
Built-in Wireless LAN A  
Connect the following adapters to the [HOST]  
terminal (USB)  
Editing Metadata  
0
Planning Metadata  
You can access the page for editing the camera  
recorder’s metadata via a web browser on  
devices such as a smartphone, tablet terminal,  
or PC, and edit the metadata that is to be applied  
to clips to be recorded.  
0
Wireless LAN adapter  
0
Ethernet adapter  
0
Cellular adapter  
Clip Metadata  
0
You can access the page for editing the  
metadata via a web browser on devices such as  
a smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC, and  
display or rewrite the metadata that is recorded  
to a clip.  
View Remote  
You can access via a web browser on devices such  
as a smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC to check  
the live image or remotely control the camera.  
Memo :  
0
This feature is available when [System] is  
configured to “HD” or “SD”.  
Camera Control  
You can access via a web browser on devices such  
as a smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC to remotely  
control the camera.  
Functions of Network Connection 177  
   
Live streaming  
Preparing Network  
Connection  
By combining with the decoder or PC application  
that supports live streaming, you can perform audio  
and video streaming via the network.  
Operating Environment  
Memo :  
Operation has been verified for the following  
0
This feature is available when [System] is  
configured to “HD” or “SD”.  
environments.  
Computer  
0
0
0
OS: Windows 7  
Web browser: Internet Explorer 11  
OS: Windows 10  
Broadcast Overlay A L  
Web browser: Chrome  
OS: macOS 10.14  
Texts, images and watermark can be overlaid onto  
recorded video and live stream video. In addition,  
changes such as changing the image are possible  
with the SDP Generator app.  
Web browser: Safari 12  
Smartphone/Tablet Terminal  
0
0
OS: iOS11 (iPhone X/iPad Pro)  
Web browser: Safari 11  
OS: Android 8  
Scoreboard Overlay L  
Web browser: Chrome  
A scoreboard can be overlaid onto a recorded or  
live streaming video. In addition, changes such as  
changing the image are possible with the “SDP  
Generator” app.  
Camera Setup for Network Connection  
1
Connect using the corresponding method  
of connection  
Sports Coaching L  
0
This camera recorder supports the tagging feature,  
which enables information such as the camera  
angle and actions of an athlete to be recorded in  
real time as metadata during sports photography  
or videography.  
[LAN] Terminal  
Connect a PC to this camera recorder directly  
using a cross-over cable or via devices such  
as an Ethernet hub using a LAN cable.  
0
0
Built-in Wireless LAN A  
Attach the wireless LAN antenna if it is not  
mounted.  
Connect the following adapters to the  
[HOST] terminal (USB)  
0
Wireless LAN adapter  
0
Ethernet adapter  
0
Cellular adapter  
Memo :  
0
Only a network connection adapter can be  
connected to the [HOST] terminal (USB).  
Connect or disconnect an adapter only after you  
have turned off the power of the camera  
recorder.  
0
0
0
You can find the latest information on the  
compatible adapters at the product page of our  
website.  
Two types of network coverage (WAN and LAN)  
are available for each application.  
178 Functions of Network Connection  
       
o
Connecting to the  
Network  
WirelessLANconnection(“InternalWireless  
LAN”A or “USB”-“Wireless LAN”)  
When “Connect with Access Point” or “P2P”-  
“WPS” is selected on the [Select Connection  
Type] screen.  
0
1
Select the interface in the [Wizard].  
Configure the settings as follows according to  
the screen.  
0
Select “LAN”, “USB” or “Internal Wireless  
LAN”A in [Network] B [Connection  
Setup] B [Wizard].  
0
Mode of connection  
0
Configuration method  
0
When “USB” is selected, the adapter that is  
connected to the [HOST] terminal (USB) is  
recognized and displayed.  
.
0
When “P2P”-“Manual” is selected on the  
[Select Connection Type] screen.  
Configure the settings as follows according to  
the screen.  
.
2
Configure the settings according to the  
selected interface.  
0
Mode of connection  
0
o
Wired LAN connection (“LAN” or “USB”-  
Configuration method  
“Ethernet”)  
Configure the settings as follows according to  
the screen.  
0
IP address setting (DHCP or manual)  
0
IP Address  
0
Subnet mask  
0
Default gateway  
0
DNS Server  
Memo :  
0
When an address is manually assigned in a NAT  
environment, it is also necessary to set the  
default gateway correctly besides conversion of  
the address at the router’s end in order to  
perform operations such as access to the  
Internet from an external network via the router.  
.
*
For “P2P”-“Manual” connections, it is necessary  
to configure the [Passphrase] according to the  
steps below after the above settings are  
configured.  
A
Set the camera recorder to the Camera  
mode, and display [Connection Setup]  
(status screen).  
0
Press the [STATUS] button on the  
camera recorder to display the status  
screen.  
Press the cross-shaped button (H I) to  
display [Connection Setup].  
Check to ensure that the [SSID] and  
[Passphrase] that you have set in the  
wizard are displayed.  
0
Connecting to the Network 179  
     
Importing Metadata  
B
Select [SSID] from the list of access points  
(smartphone, tablet terminal, PC, etc.),  
and enter [Passphrase].  
You can download a metadata settings file (XML  
format) from the FTP server and store metadata in  
the camera recorder.  
0
Display the list of access points in the  
wireless connection settings of the  
smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC, and  
select “HC550-****”A and [HC500-  
****]B. (**** are numbers that vary with  
the device used.)  
The imported metadata is applied to clips to be  
recorded.  
Preparing Metadata  
0
You can record the four metadata types below.  
0
After the password confirmation screen  
appears, enter the [Passphrase]  
displayed on the [Connection Setup]  
screen.  
Title1  
:
ASCII only, max. 63 characters  
(bytes)  
Title2  
:
:
:
UNICODE, max. 127 bytes  
UNICODE, max. 127 bytes  
UNICODE, max. 2047 bytes  
Creator  
Description  
0
0
Metadata makes use of the XML description  
format.  
Edit the  
<Title1><Title2><Description><Creator> tag  
element using the XML editor. (Indicated by the  
frames below)  
<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>  
<NRT-MetaInterface lastUpdate="2015-01-29T18:06:21+09:00"  
xmlns="urn:schemas-proHD:nonRealTimeMetaInterface:ver.1.00"  
xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance">  
<MetaData>  
<Title1>Title1 sample</Title1>  
<!-- only "en",max63bytes -->  
<Title2>Title2 sample</Title2>  
<!-- ,max127bytes -->  
<Description>Description sample</Description>  
<!-- ,max2047bytes -->  
<Creator>Creator sample</Creator>  
<!-- ,max127bytes -->  
.
o
Cellular adapter connection (“USB”-  
“Cellular”)  
Configure the settings as follows according to  
the screen.  
0
Connection phone number  
0
Username  
0
Password  
Caution :  
</MetaData>  
</NRT-MetaInterface>  
0
You can access the web functions via a web  
browser on devices such as a smartphone,  
tablet terminal, or PC only in a LAN environment.  
Note that you may have to pay very high bills in  
the case of pay-per-use contracts. Fixed price  
contract is recommended if you are using the  
network function.  
.
0
0
0
0
Note that the use of improper settings may result  
in expensive bills from the phone service  
provider. Make sure that the setting is correct.  
To avoid expensive bills due to the roaming  
connection, you are recommended to use this  
function by disabling the roaming contract.  
There may be communication even when you  
are not using the network function. Remove the  
cellular adapter when the function is not in use.  
3
Setting is complete.  
After setting is complete, you can access the  
camera recorder via a web browser.  
180 Connecting to the Network  
       
Configuring the Server for Downloading  
Importing Metadata  
For specifying the settings for connecting to the  
FTP server for downloading the metadata (domain  
name, user name, password, etc.) as well as the  
path of the file to download.  
Download the metadata settings file (XML format)  
from the FTP server.  
1
Select [Network] B [Import Metadata] and  
press the Set button (R).  
1
Open the [Metadata Server] screen.  
Open the [Network] B [Metadata Server]  
screen.  
The [Import Metadata] screen appears.  
Import Metadata  
Metadata Server  
Meta-FTP1...  
Meta-FTP2...  
Meta-FTP3...  
Meta-FTP4...  
.
2
Select the server for importing the  
metadata.  
.
0
The name that is registered in [Metadata  
Server] B [Alias] is displayed.  
2
Register the [Metadata Server].  
0
Select a server using the cross-shaped  
button (JK), and press the Set button (R).  
The server settings screen appears. Perform  
setting for each item.  
0
Select a server using the cross-shaped  
button (JK), and press the Set button (R).  
Import Metadata  
0
Up to 4 settings can be registered.  
2
Metadata Server Set  
Alias  
Protocol  
Server  
Port  
File Path  
Username  
.
.
Memo :  
0
For details on the registered information, please  
consult the network administrator for the server.  
Importing Metadata 181  
 
3
Select [Import] on the confirmation screen,  
and press the Set button (R).  
Import starts.  
Uploading a Recorded  
Video Clip  
After import is complete, the display is restored  
to the screen before the [Import Metadata]  
screen appears.  
The following are steps to upload clips recorded in  
a recording media to a preset FTP server.  
Configuring the FTP Server for  
Uploading  
For specifying the settings for connecting to the  
FTP server to upload recorded clips to (domain  
name, user name, password, etc.) as well as the  
directory of the upload destination.  
Import Metadata?  
Import  
Cancel  
3
1
Open the [Clip Server] screen.  
Open the [Network] B [Upload Settings] B [Clip  
Server] screen.  
Clip Server  
Importing...  
.
Memo :  
0
You cannot exit the menu or perform recording  
.
while import is in progress.  
2
Register the [Clip Server].  
0
If import of the metadata failed, “Import Error!” is  
displayed, and a message indicating the cause  
of the error appears.  
Register the server to upload recorded clips in  
the recording media to.  
Up to 4 servers can be registered.  
Press the Set button (R) to return to the [Import  
Memo :  
Metadata] screen in step 1.  
0
For details on the registered information, please  
When “HTTP” is selected in the [Select FTP  
Proxy] screen of the network connection setting,  
connections to the servers other than “FTP”  
protocol cannot be made.  
consult the network administrator for the server.  
0
0
If a setting other than “FTP” is specified for  
[Protocol], to ensure the safety of the  
communication path, a screen appears  
prompting you to validate the fingerprint of the  
public key and certificate received from the  
server.  
Check to ensure that the displayed value  
coincides with the known value.  
182 Importing Metadata  
     
Uploading Clips Automatically (Auto  
FTP)  
The following are steps to automatically upload  
clips recorded in a recording media to a preset FTP  
server.  
Uploading Clips Manually (Manual FTP)  
The following are steps to upload clips recorded in  
a recording media to a preset FTP server.  
All playable clips on the thumbnail screen can be  
uploaded.  
1
Configure the FTP server for manual  
uploading  
1
Configure the settings for automatic  
upload  
Set [Network] B [Upload Settings] B [Upload]  
to “Manual”.  
Configure [Network] B [Upload Settings] B  
[Upload] to “Auto” and configure the settings for  
each of [Slot], [Cellular] and [Server].  
Register the [Clip Server].  
2
0
Open the [Network] B [Upload Settings] B  
[Clip Server] screen.  
0
Register the server to upload recorded clips  
in the recording media to.  
Up to 4 servers can be registered.  
Memo :  
0
For details on the registered information, please  
consult the network administrator for the server.  
When [Network] B [Upload Settings] B [Upload]  
is configured to “Auto”, manual uploading is also  
disabled for slots other than the selected “Slot”.  
To perform manual uploading, select “Manual”.  
FTP transfer is disabled when [System] B  
[Record Set] B [Record Format] B [System] is  
configured to “High-Speed”. To perform FTP  
transfer, select a setting other than “High-  
Speed”.  
0
.
2
Start uploading  
0
Configuring [Network] B [Upload Settings] B  
[Auto Upload] to “On” starts uploading.  
You can also press the user button that is  
assigned with “Auto Upload”.  
0
0
Memo :  
0
FTP transfer is performed for the slot configured  
in [Slot].  
0
If recording is started for the same slot as the  
one configured in [Slot] while FTP transfer is in  
progress, FTP transfer will be interrupted.  
FTP transfer is not performed while live  
streaming or Return over IP is in progress.  
FTP transfer is disabled when [System] B  
[Record Set] B [Record Format] B [System] is  
configured to “High-Speed”. To perform FTP  
transfer, select a setting other than “High-  
Speed”.  
Uploading a Video Clip  
1
Set the camera recorder to the Media mode.  
0
0
0
Press and hold the [MODE] selection button  
in the Camera mode to enter the Media  
mode. A thumbnail screen of the clips  
recorded on the recording media is  
displayed.  
0
You can upload the selected clips on the  
thumbnail screen to the FTP server.  
Uploading a Recorded Video Clip 183  
 
2
5
Move the cursor to the clip to be uploaded.  
Move the cursor to the clip to be uploaded using  
the cross-shaped button (JKH I).  
Upload is complete.  
0
After upload is complete, “Successfully  
Completed.” appears on the screen.  
Press the Set button (R) to return to the  
thumbnail screen.  
0
2
FTP Upload  
Successfully Completed.  
.
Exit  
3
5
Press the [ONLINE/3] button.  
The action selection screen is displayed.  
.
Selecting and Uploading Multiple Clips  
To select and upload multiple clips, refer to  
This Clip  
Selected Clips  
All Clips  
3
Uploading All Video Clips  
1
Press the [ONLINE/3] button.  
.
The action selection screen is displayed.  
4
Select [FTP Upload] B [This Clip] B server  
to upload to, and press the Set button (R).  
The status of the transfer process is indicated  
by a progress bar.  
2
Upload the clips.  
Select [FTP Upload...] B [All Clips] B server to  
upload to, and press the Set button (R).  
FTP Upload  
This Clip  
Selected Clips  
All Clips  
Stop  
2
Upload in Background  
.
.
3
Upload starts.  
Memo :  
The status of the transfer process is indicated  
by a progress bar.  
0
The name for the server to upload files to are  
indicated using the preset names in [Clip  
Server] B [Alias].  
FTP Upload  
0
To stop uploading, press the Set button (R).  
Select [Yes] on the confirmation screen, and  
press the Set button (R) to stop uploading and  
return to the thumbnail screen.  
Stop  
Upload in Background  
.
184 Uploading a Recorded Video Clip  
4
Upload is complete.  
Memo :  
0
After all clips are uploaded successfully,  
“Successfully Completed.” is displayed.  
Press the Set button (R) to return to the  
thumbnail screen.  
0
To stop uploading, press the Set button (R).  
Select [Yes] on the confirmation screen, and  
press the Set button (R) to stop uploading and  
return to the thumbnail screen.  
0
When clips are not uploaded successfully,  
the following errors are displayed.  
0
0
If the file to be uploaded has the same name as  
an existing file in the FTP server, an overwrite  
confirmation window appears.  
FTP Upload  
When “HTTP” is selected in the [Select FTP  
Proxy] screen of the network connection setting,  
the overwrite confirmation window will not be  
displayed and the existing file is overwritten.  
Even after upload has started (FTP transfer in  
progress) in step 3, pressing the [MODE] button  
switches the camera recorder to the Camera  
mode, allowing you to start shooting.  
If a setting other than “FTP” is specified for  
[Protocol], to ensure the safety of the  
communication path, a screen appears  
prompting you to validate the fingerprint of the  
public key and certificate received from the  
server.  
Failed.  
Internal Error.  
Exit  
Cause of  
Error  
0
0
.
Memo :  
0
If a notification such as a an error message  
appears after shifting to the Camera mode while  
FTP transfer is in progress, a 5 icon (yellow) will  
appear in the media’s remaining level display  
area in the Camera mode.  
Check to ensure that the displayed value  
coincides with the known value.  
You can press the [MODE] button to switch to  
the Media mode and display the above error  
screen.  
0
Fingerprint is a unique value that varies with  
each public key and certificate.  
0
For details of the fingerprint, please consult  
to clear the error message.  
the administrator of the server to be  
connected.  
0
When “HTTP” is selected in the [Select FTP  
Proxy] screen of the network connection setting,  
connections to the servers other than “FTP”  
protocol cannot be made.  
Uploading a Recorded Video Clip 185  
FTP Resume Feature  
Connecting from a Web  
Browser  
When FTP transfer starts and there is a file of the  
same name on the server with a file size smaller  
than the file to be transferred, the file on the server  
will be regarded as an interrupted file during a FTP  
transfer. A confirmation screen to resume transfer  
(append writing) appears.  
You can access the web functions of this camera  
recorder via a web browser on devices such as a  
smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC.  
Make the necessary preparations for connection in  
advance.  
1
2
Set the camera recorder to the Camera  
mode, and display [Connection Setup]  
(status screen).  
0
Press the [STATUS] button on the camera  
recorder to display the status screen. Press  
the cross-shaped button (HI) to display the  
[Connection Setup] screen.  
0
.
Check the displayed [IP Address].  
If “Resume” is selected, FTP transfer is carried out  
Start up the web browser on the terminal  
you wish to connect to the camera  
recorder, and enter the [IP Address] in the  
address field.  
such that it appends from the position where it was  
interrupted.  
When FTP transfer ends normally, “Complete”  
appears on the screen.  
(Example: 192.168.0.10)  
Memo :  
If “192.168.0.10” is displayed in [IP Address],  
enter “http://192.168.0.10”.  
0
FTP server equipped with resume function is  
required.  
0
0
If [Network] B [Upload Settings] B [Clip  
Server] B [Clip-FTP1/2/3/4] B [Protocol] is set  
to “SFTP”, the resume function is disabled.  
If “HTTP” is selected in the [Select FTP Proxy]  
screen of the network connection setting, the  
resume function is disabled.  
http://192.168.0.10  
.
3
Enter the user name and password.  
Enter the user name and the password on the  
login screen to display the main page of the  
camera.  
0
Check the [Web Username] and [Web  
Password] in the [Network] screen (status  
screen).  
Memo :  
0
The user name and password can be changed  
in [Network] B [Web] B [Username] and  
[Password].  
186 FTP Resume Feature  
   
3
A
B
Editing Metadata  
You can create the metadata to be inserted into a  
recorded file, or rewrite the metadata of a recorded  
clip.  
Edit the metadata.  
Enter information for the necessary fields.  
After input is complete, tap (click) [Save] to  
overwrite the metadata.  
Planning Metadata  
You can access the page for editing the camera  
recorder’s metadata via a web browser on devices  
such as a smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC, and  
edit the metadata that is to be applied to clips to be  
recorded.  
A
1
Access the main page of the camera.  
Access the page via a web browser on devices  
such as a smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC.  
B
.
4
Tap (click) [OK] on the confirmation screen.  
0
0
2
Update of the [Planning Metadata] starts.  
After update is complete, “Renewal of  
planning metadata is succeeded.” is  
displayed. Tap (click) [OK].  
Tap (click) the [Planning Metadata] tab to  
open the [Planning Metadata] screen.  
2
0
Returns to the screen in step 3.  
Renewal of planning metadata is  
succeeded.  
OK  
4
.
Memo :  
0
If update failed, “Renewal of planning metadata  
is failed.” is displayed.  
Tap (click) [Close] to return to the screen of step  
3.  
.
Editing Metadata 187  
       
Clip Metadata  
o
Switching from a web browser  
You can access the page for editing the metadata  
A
You will see a message indicating “It is  
necessary to change the camera mode to  
"Remote Edit Mode". Change the mode.”  
on the web browser.  
via a web browser on devices such as a  
smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC, and display or  
rewrite the metadata that is recorded to a clip.  
1
Access the main page of the camera.  
Access the page via a web browser on devices  
such as a smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC.  
It is necessary to change the camera  
mode to "Remote Edit Mode".  
Change the mode.  
A
2
Display the clip list.  
Tap (click) the [Clip List] tab to display the clip  
list.  
Cancel  
Change  
B
.
B
Tap (click) [Change] to switch the camera  
to the Remote Edit mode.  
2
Remote Edit Mode  
Exit  
.
o
Switching from the camera  
A
“Change to Remote Edit Mode?” is  
displayed on the display screen of the  
camera unit.  
Select [Change] and press the Set button  
(R) to switch to the Remote Edit mode.  
B
.
3
Set the camera recorder to the “Remote  
Edit Mode”.  
Change to  
A
B
You can switch to “Remote Edit Mode” from a  
web browser or through operation of the  
camera.  
Remote Edit Mode?  
Change  
Cancel  
Remote Edit Mode  
Exit  
.
188 Editing Metadata  
   
6
A
Edit the metadata of the selected clips.  
Edit the information for the necessary fields.  
Memo :  
0
0
0
0
When the menu or status is displayed, display  
of the confirmation screen will be put on hold.  
If the menu is displayed on the camera recorder,  
close the menu.  
0
If you are using a PC, input using the mouse  
and keyboard.  
0
If you are using a smartphone or tablet  
terminal, tap the text input area to display a  
standard software keyboard on the screen.  
Enter the information using the displayed  
keyboard.  
If the status is displayed on the camera recorder,  
close the status display.  
Pressing the Set button (R) on the camera  
recorder while in the Remote Edit Mode ends  
the Remote Edit Mode forcibly and switches to  
the Camera mode.  
B
C
You can tap (click) [OK Mark] to add an OK mark  
to or delete it from selected clips.  
After editing is complete, tap (click) [Save] to  
overwrite the metadata.  
0
When FTP upload via the camera unit is  
currently in progress, switching to the Remote  
Edit mode is disabled.  
4
Select the Metadata Edit mode.  
A B  
Select the [Metadata] tab.  
5
Select the clip to rewrite the metadata.  
0
A list of the recorded clips appears on the  
[Clip List] screen.  
0
Tap (click) the clip for which you want to  
rewrite the metadata.  
4
C
.
5
.
Memo :  
0
You can switch the displayed slot using the [Slot  
A] and [Slot B] tabs. The [Slot EXT] tab appears  
when [System] is configured to “4K EXT (SSD)”.  
You can use the [J-30] or [K+30] tab to jump to  
the previous or next 30 clips on the list.  
0
Editing Metadata 189  
7
Tap (click) [OK] on the confirmation screen.  
Uploading a Recording  
Clip via a Web Browser  
0
0
Update of the metadata starts.  
After update is complete, “Renewal of clip  
metadata is succeeded.” is displayed. Tap  
(click) [OK].  
0
The following are steps to upload clips recorded  
in a recording media to a preset FTP server.  
You can upload selected clips, all clips, or those  
appended with an OK mark.  
0
Returns to the screen in step 4.  
0
Renewal of clip metadata is  
succeeded.  
Configuring the FTP Server for  
Uploading  
OK  
Uploading Video Clips  
7
1
2
Access the main page of the camera.  
Access the page via a web browser on devices  
such as a smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC.  
.
Memo :  
0
If update failed, “Renewal of clip metadata is  
failed.” is displayed.  
Display the clip list.  
Tap (click) [Close] to return to the screen of step  
Tap (click) the [Clip List] tab to display the clip  
list.  
4.  
2
.
3
Set the camera recorder to the “Remote  
Edit Mode”.  
You can switch to “Remote Edit Mode” from a  
web browser or through operation of the  
camera.  
190 Editing Metadata  
 
o
Switching from a web browser  
Memo :  
A
You will see a message indicating “It is  
0
When the menu or status is displayed,  
display of the confirmation screen will  
be put on hold.  
necessary to change the camera mode  
to "Remote Edit Mode". Change the  
mode.” on the web browser.  
0
0
0
If the menu is displayed on the camera  
recorder, close the menu.  
If the status is displayed on the camera  
recorder, close the status display.  
Pressing the Set button (R) on the  
camera recorder while in the Remote  
Edit Mode ends the Remote Edit Mode  
forcibly and switches to the Camera  
mode.  
It is necessary to change the camera  
mode to "Remote Edit Mode".  
Change the mode.  
A
Cancel  
Change  
B
.
0
When FTP upload via the camera unit  
is currently in progress, switching to the  
Remote Edit mode is disabled.  
B
Tap (click) [Change] to switch the  
camera to the Remote Edit mode.  
4
5
Select the Upload mode.  
Select the [Upload] tab.  
Select the clip you want to upload.  
Remote Edit Mode  
Exit  
0
0
0
A list of the recorded clips appears on the  
[Clip List] screen.  
Tap (click) the clip you want to upload to  
select it.  
.
o
Switching from the camera  
Clips being selected are indicated by a check  
mark.  
A
“Change to Remote Edit Mode?” is  
displayed on the display screen of the  
Memo :  
0
camera unit.  
You can switch the displayed slot using the [Slot  
A] and [Slot B] tabs. The [Slot EXT] tab appears  
when [System] is configured to “4K EXT (SSD)”.  
You can use the [J-30] or [K+30] tab to jump to  
the previous or next 30 clips on the list.  
B
Select [Change] and press the Set button  
(R) to switch to the Remote Edit mode.  
0
Change to  
6
A
Select the upload operation.  
Remote Edit Mode?  
Tap (click) the [Actions] button.  
Change  
Cancel  
B
4
6
5
Remote Edit Mode  
Exit  
.
.
Uploading a Recording Clip via a Web Browser 191  
7
8
Select a method to upload the clips.  
Select the clip server and start uploading.  
0
Upon selecting the server to upoload clips to,  
an upload screen appears.  
A
B
C
D
8
.
A
Upload all clips  
.
Uploads all the clips in the displayed slots.  
Tap (click) to move to the [Clip Server]  
screen.  
0
The status of the transfer process is indicated  
by a progress bar.  
B
Upload OK clips  
Uploads all clips in the displayed slots that  
are appended with an OK mark.  
Tap (click) to move to the [Clip Server]  
screen.  
C
Upload selected clips  
Uploads the clips you have selected.  
Tap (click) to move to the [Clip Server]  
screen.  
D
Clear all selection  
Clears all clip selection and returns to the  
[Clip List] screen.  
.
192 Uploading a Recording Clip via a Web Browser  
9
Upload is complete.  
Memo :  
0
After upload is complete, “Successfully  
Completed.” appears on the screen.  
0
To stop transfer, tap (click) the [Stop] button.  
Tapping (clicking) [Yes] on the confirmation  
screen stops the transfer halfway and brings you  
back to the main page.  
FTP Upload  
0
If there already exists a file on the FTP server  
with a name identical to the file to be transferred,  
a confirmation screen asking to overwrite the file  
will appear.  
Successfully Completed.  
However, if “HTTP” is selected in the [Select  
FTP Proxy] screen of the network connection  
settings, an overwrite confirmation screen does  
not appear, and the existing file will be  
overwritten directly.  
After uploading in step 8 has started, other web  
browser operations are disabled until uploading  
is complete.  
Exit  
9
.
0
When clips are not uploaded successfully,  
the following errors are displayed.  
0
0
FTP Upload  
After uploading in step 8 has started and upon  
shifting to the Media mode by pressing the  
[[MODE] selection button, operation from the  
web browser will be disabled.  
Failed.  
Internal Error.  
Exit  
Cause of  
Error  
To enable web browser operation, press the  
[[MODE] selection button again to switch to the  
Camera mode.  
.
0
If a setting other than “FTP” is specified for  
[Protocol], to ensure the safety of the  
communication path, a screen appears  
prompting you to validate the fingerprint of the  
public key and certificate received from the  
server.  
Memo :  
0
to clear the error message.  
Check to ensure that the displayed value  
coincides with the known value.  
0
Fingerprint is a unique value that varies with  
each public key and certificate.  
0
For details of the fingerprint, please consult  
the administrator of the server to be  
connected.  
0
When “HTTP” is selected in the [Select FTP  
Proxy] screen of the network connection setting,  
connections to the servers other than “FTP”  
protocol cannot be made.  
Uploading a Recording Clip via a Web Browser 193  
A
B
Page Switch Tab  
View Remote Feature  
Tap (click) this tab to move to the [Planning  
Metadata], [Clip Metadata], or [Settings]  
screen.  
You can access via a web browser on devices such  
as a smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC to check  
the live image and perform the following remote  
control operations.  
Live View Screen  
Displays the live images.  
Tap a live image to display or hide information  
that is displayed on the live image, such as  
remaining space on the media and time code.  
0
0
0
Start/stop recording  
Zooming  
Register/delete preset zoom  
C
[Clear] Button  
1
Access the main page of the camera.  
Access the page via a web browser on devices  
such as a smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC.  
Switches to the Delete Preset Zoom Position  
mode.  
2
Tap (click) the [View Remote] tab to open  
the [View Remote] screen.  
D
E
[Preset] Button  
Switches to the Register Preset Zoom Position  
mode.  
2
Zoom Control  
0
0
0
Operate the zoom function by dragging the  
zoom button along the sliding bar.  
Tap (click) the [Wide] or [Tele] button to fine-  
tune the zoom position.  
The slide changes according to the dynamic  
zoom.  
Dynamic Zoom Off:  
.
Dynamic Zoom On:  
.
.
F
G
H
Start Record Button  
Stop Record Button  
Operating Procedure  
[A]/[B]/[C] Buttons  
A
Use these buttons to perform preset registration  
Cam1  
01:12::54.19  
Z 00  
or delete a preset data.  
B
I
Function Lock Button  
Locks the functions that have been set on the  
[Settings] screen.  
268min  
C
D
230min  
---min  
STBY  
282min  
H
I
Icon  
Description  
E
F
Locked  
.
Not locked  
G
.
J
Camera Control Function  
J
.
194 View Remote Feature  
   
Registering/Deleting Preset Zoom  
4
In the same way, register [B] and [C].  
After all three positions A, B and C are  
registered, the positions of the [A], [B], and [C]  
buttons will be rearranged according to the  
order of the registered zoom position from the  
left.  
Registering Preset Zoom  
You can register any 3 zoom positions.  
1
Set to the Register Preset Zoom mode.  
Tap (click) the [Preset] button to switch to the  
Register Preset Zoom mode.  
Cam1  
01:12::54.19  
Z 00  
Cam1  
01:12::54.19  
Z 00  
268min  
230min  
---min  
STBY  
268min  
282min  
230min  
---min  
STBY  
282min  
.
5
Exit the Register Preset Zoom mode.  
Tap (click) the [Preset] button to exit the  
Register Preset Zoom mode.  
.
2
Determine the zoom position.  
Use the zoom control to operate the zoom and  
determine a position.  
Tap (click) [A].  
Position [A] is registered, and position A is  
displayed on the sliding bar of the zoom control.  
Memo :  
0
0
0
0
After registration is complete ([A], [B], and [C]  
buttons are all active), tapping (clicking) each  
button switches to the corresponding preset  
zoom position.  
3
This function operates independently of the  
preset zoom position on the camera recorder.  
Cam1  
01:12::54.19  
Z 00  
When the dynamic zoom is on, the preset button  
where the dynamic zoom position is registered  
grays out when the dynamic zoom is off and the  
zoom position cannot be changed.  
268min  
230min  
---min  
STBY  
282min  
When the dynamic zoom is off, the dynamic  
zoom position cannot be registered.  
.
View Remote Feature 195  
     
Deleting a Preset Zoom  
Camera Control Function  
1
Set to the Delete Preset Zoom mode.  
When any of positions [A], [B], and [C] are  
registered, tapping (clicking) the [Clear] button  
switches to the Delete Preset Zoom mode.  
You can control the camera by accessing via a web  
browser on devices such as a smartphone, tablet  
terminal, or PC.  
You can perform the following operations for each  
of the items.  
The image is displayed on the View remote.  
Cam1  
01:12::54.19  
Z 00  
A
B
C
268min  
230min  
---min  
STBY  
282min  
D
E
F
.
G
.
2
Tap (click) the [A], [B], or [C] button that  
corresponds to the position you want to  
delete.  
A
REC  
For performing recording start or recording  
pause operation.  
0
The position is deleted, and the button is  
grayed out.  
0
.
The corresponding zoom position mark on  
the sliding bar also disappears.  
B
STREAMING  
Turns on or off live streaming.  
Cam1  
01:12::54.19  
Z 00  
.
268min  
230min  
---min  
STBY  
282min  
Grayed out  
Position mark  
disappears  
.
3
Exit the Delete Preset Zoom mode.  
Tap (click) the [Clear] button to exit the Delete  
Preset Zoom mode.  
Memo :  
0
The Clip Review function of the camera recorder  
is unavailable during View Remote operation.  
196 View Remote Feature  
   
C
D
E
CAMERA  
ZOOM  
Enables operations related to the camera  
functions.  
Enables zooming operations.  
.
FOCUS  
Enables focusing operations.  
.
F
USER SWITCH  
You can enable or disable the user buttons that  
are assigned with a function.  
.
.
G
MENU  
You can show or hide the display and menu  
characters on an external monitor as well as  
operation of menus, switching the display  
screen and status display.  
.
.
Camera Control Function 197  
Changing the Settings via  
a Web Browser  
You can change the network-related settings by  
accessing via a web browser on devices such as a  
smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC.  
A
B
View Remote  
Settings for operations on the View Remote.  
Connection Setup  
Settings related to the network.  
You can change the settings for each of the  
preset items on the [Wizard] screen of the  
camera recorder.  
1
Access the main page of the camera.  
Access the page via a web browser on devices  
such as a smartphone, tablet terminal, or PC.  
C
Metadata Server  
Settings on the server for importing the  
metadata.  
Setting can be performed in the same way as  
the Metadata Server menu on the camera  
recorder.  
2
Tap (click) the [Settings] tab.  
The latest settings are reflected, regardless of  
whether they are specified via the camera  
recorder or web operation.  
2
D
Clip Server  
Settings for the server to upload recorded clips  
to.  
Setting can be performed in the same way as  
the [Clip Server] menu on the camera recorder.  
The latest settings are reflected, regardless of  
whether they are specified via the camera  
recorder or web operation.  
E
F
Live Streaming  
Setting for streaming audio and video via the  
network.  
The latest settings are reflected, regardless of  
whether they are specified via the camera  
recorder or web operation.  
Return over IP  
.
For specifying settings related to Return over IP.  
For configuring settings for receiving video and  
audio via the network.  
3
The [Settings] screen appears.  
Set each of the items as follows.  
The latest settings are reflected, regardless of  
whether they are specified via the camera  
recorder or web operation.  
A
B
C
D
E
F
Memo :  
0
Priority is given to menu operation on the  
camera recorder.  
0
When the menu on the camera recorder is  
opened while the [Settings] screen is opened  
using a web browser, a warning appears, after  
which the display returns to the main screen.  
While the menu is displayed on the camera  
recorder, the [Settings] screen cannot be  
opened via the web browser.  
.
0
198 Changing the Settings via a Web Browser  
   
Changing View Remote Function  
Settings  
Changing Connection Setup  
You can change the settings for each of the preset  
items on the [Wizard] screen of the camera  
recorder.  
For performing setting for using the View Remote  
function.  
0
If all the items cannot be displayed in a single  
page, scroll down to display the remaining  
items.  
A
B
0
Items that cannot be changed are grayed out  
according to the type of adapter connected and  
the mode of connection.  
A
B
C
D
C
.
A
E
[Camera Name]  
0
For setting the name that appears at the top  
left of the view screen.  
.
0
Tapping the text input area displays a  
software keyboard.  
A
B
C
D
Method of Connection  
Type of USB Adapter Connected  
Mode of Wireless LAN Connection  
If you are using a PC, enter using the PC  
keyboard.  
0
By tapping the Go key after input is complete,  
the software keyboard disappears.  
[Search Access Point] Button  
Tap (click) to display a list of the detected  
access points.  
B
[Restrictions]  
For setting the buttons to be disabled on the  
View screen while in the locked mode.  
The currently selected access point is indicated  
by a dot mark ( 0 ).  
0
[REC]:  
For setting whether to disable the Stop  
Record button, zoom operation, and camera  
control during recording.  
Tap (click) each item to switch between  
[Unlock] and [Lock].  
[Except REC]:  
0
For setting whether to disable the record  
button, zoom operation, and camera control  
in any mode other than the recording mode.  
Tap (click) each item to switch between  
[Unlock] and [Lock].  
C
[Save]/[Cancel]  
.
Tap (click) [Save] to save the settings.  
Tap (click) [Cancel] to stop setting and return to  
the main [Settings] screen.  
E
Settings on the [Select Setup Type] Screen of  
the Camera Recorder  
Changing the Settings via a Web Browser 199  
   
Changing Metadata Server Settings  
You can make direct changes to the FTP server for  
importing the metadata set in [Network] B  
[Metadata Server], as well as the path of the file to  
import.  
F
.
Changing Clip Server Settings  
F
Settings on the [IP Address Configuration]  
Screen of the Camera Recorder  
When “On” is selected for “DHCP”, all items will  
be grayed out.  
You can make direct changes to the server and  
directory settings that are specified in [Network] B  
[Clip Server] for uploading recorded clips in the  
recording media to the FTP server.  
G
Changing Streaming Settings  
You can make direct changes to settings that are  
specified in [Network] B [Live Streaming], such as  
information on the destination of distribution.  
.
G
Settings when using cellular adapter  
H
I
.
H
Settings on the [Select FTP Proxy] Screen of the  
Camera Recorder  
I
[OK]/[Cancel] Button  
After changing of settings is complete, tap  
(click) the [OK] button.  
On the confirmation screen, tap (click)  
[Execute] to change the settings on the camera  
recorder and restart the network.  
200 Changing the Settings via a Web Browser  
     
Saving the Connection Settings File  
Managing the Network  
Connection Settings File  
1
2
Select [Network] B [Connection Setup] B  
[Setup File] and press the Set button (R).  
Select [Store] and press the Set button (R).  
This camera recorder allows you to save the  
network connection settings on the Wizard screen  
to the camera recorder unit.  
Loading a saved connecting settings file enables  
you to reproduce the appropriate network  
connection state speedily.  
2
Memo :  
0
To save or retrieve the connection settings, go  
to [Network] B [Connection Setup].  
0
The following operations can be performed on  
the [Connection Setup] menu.  
0
.
3
Select the file to be newly saved (or  
overwritten) using the cross-shaped  
button (JK), and press the Set button (R).  
0
0
Number of Storable Setup Files  
Camera recorder [CAM1] to [CAM4]  
:
3
.
4
Name the file.  
Enter the subname using the software  
keyboard.  
Memo :  
0
When overwriting an existing file, the subname  
of the existing file is displayed.  
0
Select [Cancel] and press the Set button (R), or  
press the [CANCEL] button to return to the  
previous screen.  
Managing the Network Connection Settings File 201  
     
Reading the Connection Settings File  
5
Select [Store] and press the Set button (R).  
1
2
Select [Network] B [Connection Setup] B  
[Setup File] and press the Set button (R).  
Select [Load] and press the Set button (R).  
4
2
5
.
6
Save the file.  
0
A confirmation screen appears when you  
choose to overwrite.  
Select [Overwrite] on the confirmation  
screen, and press the Set button (R). Saving  
starts, andStoring...” appears on the screen.  
.
3
Select the file to read using the cross-  
shaped button (JK), and press the Set  
button (R).  
Overwrite Connection  
Setup?  
CAM3:KAMAKURA  
3
Overwrite  
6
Cancel  
.
0
Saving starts, and “Storing...” appears on the  
screen when the file is newly saved.  
.
4
Select [Load] on the confirmation screen,  
and press the Set button (R).  
Loading starts, and “Loading...” appears on the  
screen.  
Storing...  
Load Connection  
Setup?  
CAM2 :YOKOHAMA  
Load  
.
4
7
Cancel  
Saving is complete.  
After saving of the file is complete, “Complete”  
appears on the screen, and the menu screen  
closes automatically.  
.
5
Reading is complete.  
After reading of the file is complete, “Complete”  
appears on the screen, and the menu screen  
closes automatically.  
202 Managing the Network Connection Settings File  
   
Deleting Connection Settings  
1
2
Select [Network] B [Connection Setup] B  
[Setup File] and press the Set button (R).  
Select [Delete] and press the Set button  
(R).  
2
.
3
Select the file to delete using the cross-  
shaped button (JK), and press the Set  
button (R).  
3
.
4
Select [Delete] on the confirmation screen,  
and press the Set button (R).  
Deletion starts, and “Deleting...” appears on the  
screen.  
Delete Connection  
Setup?  
CAM1 :TOKYO  
Delete  
Cancel  
4
.
5
Deletion is complete.  
After file deletion is complete, “Complete”  
appears on the screen.  
Managing the Network Connection Settings File 203  
   
Performing Live Streaming  
By combining with the decoder or PC application that supports live streaming, you can perform audio and  
video streaming via the network.  
Supported Formats  
.
Usable Formats for Live Streaming  
Record Format  
1920x 1920x 1920x 1280x 1280x 720x  
640x 640x  
Frame  
Rate  
System Format Resolution  
1080, 1080, 1080, 720, 720,  
480,  
60i  
360,  
60p  
360,  
30p  
60p  
60i  
30p  
60p  
30p  
HD  
QuickTime  
(H.264)  
60p  
60i  
1920x1080  
30p  
60p  
60p  
60p  
60i  
1280x720  
1920x1080  
1280x720  
Exchange  
(U model)  
QuickTime  
(MPEG2)  
MXF  
1920x1080  
30p  
60i  
1440x1080  
1280x720  
(MPEG2)  
60p  
SD  
QuickTime  
(H.264)  
720x480  
60i  
(U model)  
.
Usable Formats for Live Streaming  
Record Format  
System Format Resolution  
1920x 1920x 1920x 1280x 1280x 720x  
640x 640x  
Frame  
Rate  
1080, 1080, 1080, 720, 720,  
50p 50i 25p 50p 25p  
576,  
50i  
360,  
50p  
360,  
25p  
HD  
QuickTime  
(H.264)  
50p  
50i  
1920x1080  
25p  
50p  
50p  
50p  
50i  
1280x720  
1920x1080  
1280x720  
MP4  
(E model)  
QuickTime  
(MPEG2)  
MXF  
1920x1080  
25p  
50i  
1440x1080  
1280x720  
(MPEG2)  
50p  
SD  
QuickTime  
(H.264)  
720x576  
50i  
(E model)  
204 Performing Live Streaming  
   
Audio  
AAC  
Memo :  
0
The distributable resolution, frame rate and bit  
rate vary according to the recording format.  
To distribute progressive video, set the frame  
rate to any of the progressive frame rates. And  
to distribute interlace video, set the frame rate to  
any of the interlace frame rates.  
0
Supported Protocols  
MPEG2-TS/UDP  
MPEG2-TS/TCP  
MPEG2-TS/RTP  
RTSP/RTP  
ZIXI  
0
Depending on the type of network adapter used  
and the connection, the images and audio  
sound during live streaming can be choppy.  
RTMP  
Performing Live Streaming 205  
Setting Distribution  
2
3
Set the Resolution and Frame & Bit Rate for  
the video to be distributed.  
Specify the settings in [Network] B [Live  
Streaming].  
1
Set the [Record Format] according to the  
resolution and frame rate of the video to be  
distributed.  
For details on the [Record Format] settings,  
Specify the distribution protocol and  
related items.  
Specify the distribution protocol and related  
items in [Network] B [Live Streaming] B  
[Streaming Server].  
Memo :  
0
Live streaming cannot be performed in the  
following cases.  
0
4
Select the server for live streaming.  
Select the distribution server in [Network] B  
[Live Streaming] B [Server].  
When [System] B [Record Set] B [Record  
Format] B [System] is set to other than “HD”  
or “SD”  
0
When [System] B [Record Set] B [Record  
Format] B[WFrame Rate] is set to “24p”  
Distributable [Record Format] and [Live Streaming Set] Combinations  
1920 x 1080  
60p, 50p  
1280 x 720  
60p, 50p  
Resolution  
Frame Rate  
Type  
60i, 50i, 30p, 25p  
30p, 25p  
Bit  
Rate  
24 Mbps  
20 Mbps  
16 Mbps  
12 Mbps  
8 Mbps  
5 Mbps  
3 Mbps  
1.5 Mbps  
0.8 Mbps  
0.3 Mbps  
.
*
R: Distributable  
o: Distributable when [Format] is configured as follows.  
0
QuickTime(H.264), Exchange (U model)  
0
MP4(H.264) (E model)  
J: When [Format] is configured to “QuickTime(MPEG2)” or “MXF(MPEG2)”, configuring [Time  
Stamp] to “On” or configuring [Overlay Function] to “Enable” disables distribution. A  
206 Performing Live Streaming  
     
Resolution 720 x 480 or 720 x 576 640 x 360  
Frame Rate 60i or 50i  
Type  
60p, 50p  
30p, 25p  
Bitrate  
24 Mbps  
20 Mbps  
16 Mbps  
12 Mbps  
8 Mbps  
R
R
R
R
R
R
5 Mbps  
3 Mbps  
1.5 Mbps  
0.8 Mbps  
0.3 Mbps  
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
.
*
R: Distributable  
Performing Live Streaming 207  
Starting Distribution  
Memo :  
1
Perform the necessary setting for the  
decoder and PC application.  
0
You can also assign “Live Streaming” to a user  
button.  
For details on the settings, please refer to the  
“INSTRUCTIONS” of the respective devices  
and applications.  
0
You can view the status of distribution on the  
LCD monitor.  
Memo :  
0
0
0
If there is an NAT router within the  
communication path between the camera and  
the decoder, port forwarding setup is required.  
For details on the settings, please refer to the  
“INSTRUCTIONS” of the router in use.  
The following parameters are required when  
connecting to this camera recorder using the  
RTSP/RTP.  
Icon  
Status  
Distribution in progress (good  
connection quality)  
.
Blinks when distribution starts or  
stops  
(Red)  
Distribution in progress (poor  
connection quality)  
Port number: 554  
.
Stream ID: stream  
(Red)  
Use the following to access via URL.  
rtsp://<IP address of the camera recorder>:554/  
stream  
Waiting for connection (during  
RTSP/RTP) or connection failed  
.
(Yellow)  
2
With the network connection established,  
set [Live Streaming] to “On”.  
0
When the 5 icon is displayed, you can view the  
details of the error on the [Streaming] screen of  
the status screen.  
0
Set [Network] B [Live Streaming] B [Live  
Streaming] to “On”.  
The network connection mark appears on the  
display screen when a network connection is  
established.  
0
Cause of Error  
.
Caution :  
0
Streaming may be interrupted temporarily 24  
hours after the process started.  
208 Performing Live Streaming  
 
Setting the FEC Matrix  
Memo :  
0
Increasing the amount of FEC overhead  
increases the packet loss resilience but more  
network bandwidth is used.  
Set the amount of FEC (Forward Error Correction)  
overhead for configuring SMPTE2022-1.  
1
Select [Network] B [Live Streaming] B  
[Streaming Server] B [Server1] to [Server4]  
B [FEC Matrix] and press the Set button.  
The FEC adjustment screen appears.  
0
Even with the same amount of overhead,  
increasing the L value will increase the packet  
loss (continuous packet loss) resilience.  
.
2
Adjust the L and D values.  
Use the H/I buttons to adjust the L value, and  
the J/K buttons to adjust the D value.  
The amount of FEC overhead changes when  
the L and D values are changed.  
To restore the L and D values to their default  
values, press the [OIS/2] button.  
Memo :  
0
Setting range  
0
4 L 20 (Default value: L = 10)  
0
4 D 20 (Default value: D = 10)  
0
L × D 100 (Default value: L×D = 10×10)  
3
Press the Set button (R).  
The screen returns to the streaming server  
setting screen.  
.
Performing Live Streaming 209  
 
Return Video and Audio from the  
Network  
Return Video/Audio from  
the Network (Return over  
IP)  
Return video/audio from the network can be  
displayed on the viewfinder or LCD monitor of the  
camera or listened through a headphone.  
1
2
Set the camera recorder to the Camera  
mode.  
Assign the “Return Video” and “Return  
over IP” features to any of the user buttons  
Memo :  
0
0
This feature is only usable in the Camera mode.  
Start the encoder before activating Return over  
IP. To end, turn off Return over IP before shutting  
down the encoder.  
Memo :  
0
The “Return over IP” feature can also be  
operated using “On”/“Off” under [Network] B  
[Return over IP] B [Return over IP].  
0
This feature is available when [System] B  
[Record Set] B [Record Format] B [System] is  
set to “HD” or “SD”. When [WFrame Rate] is set  
to “24p”, this feature is not available.  
3
When [WFormat] is configured to  
“QuickTime (MPEG2)” or “MXF(MPEG2)”,  
configure [Network] B [Return over IP] B  
[Function] to “Enable”A  
Configuring the Return over IP Server  
4
5
Press the user button that is assigned with  
Configure the Return over IP settings and establish  
the “Return over IP” function.  
the connection before displaying the return video.  
Press the user button that is assigned with  
the “Return Video” function.  
1
Register the [Return Server].  
Configure [Network] B [Return over IP] B  
[Server] to “Server”.  
Configure the individual settings in the [Return  
Server] item.  
Displays the return video image.  
The settings in [A/V Set] B [Audio Set] B  
[IFB/RET Monitor] will be applied to the audio.  
Memo :  
0
For details on the registered information, please  
consult the network administrator for the server.  
Configure “Icecast” to a setting other than  
[Type].  
Operates as IFB when the setting is configured  
to “Icecast”.  
0
210 Return Video/Audio from the Network (Return over IP)  
 
Return Audio from the Network (IFB)  
IFB (Return Audio)  
1
2
Set the camera recorder to the Camera  
mode.  
Return audio from the network can be played  
through a headphone.  
Assign the “Return over IP” function to any  
of the user buttons.  
Memo :  
0
0
This feature is only usable in the Camera mode.  
Start the encoder before activating Return over  
IP. To end, turn off Return over IP before shutting  
down the encoder.  
Memo :  
0
This feature is available when [System] B  
[Record Set] B [Record Format] B [System] is  
set to “HD” or “SD”. When [WFrame Rate] is set  
to “24p”, this feature is not available.  
0
The “Return over IP” feature can also be  
operated using “On”/“Off” under [Network] B  
[Return over IP] B [Return over IP].  
3
When [WFormat] is configured to  
“QuickTime (MPEG2)” or “MXF(MPEG2)”,  
configure [Network] B [Return over IP] B  
[Function] to “Enable”A  
Configuring the Return over IP Server  
Configure the Return over IP settings and establish  
the connection before displaying the return audio.  
1
Register the [Return Server].  
Configure [Network] B [Return over IP] B  
[Server] to “Server”.  
Configure the individual settings in the [Return  
Server] item.  
4
Press the user button that is assigned with  
the “Return over IP” function.  
When Return over IP is activated, the settings  
in [A/V Set] B [Audio Set] B [IFB/RET Monitor]  
will be applied to the audio.  
Memo :  
0
For details on the registered information, please  
consult the network administrator for the server.  
Configure “Icecast” to [Type].  
Operates as IFB when the setting is configured  
to “Icecast”.  
0
IFB (Return Audio) 211  
 
Entering Tag Information via the Web Function  
Tagging Feature L  
When using the Exchange file format, entering the  
tag information on the camera recorder helps to  
ease the management of tags during editing.  
1
Access the web function of this camera  
recorder via a web browser on devices  
such as a smartphone, tablet terminal or  
PC, and display the main page.  
Configuring to Exchange Format  
2
3
Press the “Sports Tagging” button to  
To use the tagging feature, configure [System] B  
[Record Set] B [Record Format] B [WFormat] to  
“Exchange”.  
display the tag input screen.  
Enter the tag information and press the  
“Enter” button  
Enter “Title 1” and “Title 2” manually or using the  
template input button.  
4
5
Start recording.  
Configuring Camera Angle Information  
To make changes, enter the tag information  
Camera angle information can be recorded to the  
and press the “Enter” button  
metadata of the recorded clip.  
Enter “Title 1” and “Title 2” manually or using the  
template input button.  
Configure the settings in [Camera Function] B  
[Camera Angle[Tagging]].  
6
7
Press the Set button  
Stop recording.  
The tag is recorded to the .xchange file.  
Entering Tag Information  
Tag information can be entered on the camera  
recorder or via the web function of the camera  
recorder.  
A
B
C
D
E
Entering Tag Information on the Camera  
Recorder  
1
Assign the tag to a user button  
F
2
Press the user button that is assigned with  
G
the tag  
H
I
3
4
Start recording.  
To make changes, press the user button  
.
that is assigned with the tag.  
A
B
5
Sports Tagging Button  
Current setting  
Stop recording.  
The tag is recorded to the .xchange file.  
Displays the text strings entered for [Title 1] and  
[Title 2] just before the Set button is last  
pressed.  
C
D
Data input boxes [Title 1] and [Title 2]  
Text can be entered into the boxes directly. For  
smartphones or tablets, tapping the box  
displays a OS keyboard.  
Clear button  
Clears the text in the [Title 1] and [Title 2] boxes.  
Tagging Feature L  
212  
       
Synchronizing GPS Time Code  
E
Set button  
Sends the text strings in [Title 1] and [Title 2] to  
the camera recorder and the tag data of the clip  
is updated. Update of the tag data is possible  
while recording is in progress.  
Time code information can be synchronized with  
the date/time information acquired from the GPS.  
F
G
Template input button  
Enters a template phrase into the [Title 1].  
(Example) Pressing the [KO] button enters KO  
into “Title 1”.  
Setting Time Code Generator  
Set [TC/UB] B [TC Generator] to “Free Run(GPS)”.  
REMOVE Button  
Memo :  
Adds a REMOVE flag to the .xchange file of the  
clip that is currently being recorded. When  
recording is paused during Clip Continuous  
recording, pressing the REMOVE button adds  
a REMOVE flag to the .xchange file that was last  
recorded.  
0
When [System] B [Record Set] B [Rec Mode] is  
configured to “Interval Rec” or “Frame Rec”,  
“Free Run(GPS)” cannot be selected.  
The Z icon lights up when the time code is  
synchronized.  
0
H
I
Stop Record Button  
00:00:00.00  
Stops clip recording by the camera recorder.  
This button is active only during clip recording  
by the camera recorder.  
5 .
12 :35
Start Record Button  
Starts clip recording by the camera recorder.  
This button is active only when the camera  
recorder is ready to start recording.  
ND1  
AE  
/ 60  
/64  
0
4030 20 10  
0
K
5600  
1
ISO  
F2. 8  
B
102400  
.
Memo :  
0
You can enter up to 64 characters for “Title 1”  
and up to 128 characters for “Title 2”.  
Changing (including clearing) the text in the  
“Title 1” and “Title 2” boxes does not  
automatically update the tag data of the  
recorded clip. Make sure to press the Set button  
to confirm the change. Changes in the tag data  
cannot be made to clips for which recording has  
already ended.  
0
0
0
Input of tag data in file formats other than MOV  
is not guaranteed.  
When a recorded clip is split into multiple files,  
the same tag information may not be saved to all  
the files depending on the timing at which the tag  
information is updated. It is recommended that  
a SDXC card be used with [System] B Record  
Set B [4GB File Spanning(SDXC)] configured to  
“Off”.  
Tagging Feature L  
213  
 
3
4
Broadcast Overlay A  
Select the file for overlay from the imported  
file in [Overlay Settings] B [Layout].  
L
Select “Broadcast” in [Overlay Settings] B  
[Type].  
Texts, images and watermark can be overlaid onto  
recorded videos and live streaming videos from a  
smartphone or tablet device by importing the SDP  
file for broadcast.  
When the SDP file selected in [Layout] is  
created in a type other than “Broadcast”, or  
when the recording resolution of the  
“Broadcast” type of the SDP file is different from  
the recording resolution of the current camera,  
“Broadcast” is not displayed in [Type].  
Available when [System] is set to “HD” or “HD  
+Web”.  
Use the SDP Generator to create the SDP file for  
broadcast.  
0
Broadcast:  
Watermark  
0
For information on SDP Generator, please  
contact your local dealer or download from our  
website.  
Live Mark  
Text 1  
Caution :  
Logo  
Text 3  
Time  
0
Regardless of the recording resolution  
(1920x1080, 1440x1080, 1280x720), the SDP  
file resolution that can be used on this camera  
recorder is fixed at 1920x1080.  
Text 2  
None: No display  
.
0
Memo :  
5
1
Select the display in [Overlay Settings] B  
[Output] B [HD Recording]/[HDMI]  
0
Configuring Type to “Broadcast” in the factory  
settings displays a sample of the overlaid image.  
Check the display and operation in advance  
before recording or live streaming starts.  
0
Entering Overlay Text  
Importing and Configuring Settings for  
SDP Files for Broadcast  
Connect this camera recorder to the  
network  
Memo :  
0
When the recording format is “HD+Web”, the  
scoreboard display is always overlaid on the  
“Web” recording clip.  
2
3
Connecting from a web browser  
When the web browser screen appears,  
press the overlay icon at the top of the  
screen or the [Overlay Control] button to  
display the input screen  
0
0
The scoreboard display is always overlaid on  
live video streaming.  
The settings cannot be changed during  
recording or live streaming.  
1
Set [Overlay Settings] B [Overlay  
Function] to “Enable”.  
.
When [System] is configured to a setting other  
than “HD” and “HD+Web”, this item is fixed at  
“Disable”.  
Use [Overlay Settings] B [Import User  
Layout] to import the file.  
To use an overlay other than the SDP file at  
factory default, import the SDP file for broadcast  
to the camera.  
4
One of the following screens appears  
according to the setting for [Type] in the  
camera recorder menu.  
2
Broadcast Overlay A L  
214  
     
Memo:  
Range <A> Text 1  
Range <B> Text 2  
Range <C> Text 3  
Range <D> Time  
Range <E> Logo  
Range <F> Live mark  
A
B
<A>  
<B>  
C
D
E
F
A
Shows the current overlay status.  
B
Text selection area  
The highlighted text is overlaid and displayed.  
C
[K] [J] Button  
Selects the text.  
[Edit] Button  
Switches to the text entry mode.  
[1][2][3][4] Button  
Selects the image.  
[Display] Button  
Displays or hides specific areas.  
D
E
F
G
<C>  
<D>  
Unit Button  
Selects the unit to add after Text 3.  
G
H
[Update] Button  
Reflects the changed content in the overlay  
display.  
I
[Overlay] Button  
Displays or hides the overlay.  
Text that can be entered in [Text 1], [Text 2], and  
[Text 3] are as follows:  
<E>  
<F>  
! " # $%&' ( ) * + , - . / 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9  
: ; < = > ?@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTU  
VWXYZ[ \ ] ^ _ ` a b c d e f g h i j k l m n  
o p q r s t u v w x y z { | } ~ ¡ ¢ £ ¤ ¥ ¦ § ¨  
© ª « ¬ ® ¯ ° ² ³ ´ μ ¶ • ¸ ¹ º » ¼ ½ ¾ ¿  
À Á Â Ã Ä ÅÆÇÈ É Ê Ë Ì Í Î ÏÐÑÒÓÔÕÖ×  
ØÙÚÛÜÝ Þ ß à á â ã ä åæç è é ê ë ì í î ï  
ð ñ ò ó ô õ ö ÷øùúûüýþÿĞğİıOEoeŞşŠšŸ  
H
I
Žžƒˆ˜–—‘’‚“”„†‡•…‰‹›€™  
.
.
Memo :  
0
Not more than 5 lines can be entered for Text 1  
and Text 2 each. Up to 63 bytes can be entered  
for each line.  
0
0
Up to 5 bytes can be entered for Text 3.  
For some types of text, the text that has been  
entered may not be displayed fully on the  
overlaid display. Check the display in advance.  
Broadcast Overlay A L  
215  
Displaying Watermark Images  
Displaying Images on the Whole Screen  
(Full Screen Graphic Function)  
Import the SDP file in which the watermark image  
has been preconfigured to the camera recorder in  
advance.  
Announcement and advertising images can be  
displayed across the whole screen.  
The watermark setting menu will be displayed in  
the [Overlay Settings] menu screen only when the  
SDP file for broadcast is selected in [Overlay  
Settings] B [Layout].  
1
Set [Overlay Settings] B [Watermark] to  
“On”.  
2
Select [Overlay Settings] B [Position].  
The watermark position setting screen appears.  
.
0
0
The position is moved 2 steps at a time.  
The displayed coordinates shows the  
position at the top left of the watermark  
image.  
Importing Images for Display to the Camera  
1
Prepare the image for display.  
JPEG (extension .jpg) and PNG  
(extension .png) formats are supported.  
3
Use the cursor to move the watermark and  
press the Set (R) button  
2
Copy the image file to the root directory of  
Horizontal  
Direction  
the SD card.  
0
Use an SD card of a recordable specification  
in the current camera recording settings.  
Up to 50 image files can be displayed.  
The order of display by file name can be  
specified.  
0
0
Memo :  
0
Add a two-digit number of 01 to 50 at the start of  
the file name. Files will be displayed in the order  
starting from those having the smallest number  
in the file name.  
Vertical Direction  
.
Example: When 01flower.png, 02car.jpg,  
13red.png are imported, they are displayed in  
the order of 01flower.png B 02car.jpg B  
13red.png.  
0
0
Only alphanumeric characters and underscore  
(_) can be used for the third character onwards  
in the file name.  
Enter not more than 31 characters for the file  
name.  
3
Select [Overlay Settings] B [Full Screen  
Graphic].  
4
Insert the SD card where the image files are  
copied into the SD card slot A or B of the  
camera, and select [Import GraphicW] or  
[Import GraphicY] to import.  
0
Once import is performed, all images  
previously imported will be deleted.  
To delete the imported image files, select  
[Overlay Settings] B [Full Screen Graphic] B  
[Delete Graphic].  
0
Broadcast Overlay A L  
216  
   
Displaying Images  
Display the image from the web screen for setting  
the overlay.  
Memo :  
0
The total number of currently imported image  
files and the used capacity can be checked in  
[Overlay Settings] B [Full Screen Graphic] B  
[Status]. This capacity may be bigger than the  
actual image file size.  
A
B
C
0
0
The maximum import size is approx. 23 MB,  
after combining the capacity that can be  
checked in [Status] and the size of the imported  
SDP files.  
Images that can be displayed are as follows:  
0
Image Size: 960x540  
D
E
0
File Size: 1MB and below  
0
JPEG:  
Gradation: 8 bit  
Pixel format: YCbCr or grayscale  
Baseline JPEG  
0
PNG:  
.
Bit/Channel: 1, 2, 4, 8  
Pixel format: Grayscale, Index, True color  
(RGB), grayscale with alpha, true color with  
alpha (RGBA)  
A
B
C
Start:  
Starts the display of images.  
Stop:  
Non-interlaced PNG  
Stops the display of images.  
0
When images that cannot be displayed are  
imported to the camera, an error message  
“Unsupported Graphic Format” is displayed on  
the camera recorder while image display is in  
progress. Check in advance that images can be  
displayed as per expectation.  
Next:  
Image in : Displays the next image.  
display  
Image  
not in  
:
Starts displaying from the next  
image of the image at which the  
display stopped previously.  
display  
Depending on the status of the camera, it may  
take a while to display the next image after  
pressing the [Next] button.  
D
E
Interval Time:  
Sets the display time per image.  
Depending on the status of the camera, it may  
take a while to display the next image after  
pressing the [Start] button. A time longer than  
the configured interval time may be  
displayed.  
Loop Playback:  
Select [ON] to return to the first image after the  
last image is displayed.  
Broadcast Overlay A L  
217  
Protecting Overlay Settings with a  
Password  
You can use a password to protect overlay settings  
to prevent the cancellation of watermark display by  
a third party.  
Memo :  
0
To display only one image continuously, set  
[Interval Time] to “0”.  
0
When recording is performed together with live  
streaming or when there is a lot of information  
display on the LCD/VF screen, images may take  
more than 10 seconds to display. It is possible  
to reduce the time taken to display by lowering  
the resolution of the recording and live  
streaming or by pressing the [DISPLAY] button  
of the camera recorder to turn off the display  
screen.  
Protecting with a Password  
1
Set [Overlay Settings] B [Password Lock]  
to “On”.  
2
Enter the protection password and press  
the cross-shaped button (I).  
0
0
To use only the Full Screen Graphic function  
without the overlay display, select [Overlay  
Settings] B [Type] and choose options other  
than “None”. Then, set the [Overlay] button on  
the web screen for controlling the overlay to Off.  
When the format of the next image to be  
displayed is not supported during image display,  
“Unsupported Graphic Format” will be displayed  
on the camera recorder, and that image will not  
be displayed. Import images that support a  
displayable format.  
Enter not more than 16 characters for the  
password using the software keyboard.  
3
4
Enter the same password again and press  
the cross-shaped button (I).  
Press [Set].  
A password request screen will appear  
subsequently before you enter the [Overlay  
Settings] screen.  
Caution :  
0
Do not forget the password that you have set. If  
the password is lost or forgotten, you cannot  
deactivate the password protection function.  
Memo :  
0
When overlay settings are protected by a  
password, the following items in [System] are  
grayed out and cannot be selected.  
0
[Reset All]  
0
[Record Set] B [Record Format]  
0
[Setup File] B [Load File] B [Picture File]/  
[User File]/[All File]  
[Setup File] B [Store File] B [Picture File]/  
0
[User File]/[All File]  
Deactivating Password Protection  
1
Select [Overlay Settings].  
A password request screen appears.  
2
Enter the password and press the cross-  
shaped button (I).  
If the password matches the configured  
password, the [Overlay Settings] menu  
appears.  
3
4
Change [Password Lock] to “Off”.  
Press [Set] to close the deactivation  
complete screen.  
Broadcast Overlay A L  
218  
 
Specifying Text and Images  
Scoreboard Overlay L  
By using a smartphone or tablet, a scoreboard can  
be overlaid onto a recorded or live streaming video.  
Available when [System] is set to “HD” or “HD  
+Web”.  
1
Connect the camera recorder to a network  
compatible device such as a mobile device  
via the network.  
When network connection is established  
between the devices, start the Web browser on  
the network compatible device.  
Memo :  
0
Check the display and operation in advance  
2
before recording or live streaming starts.  
Enter the following URL in the address bar  
of the Web browser.  
Configuring Scoreboard Display  
Caution :  
http:// “IP address of camera ecorder”  
Example; http://192.168.0.1  
You can check the “IP address of camera  
recorder” by pressing the [STATUS] button on  
the camera recorder to display the Status  
screen and use the cross-shaped button (H I)  
to display the Network screen.  
Enter the user name and password.  
Enter the user name and the password on the  
login screen to display the main page of the  
camera.  
Press the overlay control icon at the top of  
the screen or the [Overlay Control] button  
to display the Settings screen  
0
Regardless of the recording resolution  
(1920x1080, 1440x1080, 1280x720), the SDP  
file resolution that can be used on this camera  
recorder is fixed at 1920x1080.  
.
Memo :  
0
When displaying soccer or ice hockey, import an  
SDP file to the camera recorder in advance.  
Create an SDP file using the SDP Generator.  
Next, select the imported SDP file in [Overlay  
Settings] B [Layout].  
3
4
0
0
When the recording format is “HD+Web”, the  
scoreboard display is always overlaid on the  
“Web” recording clip.  
The scoreboard display is always overlaid on  
live video streaming.  
4
1
Configure [Overlay Settings] B [Overlay  
Function] to “Enable”.  
When [System] is configured to a setting other  
than “HD” and “HD+Web”, this item is fixed at  
“Disable”.  
2
Import the file in [Overlay Settings] B  
[Import User Layout]  
0
Create SDP files for scoreboard overlay in  
advance using the SDP Generator.  
Skip step 2 if [Layout] is to be configured to  
“Default” in step 3.  
0
3
4
5
Select [Overlay Settings] B [Layout].  
Select [Overlay Settings] B [Type].  
Select the display in [Overlay Settings] B  
[Output] B [HD Recording]/[HDMI]  
.
5
Press the [Update] button to reflect the  
specified text and images in the overlay.  
Broadcast Overlay A L  
219  
   
Baseball :  
Configuring Scoreboard Display  
Position  
Inning  
Runner  
Count  
Team Name;  
Points Scored  
The scoreboard can be displayed at the following  
positions on the screen. Create an SDP file with the  
desired display position in the SDP Generator and  
import the file to the camera recorder.  
Offense Team Indicator  
.
Soccer :  
Type  
Overlay Location  
Top, Bottom  
Select [Small], [Large] or [Penalty Shoot-out] in  
the Overlay Control web screen.  
[Small]  
Type 1  
Type 2  
Football  
Top, Bottom  
Top, Bottom  
Top, Bottom  
Time  
Points Scored Team Name (Small)  
Basketball  
Baseball  
Top Right, Bottom Right,  
Top Left, Bottom Left  
Team Logo (Small)  
Additional Time  
Top Right, Bottom Right,  
Top Left, Bottom Left  
Small  
Large  
Bottom (not  
Soccer  
changeable)  
Penalty  
Bottom (not  
changeable)  
Shoot-out  
Top Right, Bottom Right,  
Hockey  
Top Left, Bottom Left  
Type 1 :  
Minutes of Added Time  
.
Offense Team Indicator  
Points Scored Period  
[Large]  
Text  
TEAM NAME  
Remainning Time  
.
Type 2 :  
Team Name (Large)  
Team Logo (Large) Points Scored  
[Penalty Shoot-out]  
.
TEAM NAME  
Points Scored  
Set  
Set Count  
.
Goal/Miss  
Points Scored  
.
Football :  
Points Scored  
Period  
Offense Team Indicator  
Remainning Time  
TOL  
TEAM NAME  
Down & Distance  
.
Basketball :  
Period  
Remainning Time  
Points Scored  
TOL  
TEAM NAME  
Shot Clock  
.
Scoreboard Overlay L  
220  
 
Hockey :  
Entering Scoreboard Data  
Select [Small] or [SHOOTOUT] in the Overlay  
1
Connect this camera recorder to the  
network  
Control web screen.  
[Small]  
TEAM NAME Period  
2
3
Connecting from a web browser  
When the web browser screen appears,  
press the overlay icon at the top of the  
screen or the [Overlay Control] button to  
display the input screen  
Team Logo  
Points Scored  
Remainning Time  
Power Play  
.
.
[SHOOTOUT]  
4
One of the following screens appears  
according to the setting for [Type] in the  
camera recorder menu.  
Rounds 1 to 3  
All information except for the numerical values  
is reflected immediately on the scoreboard  
display without the need to press the [Update]  
button.  
Goal/Miss  
Rounds 4 and later  
Memo :  
0
When the camera recorder is live streaming  
while recording, the update interval of the time  
display may not be constant. When this  
happens, reduce the resolution of the live  
streaming.  
.
None: Does not display  
Scoreboard Overlay L  
221  
 
Type 1  
Type 2  
A
A
B
B
C
C
D
E
.
A
[Update] Button  
Reflects numerical values such as score and  
distance on the score overlay.  
[Overlay] Button  
Turns the score overlay on or off.  
B
C
.
Team Name (for text input)  
A
Time  
IftheSDPfileselectedinthemenuitem [Overlay  
Settings] B [Layout] contains more than one  
team name image, this item is grayed out and  
text input is disabled.  
The start time entered is reflected on the score  
overlay by pressing the [Set] button.  
B
[Update] Button  
Reflects numerical values such as score and  
distance on the score overlay.  
C
D
[Overlay] Button  
Turns the score overlay on or off.  
Team Name (for text input)  
IftheSDPfileselectedinthemenuitem [Overlay  
Settings] B [Layout] contains more than one  
team name image, this item is grayed out and  
text input is disabled.  
E
Clock Count Direction  
Count Up: Increase  
Count Down: Decrease  
Scoreboard Overlay L  
222  
Football  
Baseball  
A
A
B
C
B
C
D
.
A
[Update] Button  
Reflects numerical values such as score and  
distance on the score overlay.  
[Display] Button  
Displays or hides specific areas.  
.
B
C
A
Time  
The start time entered is reflected on the score  
overlay by pressing the [Set] button.  
Team Name (for text input)  
IftheSDPfileselectedinthemenuitem [Overlay  
Settings] B [Layout] contains more than one  
team name image, this item is grayed out and  
text input is disabled.  
B
[Update] Button  
Reflects numerical values such as score and  
distance on the score overlay.  
C
D
[Overlay] Button  
Turns the score overlay on or off.  
Team Name (for text input)  
IftheSDPfileselectedinthemenuitem [Overlay  
Settings] B [Layout] contains more than one  
team name image, this item is grayed out and  
text input is disabled.  
Scoreboard Overlay L  
223  
Basketball  
A
B
Time  
The start time entered is reflected on the score  
overlay by pressing the [Set] button.  
[Update] Button  
Reflects numerical values such as score and  
A
distance on the score overlay.  
C
D
E
[Overlay] Button  
Turns the score overlay on or off.  
B
C
[Display] Button  
Displays or hides specific areas.  
[Reset1]/[Reset2] Button  
for Shot Clock  
Resets the value (in seconds) set below  
[Set] Button  
Confirms the value (in seconds) when [Reset1]/  
[Reset 2] button is pressed  
D
E
F
Team Name (for text input)  
IftheSDPfileselectedinthemenuitem [Overlay  
Settings] B [Layout] contains more than one  
team name image, this item is grayed out and  
text input is disabled.  
F
.
Scoreboard Overlay L  
224  
Soccer  
A
B
Time  
The start time entered is reflected on the score  
overlay by pressing the [Set] button.  
A
B
Time (Left):  
Currently displayed match time.  
Time (Right):  
Currently displayed additional time. Displayed  
only during additional time.  
C
D
Period:  
C
Can be changed only when the clock is stopped.  
Minutes of Added Time:  
Displays the additional time granted only during  
additional time if “ON” is selected.  
D
E
F
E
[Update] Button  
Reflects numerical values such as score and  
distance on the score overlay.  
G
F
G
[Overlay] Button  
Turns the score overlay on or off.  
Display Type:  
[Small] Button: Small display  
[Large] Button: Large display  
[PSO] Button: Penalty Shoot-out  
displayMinutes  
H
H
I
Penalty Shoot-out:  
Use when “PSO” is selected.  
Preset Settings:  
Items to be set before the match. Set the  
duration of each halftime, texts to be displayed  
in the Large display, and team names to be used  
in the Small and Large displays.  
I
J
Team Name (for text input)  
IftheSDPfileselectedinthemenuitem [Overlay  
Settings] B [Layout] contains more than one  
team name image, this item is grayed out and  
text input is disabled.  
J
.
Scoreboard Overlay L  
225  
Hockey  
A
B
Time  
The start time entered is reflected on the score  
overlay by pressing the [Set] button.  
A
B
Power Play:  
Entering the penalty time displays the power  
play state that corresponds to it.  
C
D
[Overlay] Button  
Turns the score overlay on or off.  
[Update] Button  
Reflects numerical values such as score and  
distance on the score overlay.  
E
F
G
Display Type:  
[Small] Button: Small display  
[SHOOTOUT] Button: Shoot-out display  
C
D
SHOOTOUT:  
[Round 1-3] Tab: For round 1 to 3  
[Round 4+] Tab: For round 4 and later  
E
Team Name (for text input)  
IftheSDPfileselectedinthemenuitem [Overlay  
Settings] B [Layout] contains more than one  
team name image, this item is grayed out and  
text input is disabled.  
F
G
.
Scoreboard Overlay L  
226  
Additional time display for Soccer  
The display of additional time toggles on and off automatically depending on the elapsed time of [Time]  
and the status of [Period]. Whether a match is in additional time is determined by the setting values of  
[Duration of Each Half] and [Duration of Each Half of ET] of [Preset Settings]. The display example is as  
follows.  
Example) Duration of Each Half: “45:00”, Duration of Each half of ET: “15:00”  
Period  
Time  
1:23  
Time Display  
1st Half  
2nd Half  
ET 1  
.
.
.
.
46:23  
46:23  
.
.
.
.
91:23  
91:23  
106:23  
106:23  
121:23  
ET 2  
Power play for Hockey  
Depending on the state of the penalty time, power play is automatically displayed or hidden. The display  
example is as follows.  
Penalty Time  
Left Team Right Team  
Penalty 1 Penalty 2 Penalty 1 Penalty 2  
Time Display  
Display Position  
Display Time  
0:00  
0:00  
0:00  
0:00  
.
0:00  
0:00  
Time C  
0:00  
Time C  
.
Time C or D (the  
0:00  
0:00  
0:00  
Time C  
0:00  
Time D  
0:00  
smaller of the two)  
.
Time A  
Time A  
Time A  
Time A  
Time A  
Time A  
.
Time A or C (the  
0:00  
Time C  
Time C  
0:00  
0:00  
smaller of the two)  
.
Time A, C or D (the  
0:00  
Time D  
0:00  
smallest of the three)  
.
Time A or B (the  
Time B  
Time B  
smaller of the two)  
.
Time A, B or C (the  
Time C  
0:00  
smallest of the three)  
.
Time A, B, C or D  
(the smallest of the  
four)  
Time A  
Time B  
Time C  
Time D  
.
Scoreboard Overlay L  
227  
Team Display Settings  
2
Insert the SD card in which the SDP file is  
copied into slot A or B,  
Team names can be displayed by one of the  
then select [Overlay Settings] B [Import User  
Layout].  
following ways.  
0
0
Specifying texts directly from web browser  
Importing an image containing the team name  
and logo  
The SDP files in the root folder of the SD card  
are displayed (max. 8 files per slot). However,  
if the file name is long and cannot be displayed  
on the menu screen, the file will be displayed  
with part of the file name omitted.  
Specifying texts directly from web browser  
Enter the texts in the Overlay Control web screen.  
Available characters are as follows. However, text  
cannot be entered when using a SDP file  
containing team name images.  
Select an SDP file to import from the list of  
displayed SDP files.  
3
Import the file  
Select an import destination from areas 1 to 4  
to start importing. If you select an area where a  
file name is already displayed, a confirmation  
screen asking whether to overwrite will appear.  
It will take about 20 to 30 seconds to complete  
the import. “Complete” will be displayed at the  
end. A gray display area indicates insufficient  
space and it cannot be selected. Select another  
area or delete SDP files that are not required in  
advance in [Overlay Settings] B [Delete User  
Layout].  
!"#$%&'()*+,-./0123456789:;<=>?@ABCDEFGH  
IJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ[\]^_`abcdefghijklmno  
pqrstuvwxyz{|}~¡¢£¤¥¦§¨©ª«¬®¯° ²³´μ¶•¸¹º»¼½  
¾¿ÀÁÂÃÄÅÆÇÈÉÊËÌÍÎÏÐÑÒÓÔÕÖרÙÚÛÜÝ  
Þßàáâãäåæçèéêëìíîïðñòóôõö÷øùúûüýþÿĞğİıŒ  
œŞşŠšŸŽžƒˆ˜–—‘’‚“”„†‡•…‰‹›€™  
.
Memo :  
0
For some types of text, the text that has been  
entered may not be displayed fully on the  
overlaid display. Check the display in advance.  
Caution :  
0
Do not turn off the power of the unit during  
import. You may lose the import data.  
Importing an image containing the team name  
and logo  
0
When import is successful, the name of the  
imported SDP file will be added to the  
[Overlay Settings] B [Layout] item. Select an  
SDP file name suitable for overlay. If a valid  
SDP file is not imported to the camera  
recorder, or if the SDP file imported does not  
match the recording format of the camera  
recorder, the [Type] item will be displayed as  
“None” and grayed out. Import a correct SDP  
file with [Import User Layout].  
To display a team name with logo or a team name  
that contains characters that are not available for  
input, an image can be imported to the camera  
recorder in place of text input for display at the team  
name area of the score overlay.  
The data file (SDP file) to be imported can be  
generated by an SDP Generator, a PC/Mac  
application. A maximum of 30 teams can be  
registered.  
For information on SDP Generator, please contact  
your local dealer or download from our website.  
0
Select the team name to display in [Main  
Menu] → [Overlay Settings] → [Left Team] (*)  
or [Right Team] (*).  
Caution :  
* This menu item name can be changed in the  
SDP Generator settings.  
0
Please check the content and font licenses of  
the image before use.  
0
It is recommended that you check the display  
of imported team names or logos before  
recording starts.  
1
Copy the SDP file to the root folder of an SD  
card  
Copy the SDP file generated by the SDP  
Generator to the root folder of an SD card.  
Specify a name for the SDP file that is not longer  
than 63 alphanumeric characters with a “sdp”  
extension.  
Example: [overlay1.sdp]  
Scoreboard Overlay L  
228  
   
Deleting an Imported SDP File  
You can delete an imported SDP file.  
Entering Scoreboard Data  
Automatically  
By using a scoreboard solution supplied from  
Sportzcast, the camera can ingest scoreboard  
data automatically. This enables the updating of  
the scoreboard display without having to manually  
enter the scores from the Web screen. Please  
contact the local dealers in your area on the  
Sportzcast solution.  
1
Select [Overlay Settings] B [Delete User  
Layout].  
2
Select an SDP file to delete.  
The blue line at the background of the SDP file  
name indicates that the file is applied for the  
current overlay.  
Configuring the Server  
To connect to the Sportzcast cloud service, select  
“Cloud” in the [Sever Settings] (A P 146).  
Meanwhile, connection to a Sportzcast that is  
connected to a local network can be configured  
using [Search Local Server]. Start search after  
powering on Scorebot and connecting it to the  
same network as the camera recorder.  
.
1
From the list of search results, select the  
Scorebot to connect and press the cross-  
shaped button (I).  
Memo :  
0
The imported SDP file cannot be deleted in  
[System] B [Reset All]. Please use this function  
to delete.  
.
2
Details of the selected Scorebot will be  
displayed. Check the information and press  
the cross-shaped button (I).  
3
4
Once the connection is successfully  
established, a confirmation screen  
appears. Press the cross-shaped button  
(I).  
Select [Sever Settings] of the destination  
for saving and press the cross-shaped  
button (I).  
.
Scoreboard Overlay L  
229  
 
5
6
Enter the [Alias] name to save and press the  
cross-shaped button (I).  
After the connection complete screen  
appears, press the Set button (R) to close  
the menu screen.  
Memo :  
0
If a Scorebot is currently being connected,  
searchcannotbeperformeduntiltheconnection  
has been terminated.  
0
0
Old settings that are saved in [Sever Settings] at  
the storage destination will be overwritten.  
Connection is automatically established upon  
exiting the Wizard, and the [Server] setting  
switches to [Sever Settings] while the camera is  
connected to the Scorebot.  
The connection status to the Sportzcast server is  
displayed in the “Sportzcast” item of the status  
screen (Network) as follows.  
0
Press the [STATUS] button on the camera  
recorder to display the status screen. Press the  
cross-shaped button (H I) to display the  
[Network] screen.  
0
Check the displayed [Sportzcast].  
.
Changing Sportzcast Settings  
The different settings can be configured in the  
respective items under [Overlay Settings] B  
[Sportzcast] B [Settings].  
Scoreboard Overlay L  
230  
Error Messages and Actions  
Warning display on the LCD monitor and viewfinder screen, tally lamp indication and warning tone are as  
follows according to the error status.  
Memo :  
0
This camera recorder makes use of a microcomputer. Noise interference from external sources may  
prevent it from functioning properly. When this occurs, turn off and on the power of the camera recorder  
again.  
Error Message  
Status  
Action  
Turn Power Off Turn  
System error.  
*
Turn off the power, and turn it on again.  
If the error persists, please contact the  
local dealers in your area.  
Back On Later  
The warning tone sounds and the  
tally lamp blinks twice every  
second.  
0
Fan Stop Detected  
Please Turn P.Off  
The fan stopped running.  
Please contact the local dealers in your  
area.  
Fan Maintenance  
Usage time of the fan has exceeded Check the fan and replace accordingly.  
Required  
9000 hours.  
For more details, please contact the local  
dealers in your area.  
Memo :  
0
You can check the usage time of the  
fan in [System] B [System  
Information] B [Fan Hour].  
0
0
0
0
Getting Overheated.   
The battery has exceeded the  
specified temperature.  
The power turns off  
Wait until the temperature drops or  
replace the battery.  
Please Turn Power Off.  
If the error persists, please contact the  
local dealers in your area.  
automatically after about 15  
second.  
Rec Inhibited  
[REC] button is pressed when the Turn off the write-protect switch of the SD  
card, or insert a recordable SD card.  
write-protect switch of the SD card  
is set.  
0
0
0
0
0
0
Lost Media Info *  
Card is removed while recording Restore the card using this camera  
is in progress.  
recorder.  
Card is removed while  
formatting is in progress.  
Card is removed while restoring  
is in progress.  
Card is removed while adding  
the OK mark.  
Card is removed while writing a  
setup file.  
Card is removed while deleting a  
clip.  
(*: A, B)  
Error Messages and Actions 231  
     
Error Message  
Record Format Incorrect  
Status  
Action  
0
The video format of the file for Set [WResolution], [WFrame Rate] and  
Clip Review is different from the [WBit Rate] correctly.  
current [WResolution],  
[WFrame Rate], or [WBit Rate]  
setting.  
0
0
Media Full  
No Clips  
[REC] button is pressed when Replace the recording media with a new  
one.  
the media in use has no  
remaining space.  
Remaining space ran out during  
recording.  
No viewable clips are found on the Insert an SD card that contains clips that  
card for Clip Review.  
can be reviewed.  
No Media  
No Media  
No Clips  
When the [REC] button is pressed Insert a recording media.  
while a recording media is not  
inserted.  
No recording media is inserted while Insert a recording media.  
in Media mode or when the  
thumbnail screen is displayed.  
No clips are found in the inserted Insert a recording media that contains  
recording media while in Media playable clips.  
mode or when the thumbnail screen (A P48 [Recording Media] )  
is displayed.  
Recording has stopped When continuous recording in “4K Start recording again.  
as it has exceeded 4  
hours  
EXT (SSD)” has exceeded 4 hours.  
List of FTP Transfer Errors  
If the upload of a recorded clip or download of the metadata setup file (XML format) is not successfully  
completed, the following errors are displayed.  
Error message  
Timeout.  
Status  
Action  
Execute again.  
Use a different server.  
0
0
Transfer was discontinued due to  
timeout caused by network  
transmission or server failure.  
Media Was Removed.  
Adapter Was Removed.  
Recording media is removed while Insert the recording media and  
FTP transfer is in progress.  
execute FTP transfer again.  
The USB network device is  
removed while FTP transfer is in  
progress.  
Connect the USB network device.  
Cannot Connect to Server.  
UnabletoconnecttotheFTPserver. Adjust the Server and Port settings  
for [Metadata Server] or [Clip  
Server].  
232 Error Messages and Actions  
   
Error message  
Access Denied.  
Status  
Access is denied.  
Action  
Adjust the Server and Port settings  
for [Metadata Server] or [Clip  
Server].  
Invalid Username or  
Password.  
Authentication for login to the FTP Adjust the Username and Password  
server failed.  
settings for [Metadata Server] or  
[Clip Server].  
Invalid Path Was Requested. The path specified for the FTP  
server is incorrect.  
Adjust the [Clip Server] and [Dir.  
Path] settings for [Metadata  
Server] or [File Path].  
Server Error.  
There was an unintended operation Execute again.  
of the FTP server.  
Use a different server.  
Invalid Request.  
Invalid Data Size.  
A bad request is executed for the Execute again.  
FTP server.  
Invalid data size, such as a planning Adjust the planning metadata saved  
metadata size that exceeds 4 KB. in the [Metadata Server].  
Invalid Data Format.  
The XML format of the planning  
Adjust the planning metadata saved  
metadata is invalid.  
in the [Metadata Server].  
Transfer Error.  
Invalid URL.  
Transfer failed due to  
communication failure.  
Execute again.  
The path was deemed invalid by the Adjust the Server and Port settings  
FTP server.  
for [Metadata Server] or [Clip  
Server].  
Media Access Error.  
Reading/writing of the recording  
media failed while FTP transfer is in  
progress.  
Use a different recording media.  
Internal Error.  
Other Error.  
An internal error has occurred while Adjust the settings and execute  
FTP transfer is in progress.  
again.  
An unknown error or other errors  
Adjust the settings and execute  
have occurred while FTP transfer is again.  
in progress.  
Media Read Error.  
Reading of the recording media  
failed while FTP transfer is in  
progress.  
Use a different recording media.  
Error Messages and Actions 233  
List of Live Streaming Error Displays  
The following error messages are displayed when the live streaming setting is incorrect, or when the  
connection is lost during live streaming.  
Error message  
Invalid Address  
Status  
The IP address format is  
Action  
0
0
0
Enter the IP address, host name  
or URL of the destination  
correctly.  
incorrect.  
The domain name cannot be  
converted into the IP address.  
Multicast Is Not Supported  
An IP multicast address was set.  
Use an IP address that is not a  
multicast address.  
0
0
Cannot Connect to Receiver Establishment of connection with  
TCP failed.  
Ensure that the recipient’s  
device is set to TCP.  
Set Type to “MPEG2-TS/UDP”.  
TCP Disconnected  
TCP connection is lost.  
Check to ensure that there is no  
abnormality in the decoder, or  
network connection device and  
cables, followed by establishing the  
connection again.  
0
0
0
Not Enough Bandwidth  
The communication bandwidth  
is narrower than the average bit  
rate.  
Lower the resolution/picture  
quality of the video to be  
distributed.  
0
The network bandwidth is  
insufficient, and packets are  
discarded.  
Consider switching to the use of  
a stable network, such as wired  
LAN.  
Connection Timeout  
Authorization Failed  
Connection Error  
Timeout for connection via ZIXI.  
Set [Destination Address] and  
[Destination Port] correctly.  
Set [Stream ID] and [Password]  
correctly.  
Authentication of connection via  
ZIXI failed.  
0
Connection via “ZIXI” or “RTMP”  
failed.  
Check whether a different  
camera with an identical stream  
ID is connected.  
0
Set [Destination URL] and  
[Stream Key] correctly.  
Disconnected  
“ZIXI” or “RTMP” connection is lost. Check whether there is abnormality  
with the network connection device,  
cables, etc., and try to re-establish  
the connection.  
234 Error Messages and Actions  
   
List of Layout Import Error Displays A L  
Error Message  
Failed To Read File From  
Status  
SD card is defective.  
SDP file data is corrupted.  
Action  
Use other SD card.  
Media!  
Use the SDP file generated by the  
SDP Generator.  
No User Layout Exists.  
SDP file data is corrupted.  
Use the SDP file generated by the  
SDP Generator.  
The camera recorder version is old Update the firmware for the camera  
and an unknown SDP file has been recorder to the latest version.  
imported.  
Failed To Write File To The  
Camera!  
There may be a problem with the  
Please contact the local dealers in  
camera.  
your area.  
Import Error!  
An internal error has occurred.  
Please contact the local dealers in  
your area.  
List of Sportzcast Connection Error Displays L  
Error Message  
Cannot Connect to Server  
Status  
Action  
Cannot connect to the Sportzcast Check that the network connection  
server.  
settings are correct.  
Enter the IP address or host name  
of the Sportzcast server correctly.  
Invalid License  
Sportzcast license is invalid.  
Enter the license name correctly.  
Please note that you cannot use a  
license name you have already  
used in another camera.  
Cannot Get Node  
Invalid BOT Number  
Server response is invalid.  
The BOT number entered is invalid. Enter the Sportzcast BOT number  
Please contact Sportzcast.  
correctly.  
Error Messages and Actions 235  
   
Blinking of the Tally Lamp  
The tally lamp starts blinking when the remaining space on the recording media is running out during  
recording or when the battery power is running low.  
Blinking Mode  
Remaining Battery Power/SD Card Space  
0
0
Blinks slowly  
Battery power is low  
(once every second)  
Remaining recording time on recording media is less than 3 minutes  
(during recording)  
0
0
0
When a malfunction occurred during live streaming  
Blinks quickly  
Remaining battery power is almost zero  
Remaining recording time on recording media has reached 0 minutes  
(during recording)  
(2 times per second)  
0
Error on the camera recorder  
Warning Tone  
0
Warning tone is output from the speaker and [x] terminal when the battery level is low.  
Warning tone is also output when an error occurs in the camera recorder.  
Memo :  
0
You can specify whether to turn on the warning tone as well as setting the volume in [A/V Set] B [Audio  
Set] B [Alarm Level].  
236 Error Messages and Actions  
   
Troubleshooting  
Symptom  
Action  
0
0
0
Power does not turn on.  
Is the AC adapter properly connected?  
Is the battery charged?  
Is the power turned on immediately after it is turned off?  
Make sure to wait for an interval of at least 5 seconds before turning  
on the power again.  
0
0
Unable to start recording.  
Is the record trigger button/lock switch on the handle turned on?  
Is the write-protect switch of the SD card turned on?  
Make sure that the write-protect switch is turned off.  
Is the camera recorder set to the Camera mode?  
Use the [MODE] selection button to switch to the Camera mode.  
0
0
Is the SD card inserted compatible with the recording format?  
0
Camera image is not output on  
the LCD monitor and  
Is the camera recorder set to the Camera mode?  
Use the [MODE] selection button to switch to the Camera mode.  
viewfinder screen.  
0
The LCD monitor and viewfinder screens cannot be displayed at the  
same time.  
To display the viewfinder screen, close the LCD monitor or press and  
hold the [DISPLAY] button.  
0
Playback does not start after  
selecting a clip thumbnail and  
pressing the Set button (R).  
Is the selected clip a playable clip?  
Playback is not possible if the clip has a different video format setting.  
0
0
0
0
0
Images on the LCD monitor  
and viewfinder screen appear  
dark or blurred.  
Readjust the brightness of the LCD monitor and viewfinder.  
Is the [ND FILTER] switch set to “1/64”?  
Is the iris closed?  
Is the shutter speed setting too high?  
Is the peaking level too low?  
Use the [PEAKING +/-] button to adjust the contour for the LCD  
monitor and the viewfinder screen.  
0
0
The[CH1/CH2]recordinglevel  
adjustment knob does not  
work.  
Is the [CH1/CH2 AUTO/MANUAL] switch set to “AUTO”?  
Is the [FULL AUTO] switch set to “ON”?  
Is the [FULL AUTO] switch set to “ON”, and [A/V Set] B [Audio Set] B  
[FULL AUTO] set to “Auto”?  
0
Microphone audio cannot be  
heard through the headphone.  
Is the audio setting configured to “IFB/RET Only”?  
Set [A/V Set] B [Audio Set] B [IFB/RET Monitor] B [CH1]/[CH2] to  
“Off”.  
0
SD card cannot be initialized  
(formatted).  
Is the write-protect switch of the SD card turned on?  
Make sure that the write-protect switch is turned off.  
0
Battery alarm appears even  
after loading a charged  
battery.  
Is the battery too old?  
Troubleshooting 237  
 
Symptom  
Action  
0
0
The time code and user’s bit  
Even in Camera mode or Media mode, the time code and user’s bit  
may not be displayed depending to the type of display.  
Is [LCD/VF] B [Display On/Off] B [TC/UB] set to “Off”? To display the  
date and time, set it to “On”.  
are not displayed.  
0
The time is not displayed.  
The time is only displayed on the display screen in the Camera mode  
(during shooting).  
Is [System] B [Record Set] B [Time Stamp] set to “On”? To display  
the date and time, set it to “Off”.  
0
0
The actual recording time is  
shorter than the estimated  
time.  
The two camera recorders are  
not synchronized even though  
the time codes have been  
synchronized. (Z on the Slave  
device is not displayed.)  
The recordable time may be shorter depending on the shooting  
conditions or the subject.  
0
0
Is the [TC IN/OUT] switch correctly set?  
Set [System] B [Record Set] B [Record Format] B [WFrame Rate]  
such that the two camera recorders have the same frame rate.  
0
Cannot connect to wireless  
LAN.  
Check the mode of connection and method of setting ([SSID] and  
[Passphrase] in cases other than WPS).  
0
Even if the Passphrase is wrong, “Completed the Setup Wizard.  
Please Input the Passphrase into Your Device.” may appear at the  
browser setting depending on the type of encryption.  
Adjust [Passphrase] again.  
0
0
The View Remote screen turns  
black.  
The network path is congested.  
Wait a while before refreshing (reloading) the web browser.  
Clear the cache in your Web browser.  
The screen flickers.  
The screen freezes.  
Cannot perform remote  
operation.  
0
The clips cannot be uploaded  
Adjust the [Clip Server] settings.  
to the FTP server.  
0
If a file size limit is set in the FTP server, set the size limit such that it  
is larger than the maximum size of the recorded clip.  
Take necessary action as described in “[List of FTP Transfer Errors]  
0
0
0
The wireless LAN is  
disconnected.  
The wireless LAN may be disconnected depending on the  
environment. Change the usage environment.  
Connect via wired LAN.  
0
0
The images and audio sound  
during live streaming are  
choppy.  
Depending on the connection method to the network and connection  
environment, streaming may not be possible with the encoding bit rate  
specified. Please reduce the encoding bit rate.  
GPS signal cannot be  
Signal reception from GPS satellites may be affected by buildings or  
received. A L  
trees.  
Perform positioning preferably at an unobstructed location with a clear  
view.  
0
0
Radio wave reception may be affected by weather conditions such as  
on a cloudy or rainy day.  
The position is not accurate.  
The precision error may be up to hundreds of meters if the GPS signal  
A L  
is weak or reflected off surrounding buildings.  
238 Troubleshooting  
Terminal Section  
Specifications  
General  
Video/Audio  
Item  
Description  
Item  
Power  
Description  
[SDI OUT] terminal (480i or 576i: Downconverted 720p/1080i/  
DC 12 V  
1080p: embedded audio), BNC (unbalanced)  
Power  
Approx. 24.0 W  
3G-SDI,  
HD-SDI,  
SD-SDI  
Compliant with SMPTE ST424,  
Compliant with SMPTE ST292,  
Compliant with SMPTE ST259  
Compliant with SMPTE ST299,  
Compliant with SMPTE ST299,  
Compliant with SMPTE ST272  
consumption  
(When recording in the factory  
default settings using the  
viewfinder.)  
3G-SDI,  
HD-SDI,  
SD-SDI  
Embedded  
audio  
Mass  
Approx. 3.6 kg  
(With battery attached)  
Allowable operating 0 °C to 40 °C (32 °F to 104 °F)  
temperature  
standard  
Allowable operating 30 %RH to 80 %RH  
humidity  
[HDMI] output Type A  
terminal  
[INPUT 1/INPUT 2] Terminal (XLR 3-pin)  
Allowable storage  
-20 °C to 50 °C (-4 °F to 122 °F)  
temperature  
[MIC]  
-50 dBu, 3 kK, XLR (balanced),  
Built-in wireless IEEE802.11a/b/g/n/ac  
LAN  
(2.4 GHz/5 GHz band)  
+48 V output (phantom power  
A
Encryption method: WPA2  
supply)  
U
2.4 GHz Ch1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11  
[LINE]  
+4 dBu, 10 kK, XLR (balanced)  
model  
5 GHz  
Ch36, 40, 44, 48, 52, 56, 60, 64,  
100, 104, 108, 112, 116, 120,  
124, 128, 132, 136, 140, 149,  
153, 157, 161, 165  
[AUX] terminal -22 dBu, 10 kK, 3.5 mm stereo  
USA  
mini jack (unbalanced)  
Φ3.5 mm stereo mini jack  
[x] Terminal  
5 GHz  
Ch36, 40, 44, 48, 52, 56, 60, 64,  
CANADA 100, 104, 108, 112, 116, 132,  
136, 140, 149, 153, 157, 161,  
165  
E
2.4 GHz Ch1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11,  
model  
12, 13  
5 GHz  
Ch36, 40, 44, 48, 52, 56, 60, 64,  
Outside 100, 104, 108, 112, 116, 120,  
Russia 124, 128, 132, 136, 140  
5 GHz  
Ch36, 40, 44, 48, 52, 56, 60, 64,  
Russia 132, 136, 140, 149, 153, 157,  
161, 165  
Specifications 239  
 
Others  
Item  
Camera Section  
Description  
Item  
Description  
[LAN] terminal 100BASE-TX/1000BASE-T  
(RJ-45)  
[HOST] terminal USB-A type, network  
connection function only  
[REMOTE]  
terminal  
[TC IN/OUT] terminal  
[IN]  
Image pickup  
1" single CMOS sensor  
(effective resolution: approx.  
9.35 megapixels)  
device  
Sync system  
ND filter  
Gain  
Internal sync (built-in SSG)  
OFF, 1/4, 1/16, 1/64  
-6 dB, -3 dB, 0 dB, 3 dB, 6 dB, 9  
dB, 12 dB, 15 dB, 18 dB, 21 dB,  
24 dB, Lolux (30 dB, 36 dB),  
AGC  
Φ2.5 mm mini jack  
(Stereo)  
1.0 V(p-p) to 4.0 V(p-p) high  
impedance  
Electronic  
shutter  
1/6 to 1/10000, EEI  
[OUT]  
2.0 ± 1.0 V (p-p) low impedance  
LCD Monitor  
Viewfinder  
3.97" LCD (800x480)  
0.4"  
4:3 Quad-VGA (1280x960)  
Lens  
F2.8 to F4.5, 20x zoom,  
f = 9.43 mm to 188.6 mm  
(35 mm equivalent: 28.0 mm to  
560.0 mm)  
Filter diameter Φ82 mm  
Sensitivity F11, 2000 lx (standard value: 60  
Hz)  
Storage Section  
Item  
Description  
Supported  
SDHC/SDXC: SD slots x 2  
media  
M.2 SSD: Expansion slot  
240 Specifications  
Video/Audio  
Item  
Description  
HD mode (MOV/MXF: MPEG-2) A  
Item  
Description  
Recording file QuickTime File Format (MOV),  
4K EXT (SSD) mode (Apple ProRes)  
format  
Video  
MXF File Format (MXF)  
Recording file QuickTime File Format  
format  
Video  
HQ mode MPEG-2 Long GOP VBR, 35  
Mbps (Max) MP@HL,  
422HQ mode Apple ProRes 422 HQ, 1768  
1920x1080/59.94i, 29.97p, 50i,  
25p  
Mbps (Max),  
3840x2160/59.94p, 50p,  
29.97p, 23.98p, 25p  
1440x1080/59.94i, 50i  
1280x720/59.94p, 50p  
422 mode  
Apple ProRes 422, 1178 Mbps  
SP mode MPEG-2 Long GOP CBR, 25  
(Max),  
Mbps (Max) MP@H14  
3840x2160/59.94p, 50p,  
29.97p, 23.98p, 25p  
1440×1080/59.94i, 50i  
Audio  
LPCM 2ch, 48 kHz/16 Bit  
422LT mode Apple ProRes 422 LT, 821  
HD mode (MOV: H.264)  
Recording file QuickTime File Format  
format  
Mbps (Max),  
3840x2160/59.94p, 50p,  
29.97p, 23.98p, 25p  
Video  
Audio  
LPCM 2ch, 48 kHz/24 bit  
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 70 Mbps  
4K mode (MOV: H.264)  
(Max) 1920×1080/59.94p, 50p  
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 50 Mbps  
(Max) 1920×1080/59.94p,  
59.94i, 29.97p, 23.98p, 50p,  
50i, 25p  
XHQ mode  
Recording file QuickTime File Format  
format  
Video  
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 150 Mbps  
(Max)  
1280×720/59.94p, 50p  
XHQ mode  
XHQ mode  
3840×2160/29.97p, 23.98p,  
25p  
XHQ mode MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 50 Mbps  
(Max)  
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 150 Mbps  
1920×1080/59.94p, 59.94i,  
29.97p, 23.98p, 50p, 50i, 25p  
(Max)  
3840×2160/29.97p, 23.98p,  
UHQ mode MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 35 Mbps  
25p  
(Max)  
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 70 Mbps  
1920×1080/59.94i, 29.97p,  
23.98p, 50i, 25p  
(Max)  
3840×2160/29.97p, 23.98p,  
25p  
1280×720/59.94p, 50p  
Audio  
LPCM 2ch, 48 kHz/16 Bit, 24 Bit  
Audio  
LPCM 2ch, 48 kHz/16 bit, 24 bit  
(422 10 bit only)  
(422 10 bit only)  
Specifications 241  
Item  
Description  
Item  
Description  
HD mode (Exchange (U model) / MP4 (E model):  
SD mode (MOV: H.264)  
H.264)  
Recording file QuickTime File Format  
Recording file MP4 File Format  
format  
Video  
format  
Video  
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 8 Mbps  
(Max)  
720×480/59.94i (U model)  
720×576/50i (E model)  
LP mode MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 12 Mbps  
(Max)  
1920x1080/59.94p (U model),  
1920x1080/50p (E model),  
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 8 Mbps  
(Max)  
Audio  
LPCM 2ch, 48 kHz/16bit  
Web mode (MOV: H.264)  
Recording file QuickTime File Format  
format  
Video  
1280x720/59.94p (U model)  
1280x720/50p (E model)  
HQ mode MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 8 Mbps  
Audio  
AAC 2ch, 48 kHz/16 Bit 128  
(Max)  
kbps  
720x480/59.94i, 720x576/50i  
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 3 Mbps  
(Max)  
HD mode (High-Speed)  
Recording file QuickTime File Format  
format  
Video  
960x540/29.97p, 25p, 23.98p  
LP mode MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 1.2 Mbps  
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 70 Mbps  
(Max)  
(Max), 1920×1080  
480x270/29.97p, 25p, 23.98p  
XHQ mode  
119.88/59.94p, 100/50p  
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 50 Mbps  
(Max), 1920×1080  
Audio  
LPCM 2ch, 48 kHz/16 Bit  
(720x480, 720x576)  
μ-law 2ch, 16 kHz (960x540,  
480x270)  
119.88/59.94p, 100/50p,  
119.88/29.97p, 100/25p,  
119.88/23.98p  
Streaming mode  
Video  
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264  
1920x1080/59.94p, 50p  
24/20/16/12/8 Mbps (Max)  
1920x1080/59.94i, 50i, 29.97p,  
25p  
XHQ mode MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 50 Mbps  
(Max), 1920×1080  
119.88/59.94p, 100/50p,  
119.88/29.97p, 100/25p,  
119.88/23.98p  
20/16/12/8/5/3 Mbps (Max)  
1280x720/59.94p, 50p  
20/16/12/8/5/3 Mbps (Max)  
1280x720/29.97p, 25p  
8/5/3/1.5 Mbps (Max)  
720x480/59.94i  
UHQ mode MPEG-4 AVC/H.264, 35 Mbps  
(Max), 1920×1080  
119.88/29.97p, 100/25p,  
119.88/23.98p  
Audio  
LPCM 2ch, 48 kHz/16 Bit, 24 Bit  
(422 10 bit only)  
720x576/50i  
8/5/3/1.5/0.8/0.3 Mbps (Max)  
640x360/59.94p, 50p  
3/1.5 Mbps (Max)  
640x360/29.97p, 25p  
3/1.5/0.8/0.3 Mbps (Max)  
Audio  
AAC 2ch, 128/64 kbps  
242 Specifications  
Accessories  
Accessories  
Warranty Card (U model only)  
INSTRUCTIONS (BASIC)  
AC Adapter  
1
1
1
Power Cord (U model: 1, E model: 2)  
Battery  
Wireless LAN Antenna A  
1
2
*
A large eyecup and hood are mounted in  
advance to the camera body.  
Specifications 243  
Dimensional Outline Drawing (Unit: mm)  
Wireless LAN antenna is not included in GY-HC500U/GY-HC500E/GY-HC500SPCU.  
.
437  
386  
77  
*
The specifications and appearance of this product are subject to changes for further improvement  
without prior notice.  
244 Specifications  
Appendix  
Tone Mapping Characteristics for Converting HLG to ITU709 for LCD/VF  
.
60%  
ITU709  
80%  
110  
100  
90  
75%  
72.5%  
50%  
ITU709  
ITU709  
ITU709  
ITU709  
80  
70  
60  
50  
40  
30  
20  
hlg  
80%  
*3  
*1  
75%  
*4  
50%white + KNEE  
60%white +_KNEE  
72.5%_white + knee  
75%_white + knee  
80%_white + knee  
ITU709_50%  
*2  
72.5%  
60%  
*6  
*5  
50%  
0.1  
ITU709_60%  
ITU709_72.5%  
ITU709_75%  
ITU709_80%  
WHITE POINT  
10  
0
0
0.2  
0.3  
0.4  
0.5  
0.6  
0.7  
0.8  
0.9  
1
INPUT  
*1 HLG  
*2 White Level  
80% converted  
*3 White Level  
75% converted  
*4 White Level  
72.5% converted  
*5 White Level  
60% converted  
*6 White Level  
50% converted  
Appendix 245  
   
Index  
A
H
I
B
C
L
M
N
O
P
D
E
F
R
G
246 Index  
 
S
T
U
V
W
Z
Symbol  
Index 247  
Article 4 Right pertaining to the Licensed  
Software  
Software License  
Agreement  
1. Any and all copyrights and other rights pertaining  
to the Licensed Software and related documents  
shall belong to the Licensor or the original holder of  
the right who granted to the Licensor the license or  
sublicense for the Licensed Software (hereinafter  
the “Original Rightholder”), and the User shall not be  
entitled to any right other than the license granted  
hereunder, in respect of the Licensed Software and  
any related documents.  
The software embedded in the Product (hereinafter  
the “Licensed Software”) provided by  
JVCKENWOOD Corporation (hereinafter the  
“Licensor”) is copyrighted to or sublicensable by the  
Licensor, and this Agreement provides for the terms  
and conditions which Users shall follow in order to  
use the Licensed Software. The User shall use the  
Licensed Software by agreeing with the terms of this  
Software License Agreement. This Agreement shall  
be deemed completed at the time the User  
2. The User shall, whenever the User uses the  
Licensed Software, comply with any laws relating to  
the copyright and other intellectual property rights.  
(hereinafter the “User”) initially used the Product in  
which the “Licensed Software” is embedded.  
The Licensed Software may include the software  
which has been licensed to the Licensor directly or  
indirectly from any third party. In such case, some  
third parties require the Users to follow their  
Article 5 Indemnification of Licensor  
1. Neither the Licensor nor the Original Rightholder  
shall be liable for any damage incurred by the User  
or any third party due to the exercise of the license  
granted to the User under this Agreement, unless  
otherwise restricted by law.  
conditions for use separately from this Software  
License Agreement. Such software shall not be  
subject to this Agreement, and the Users are urged  
2. The Licensor will offer no guarantee for the  
merchantability, convertibility and consistency with  
certain objective of the Licensed Software.  
Article 6 Liability to Third Party  
Article 1 General Provision  
If any dispute has arisen with any third party due to  
an infringement upon a copyright, patent or any other  
intellectual property right that was caused by the  
User’s use of the Licensed Software, the User shall  
settle such dispute at the User’s own cost and hold  
the Licensor and the Original Rightholder harmless  
from any inconvenience it may cause.  
The Licensor shall grant to the User a non-exclusive  
and non-transferable (other than the exceptional  
case referred to in Article 3, Paragraph 1) licensed  
to use the Licensed Software within the country of  
the User (the country where the User bought the  
Product (hereinafter the “Country”)).  
Article 7 Confidentiality  
Article 2 License  
The User shall keep the confidentiality of such  
portion of the Licensed Software, related documents  
thereof or any other information to be granted under  
this Agreement, as well as the conditions of this  
Agreement as has not yet entered the public domain,  
and shall not disclose or divulge the same to any third  
party without approval of the Licensor.  
1. The license granted under this Agreement shall be  
the right to use the Licensed Software in the Product.  
2. The User shall not duplicate, copy, modify, add,  
translate or otherwise alter, or lease the Licensed  
Software and any related documents, whether in  
whole or in part.  
3. The use of the Licensed Software shall be limited  
to personal purpose, and the Licensed Software  
shall not be distributed, licensed or sub-licensed  
whether it is for commercial purpose or not.  
4. The User shall use the Licensed Software  
according to the directions described in the  
operation manual or help file, and is prohibited to use  
or duplicate any data in a manner violating the  
Copyright Law or any other laws and regulations by  
applying whole or a part of the Licensed Software.  
Article 8 Termination  
In case the User falls under any of the events  
described in the following items, the Licensor may  
immediately terminate this Agreement or claim that  
the User compensates for the damage incurred by  
the Licensor due to such event:  
(1) when the User violated any provision of this  
Agreement; or  
(2) when a petition has been filed against the User  
for an attachment, provisional attachment,  
provisional disposition or any other compulsory  
execution.  
Article 3 Conditions for Grant of License  
1. When the User transfers the Product, it may also  
transfer the license to use the Licensed Software  
embedded in the Product (including any related  
materials, updates and upgrades) on condition that  
no original, copies or related materials continue in  
the possession of the User, and that the User shall  
cause the transferee to comply with this Software  
License Agreement.  
2. The User shall not carry out reverse engineering,  
disassembling, decompiling or any other code  
analysis works in connection with the Licensed  
Software.  
248 Software License Agreement  
 
Article 9 Destruction of the Licensed Software  
The Licensed Software covers those corresponding  
to free software, and, as a condition of distribution of  
the software component in executable format which  
is based on the license granted under the GNU  
General Public License or Lesser General Public  
License (hereinafter “GPL/LGPL”), it requires an  
availability of the source code for the relevant  
component. Please refer to the following URL  
concerning the distribution of the source code;  
If this Agreement is terminated pursuant to the  
provision of Article 8, the User shall destroy the  
Licensed Software, any related documents and  
copies thereof within two (2) weeks from such date  
of termination.  
Article 10 Export Restriction  
1. The User shall understand that the Licensed  
Software shall be subject to the export restrictions  
adopted by the country of User and any other  
countries.  
2. The User shall agree that the software will be  
subject to any and all applicable international and  
domestic laws including the export control regulation  
of the country of User and any other countries, and  
any restrictions concerning the end-users, the use  
by end-users and importing countries to be provided  
by the country of User and any other countries, and  
any other governmental authorities.  
Please note that we are unable to answer any inquiry  
relating to the contents, etc. of the source code. In  
addition, the Licensed Software includes the  
software developed or created independently by  
JKC and there exists an ownership of JKC in such  
software and any accompanying documents, which  
is protected by the Copyright Law, any international  
treaties and other applicable laws. As to matters  
concerning the handling by JKC of the software  
components, please refer to the “Software License  
Agreement” attached hereto. Please note that any  
software component licensed under “EULA” which  
is not subject to “GPL/LGPL”, and those developed  
or created independently by JKC shall not be subject  
to the requirement for provision of the source code.  
The software component distributed under “GPL/  
LGPL” shall be licensed to users without charge,  
and, therefore, no warranty is given for such software  
component, either express or implied, within the  
scope of the applicable laws and regulations. Unless  
otherwise permitted by applicable laws and  
3. If the User is an agency of the United States of  
America (the “Government”), the User acknowledge  
Licensor’s representation that the Licensed  
Software is a “Commercial Item” as defined in  
Federal Acquisition Regulation (FAR) part 2.101(g)  
consisting unpublished “Commercial Computer  
Software” as those items are used at FAR part  
12.212 and is only license the User with the same  
use right Licensor grants all commercial end users  
pursuant to the terms of this Agreement.  
Article 11 Miscellaneous  
1. In the event any part of this Agreement is  
invalidated by operation of law, the residual  
provisions shall continue in force.  
2. Matters not stipulated in this Agreement or any  
ambiguity or question raised in the construction of  
this Agreement shall be provided or settled upon  
good-faith consultation between the Licensor and  
the User.  
regulations or agreed in written form, none of the  
owners of the copyright or persons entitled to alter or  
redistribute the software component under the said  
license shall have any liability for any type of damage  
or loss resulting from the use of or inability to use  
such software component. For further details of the  
conditions of use of such software component or  
matters required to be complied with, please refer to  
the relevant “GPL/LGPL”.  
3. The Licensor and the User hereby agree that this  
Agreement is governed by the laws of Japan, and  
any dispute arising from, and relating to the rights  
and obligations under, this Agreement shall be  
submitted to the exclusive jurisdiction of the Tokyo  
District Court for its first instance.  
Users are urged to read the details for the relevant  
license carefully before using the software  
component covered by “GPL/LGPL” and embedded  
in the Product. Since the terms and conditions of  
individual licenses are provided by parties other than  
JKC, the original English version will be displayed by  
the Product.  
Important Notice  
concerning the Software  
Software License Attached to the Product :  
A
Turn on the power.  
Press the [MENU/THUMB] button.  
The Software embedded in the Product is composed  
of several independent software components, and in  
each of such individual components (hereinafter the  
“Licensed Software”), a copyright of either  
JVCKENWOOD Corporation (hereinafter “JKC”) or  
a third party subsists.  
B
C
Select [System]  
B
[System Information]  
B
[Open  
Source License].  
The Product uses the software component  
designated in the End-User License Agreement that  
was executed between JKC and a third party  
(hereinafter “EULA”).  
Software License Agreement 249  
   
250  
251  
.
B5A-2966-00  
© 2019 JVCKENWOOD Corporation  

NEC MT830 User Manual
Mitsubishi Electronics Msh 09nv User Manual
METRA 99 5849CH User Manual
MAYTAG MMV6190FZ 02 User Manual
LG LDC22720 02 User Manual
LG LBC22520 02 User Manual
LG 16U70Q User Manual
D LINK COVR X1860 User Manual
BLACK DECKER FIRESTORM PS130 User Manual
ACER EW 12H User Manual